CJ2 PTM
CJ2 PTM
CJ2 PTM
NOTE:
For printing purposes, revision numbers in footers occur at the bottom of every page
that has changed in any way (grammatical or typographical revisions, reflow of pages,
and other changes that do not necessarily affect the meaning of the manual).
NOTICE
The material contained in this training manual is based on information obtained from the
aircraft manufacturer’s Pilot Manuals and Maintenance Manuals. It is to be used for famil-
iarization and training purposes only.
We at FlightSafety want you to have the best training possible. We welcome any sugges-
tions you might have for improving this manual or any other aspect of our
training program.
Chapter 3 LIGHTING
Chapter 7 POWERPLANT
Chapter 9 PNEUMATICS
Chapter 12 PRESSURIZATION
Chapter 16 AVIONICS
WALKAROUND
APPENDIX
ANNUNCIATOR PANEL
CHAPTER 1
AIRCRAFT GENERAL
CONTENTS
Page
GENERAL .............................................................................................................................. 1-1
Structures ......................................................................................................................... 1-2
Nose Section .................................................................................................................... 1-5
Flight Compartment......................................................................................................... 1-5
Entrance Door and Emergency Exit ................................................................................ 1-6
Cabin................................................................................................................................ 1-8
Wing................................................................................................................................. 1-8
Tail Cone Compartment................................................................................................... 1-8
Empennage .................................................................................................................... 1-10
SYSTEMS............................................................................................................................. 1-10
Electrical System ........................................................................................................... 1-10
Fuel System ................................................................................................................... 1-10
Engines .......................................................................................................................... 1-10
Ice Protection ................................................................................................................. 1-11
Hydraulic System........................................................................................................... 1-11
Flight Controls ............................................................................................................... 1-11
Environmental Controls ................................................................................................. 1-11
Avionics ......................................................................................................................... 1-11
PUBLICATIONS................................................................................................................... 1-11
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
1-1 Cessna Citation CJ2 ................................................................................................. 1-2
1-2 Exterior Three-View Drawing.................................................................................. 1-3
1-3 Braking Taxi Turning Distance ................................................................................ 1-4
1-4 Engine Hazard Areas................................................................................................ 1-4
1-5 Baggage Door Microswitch ..................................................................................... 1-5
1-6 Sight Gages .............................................................................................................. 1-5
1-7 Entrance Door, Pins, Interior Handle, and Latch Release ....................................... 1-6
1-8 Door Locking Indicator Windows............................................................................ 1-7
1-9 Emergency Exit (Interior and Exterior) ................................................................... 1-7
1-10 Interior Arrangements .............................................................................................. 1-9
1-11 Wing Trailing Edge .................................................................................................. 1-8
1-12 Wing Leading Edge.................................................................................................. 1-8
1-13 Stall Strips ............................................................................................................... 1-8
1-14 Tail Cone Baggage Door ....................................................................................... 1-10
1-15 Empennage............................................................................................................. 1-10
49.79 FT (15.18 M)
15.95 FT
(4.86 M)
DIHEDRAL
WING 5° NOSE GEAR DOORS
ENGINE PYLONS 23°
HORIZONTAL 0° BAGGAGE DOORS
WING AREA 264.34 FT2
(24.56 M2)
CABIN DOOR
EMERGENCY EXIT
THRUST ATTENUATORS
ELEVATOR
RUDDER
EMERGENCY EXIT TRIM TAB
(RIGHT SIDE ONLY)
14.45 FT
BAGGAGE DOORS (4.40 M)
TAIL CONE
ACCESS DOOR
(LEFT SIDE ONLY)
47.34 FT (14.43 M)
18.27 FT (5.57 M) HYDRAULIC RESERVOIR
ACCESS (RIGHT SIDE)
32.88 FT (10.02 M)
CURB-TO-CURB
16.44 FT
(5.01 M)
20.43 FT
(6.23 M)
70 FT
(20 M)
20 FT
(6 M)
DISTANCE IN FEET
0 10 20 30 40 60
DISTANCE IN METERS
CAUTION
Ensure that the key is removed prior
to flight to prevent possible ingestion
of the key into an engine.
Flight Compartment
Two complete crew stations are provided with
dual controls, including control columns,
brakes, and adjustable rudder pedals with fore,
mid, and aft detents. There are two fully ad-
justable seats with five-point seat belts and
shoulder harnesses.
Figure 1-7. Entrance Door, Pins, Interior Handle, and Latch Release
DOOR
If the door seal loses inflation
SEAL pressure, the DOOR SEAL an-
nunciator light illuminates.
Cabin pressurization will not be lost because
the secondary seal (which is not inflatable) will
hold the cabin pressure.
Cabin
The cabin extends from the forward to the aft
pressure bulkhead and measures approximately
18.9 feet in length, 4.9 feet in width, and 4.8
feet in height. Figure 1-10 shows two interior
arrangements.
WING
The wing is a one-piece assembly, natural
laminar flow (NLF) airfoil that attaches to
the bottom of the fuselage, constructed of
aluminum. Each wing is a fuel tank. Hydrauli- Figure 1-13. Stall Strips
cally actuated speedbrakes, flaps, and main
landing gear are attached to each wing (Fig-
ure 1-11).
TAIL CONE COMPARTMENT
The leading edge of the wings are anti-iced The tail cone compartment is an unpressurized
by engine bleed-air heat (Figure 1-12). Stall area and contains the major components of
strips are attached to the leading edge pan- the hydraulic, environmental, electrical distri-
els (Figure 1-13). bution, flight controls, and engine fire extin-
guishing systems. Access is through an
1 2 1 2
SIDE-FACING
SEAT
CABINETTE
3 4 3 4
5 6 5 6
7 8 7 8
T T
STANDARD OPTION 1
FUEL SYSTEM
The fuel system has two distinct, identical
halves. Each wing tank stores and supplies
the fuel to its respective engine. Fuel transfer
capability is provided. All controls and indi-
cators are located in the cockpit.
ENGINES
Two Williams FJ44-2C turbofan engines are
Figure 1-14. Tail Cone Baggage Door
pylon-mounted on the rear fuselage, and each
produces 2,400 pounds thrust.
CHAPTER 2
ELECTRICAL POWER SYSTEMS
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 2-1
GENERAL .............................................................................................................................. 2-1
DC POWER............................................................................................................................. 2-2
Battery.............................................................................................................................. 2-2
Starter-Generators ............................................................................................................ 2-2
External Power................................................................................................................. 2-3
Distribution ...................................................................................................................... 2-4
Control ............................................................................................................................. 2-9
Monitoring ..................................................................................................................... 2-10
Protection ....................................................................................................................... 2-11
OPERATION......................................................................................................................... 2-12
Normal ........................................................................................................................... 2-12
Abnormal ....................................................................................................................... 2-13
QUESTIONS......................................................................................................................... 2-16
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
2-1 Battery Location....................................................................................................... 2-2
2-2 Battery Disconnect Switch....................................................................................... 2-2
2-3 Generator Circuit...................................................................................................... 2-3
2-4 External Power Receptacle ...................................................................................... 2-3
2-5 External Power Circuit............................................................................................. 2-4
2-6 Electrical System Schematic—SNs 0001 and Subsequent...................................... 2-5
2-7 J-Box on Aft Side of Aft Baggage Compartment.................................................... 2-6
2-8 Circuit-Breaker Panels—SNs 0001 and Subsequent (One PFD) ............................ 2-7
2-9 Circuit-Breaker Panels—SNs 0001 and Subsequent (Two PFDs) .......................... 2-8
2-10 DC Electrical Controls and Start Buttons.............................................................. 2-10
2-11 Electrical Indicators ............................................................................................... 2-11
2-12 Audio Control Panel .............................................................................................. 2-15
TABLE
Table Title Page
2-1 Emergency Bus Items .............................................................................................. 2-9
CHAPTER 2
ELECTRICAL POWER SYSTEMS
G
EN PL
#1 IL
O
DC
#1 EN
G
FF
O
T
BA
O ACEN
RV M
SE TE T G
#1 SYS HO
ATT
B
INTRODUCTION
This chapter provides a description of the electrical power system used on the Cita-
tion CJ2, and is divided into the following subchapters: general, battery, starter-gen-
erators, external power, distribution, control, monitoring, protection, normal and
abnormal operations.
DC POWER
BATTERY
A standard nickel-cadmium battery provides
25 volts rated at 28 ampere-hours. Optional bat-
teries available are a 25-volt 44-ampere hour
nicad battery and a 24-volt 42-ampere hour
lead acid battery. A battery in good condition
should supply power to all buses for a maxi- Figure 2-2. Battery Disconnect Switch
mum of 10 minutes with maximum load. If
only the hot battery and emergency buses are valve. This switch opens the battery discon-
powered, battery life should be a minimum of nect relay. It is used in case of a battery over-
30 minutes. heat or stuck start relay.
The battery, located in the tail cone compart- The nicad battery is susceptible to, and must
ment (Figure 2-1), is provided with a manual be protected from, overheat due to excessive
quick-disconnect and is accessible through the charging or discharging. The nicad battery is
tail cone door. limited to three engine starts per hour.
STARTER-GENERATORS
Two engine-driven DC starter-generators, one
mounted on each engine accessory gearbox,
are the primary sources of power and supply
all DC buses. Each generator is air cooled,
rated at 30 volts DC, regulated to 29 volts. The
ammeters have a yellow arc from 250 to 300
amps and a red line at 300 amps. The maximum
load is 250 amps during ground operations
and enroute above 41,000 feet. The maximum
load enroute through 41,000 feet is 300 amps.
Generators are capable of 50% overload to
Figure 2-1. Battery Location 450 amperes for two minutes. The generators
are used as motors for engine starting, then be-
The battery is connected to the hot battery bus. come generators at the completion of the start
A battery disconnect relay is installed between cycle. Each generator system is operated in-
the battery and its ground to provide an dependently, but power is distributed through
electrical disconnect during certain abnormal systems that are in parallel except under fault
conditions. conditions. The generators share loads equally
(10% of total load) during normal operation
A BATTERY DISC switch (Figure 2-2) is in- via an equalizer connection between the gen-
stalled in the cockpit behind the pilots oxygen erator control units.
EXTERNAL POWER
An external power unit may be connected to Figure 2-4. External Power Receptacle
the aircraft DC system through a receptacle lo-
cated in the fuselage on the left tail cone (Fig- When using the external power for prolonged
ure 2-4). Before connecting an external power ground operation (over 30 minutes), the battery
unit, the voltage of the EPU should be regu- should be disconnected at the quick-disconnect
lated to 28 to 29 volts maximum, and the am- plug to preclude overheating the battery. Do
perage output should be between 800 and not use the battery disconnect switch in the
1,100 amperes. External power is routed to the flight deck for this because it will discharge
hot battery bus (Figure 2-5). The battery the battery.
charges from the external power unit regard-
less of the battery switch position.
A
BATT
GEN EMER GEN
OFF L RELAY OFF
OFF R
POWER BATT
L RELAY PWR LH R
RELAY
RELAY
EMER
GCU GCU
V START V 20 A START V
RELAY RELAY
QUICK-DISCONNECT
PLUG
OVER
EXT
POWER VOLTAGE
BATT
RELAY SENSOR
BATT BATTERY
DISC DISCONNECT
RELAY EPU
NORMAL LEGEND
BATTERY POWER
LEFT NORMAL BUS POWER
RIGHT NORMAL BUS POWER
VOLTMETER
BATTERY
EXT POWER
DISABLE RELAYS
EXT
POWER
RELAY
BATTERY
DISCONNECT
RELAY
EXT OVERVOLTAGE
POWER SENSOR
L CB PANEL R CB PANEL
EMER EMER
R X OVER L X OVER
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
CURRENT LIMITERS
80 80
A
BATT
GEN GEN
OFF L OFF OFF
BATT R
POWER
L RELAY POWER LH R
RELAY
RELAY
EMER
GCU GCU
V START V 20 A START V
RELAY RELAY
QUICK-DISCONNECT
PLUG OVER
EXT
POWER VOLTAGE
BATT
RELAY SENSOR
BATT BATTERY
DISC DISCONNECT
EPU
RELAY
NORMAL
RIGHT DC LEFT DC
CIRCUIT CIRCUIT
BREAKER’S BREAKER’S
HOT BATTERY
BUS CIRCUIT
BREAKER’S
EMERGENCY
BUS 20 AMP
CIRCUIT BREAKER
The two feed buses are normally powered by In order to permit logical grouping of circuit
the right and left generators and are tied to- breakers (e.g., left and right ignition), circuit
gether by the crossfeed bus. They may also re- connection is provided from the right or left
ceive power from the battery or an external feed extension bus to the opposite circuit-
power unit. breaker panel through the right and left
crossover buses.
The hot battery bus is always connected di-
rectly to the battery. It may receive power The hot battery bus items are:
from an external power unit, and, during nor-
mal operation, is powered from any generator. • Lights—Nose compartment light, cabin
entry door EXIT and white light, emer-
The crossfeed bus functions solely as a bus gency exit door EXIT and white lights,
tie connecting the hot battery bus, the emer- the two right wing walkway lights, the
gency bus, and the two feed buses into one in- optional right footwell strip lights, and
tegral system. the aft baggage compartment light.
• Voltmeter—It reads hot battery bus volt-
From each feed bus in the tail cone, an exten- age in BATT or EMER and zero voltage
sion bus provides distribution of power to in OFF. In OFF, the voltmeter will read
components through controls and circuit break- generator output voltage when L or R
ers in the cockpit. The left and right feed ex- GEN is momentarily selected on the
tension buses are located behind the pilot and voltage selector switch.
copilot circuit-breaker panels, respectively
(Figure 2-8 and 2-9). • ELT (optional)—If it is turned on by the
G switch, the ARM position uses hot
5 2 2 2 5 5 5 5 5 5 15 7.5 5 5
ANTI-ICE MISC INSTRUMENTS
L PITOT L AOA W/S BLEED W/S BLEED STBY DEFOG FRESH AIR R FUEL R R FW R R
STATIC ENGINE HTR AIR TEMP AIR GYRO CLOCK FAN FAN TEMP CONTROL BOOST SHUTOFF FIRE DET IGNITION
7.5 5 15 5 5 5 5 5 10 5 5 15 7.5 5 5
WARNING
R PITOT R TAIL W/S AS / ALT AIR AFT EVAP FWD EVAP BATTERY WARNING WARNING LANDING RUDDER
STATIC ENGINE DEICE ALCOHOL VIB FLT / HR COND FAN FAN TEMP LTS I LTS II GEAR BIAS
7.5 5 5 5 5 5 5 15 20 5 5 5 5 2
DC POWER L BUS LIGHTS SYSTEMS
L ANTI- WING L EL L THRUST ANG OF ENGINE PITCH SPEED BRAKE
START COLL NAV INSPECT PANEL PANEL ATTEN ATTACK SYNC TRIM BRAKE SYSTEM
L BUS
7.5 7.5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 15
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3
35 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
10 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2 2 2 5
COMM NAV NAV 2 XPDR ADF DME MKR TCAS FMS R ALT/ STDBY AHRS # AUDIO
2 2 CONVERT 2 2 2 BCN 1 1 L IAPS L FGC AS VIB HSI 1 1
10 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 7.5 5 5 5 5
*
PFD 1
COMM TELE STORM ADC DCP RAD # FMS # ADI HSI AHRS AUDIO
3 PHONE SCOPE 1 PRI HTR 1 ALT 2 R IAPS R FGC 2 2 2 2
5 5 5 5 10 10 5 5 5 7.5 5 5 5
PFD 2 MFD DC PWR - R BUS
IAPS ADC DCP GROUND R
RADAR HTR WARN 2 PRI HTR 2 PROX PRI HTR POWER START
R BUS
5 5 5 5 5 35
RIGHT FEED EXTENSION OPTIONS POWERED FROM # SNs 001 THROUGH 006—YELLOW
RH CROSSOVER SNs 007 AND SUBSEQUENT—BLUE
LEFT CROSSOVER
AVIONIC BUS OPTIONS ** AHRS NO. 2 ALSO USES STBY
ATTITUDE: 30-MINUTE BATTERY
EMERGENCY BUS
* AUDIO 1 ON EMER BUS
RESERVED IF BATT SWITCH IN EMER
5 2 2 2 5 5 5 5 5 5 15 7.5 5 5
ANTI-ICE MISC INSTRUMENTS
L PITOT L AOA W/S BLEED W/S BLEED STBY DEFOG FRESH AIR R FUEL R R FW R R
STATIC ENGINE HTR AIR TEMP AIR GYRO CLOCK FAN FAN TEMP CONTROL BOOST SHUTOFF FIRE DET IGNITION
7.5 5 15 5 5 5 5 5 10 5 5 15 7.5 5 5
WARNING
R PITOT R TAIL W/S AS / ALT AIR AFT EVAP FWD EVAP BATTERY WARNING WARNING LANDING RUDDER
STATIC ENGINE DEICE ALCOHOL VIB FLT / HR COND FAN FAN TEMP LTS I LTS II GEAR BIAS
7.5 5 5 5 5 5 5 15 20 5 5 5 5 2
DC POWER L BUS LIGHTS SYSTEMS
L ANTI- WING L EL L THRUST ANG OF ENGINE PITCH SPEED BRAKE
START COLL NAV INSPECT PANEL PANEL ATTEN ATTACK SYNC TRIM BRAKE SYSTEM
L BUS
7.5 7.5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 15
NO. 1 NO. 2 NO. 3
35 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5
10 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 2 2 2 5
COMM
2
NAV
2
NAV 2
CONVERT
XPDR
2
ADF
2
DME
2
MKR
BCN
TCAS
1
FMS
1 L IAPS L FGC
R ALT/
AS VIB
STDBY
HSI
AHRS
1
# AUDIO
1
10 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 7.5 5 5 5 5
*
PFD 1
COMM
3
TELE
PHONE
STORM
SCOPE
ADC
1 PRI HTR
DCP
1
RAD
ALT
# FMS
2
# R IAPS R FGC
ADI
2
HSI
2
AHRS
2
AUDIO
2
5 5 5 5 10 10 5 5 5 7.5 5 5 5
PFD 2 MFD DC PWR - R BUS
IAPS ADC DCP GROUND R
RADAR HTR WARN 2 PRI HTR 2 PROX PRI HTR POWER START
R BUS
5 5 5 5 5 35
RIGHT FEED EXTENSION OPTIONS POWERED FROM # SNs 001 THROUGH 006—YELLOW
RH CROSSOVER SNs 007 AND SUBSEQUENT—BLUE
LEFT CROSSOVER
AVIONIC BUS OPTIONS ** AHRS NO. 2 ALSO USES STBY
ATTITUDE: 30-MINUTE BATTERY
EMERGENCY BUS
* AUDIO 1 ON EMER BUS
RESERVED IF BATT SWITCH IN EMER
Should external power unit (EPU) voltage be Before starting the engines, the generator
excessive, an overvoltage sensor opens the switches should be rechecked for proper po-
external power relay and breaks the circuit to sition and battery voltage verified. The battery
the hot battery bus. External power disable switch should be in the BATT position in order
relays also disconnect the external power unit that power from the feed extension bus may
from the hot battery bus whenever a power close the start relay when the start button is
relay closes, bringing a generator online. There depressed. Depressing the start button also
is no reverse current protection between the activates the electric fuel boost pump, arms the
hot battery bus and the EPU. When the EPU ignition, and activates the engine instrument
relay is opened due to high voltage and the EPU and overhead floodlights to full bright.
voltage is returned to normal, the EPU plug
must be pulled and reconnected to close the Closure of the start relay, indicated by illumi-
EPU relay. nation of the start button white light, connects
hot battery bus power to the starter for engine
CAUTION rotation. At 8 to 12% turbine rpm (N 2 ) and
verification of N1 rotation, the throttle is moved
Some external power units do not from cutoff to idle. Fuel is now able to flow
have reverse current protection. If through the FCU (fuel control unit) to the fuel
the EPU is turned off while connected slinger and start nozzle at the same time the ig-
to the aircraft, rapid discharge and nition is activated by a throttle switch. A green
damage to the battery can result. Al- light directly above the ignition switch and
ways disconnect the EPU from the IGN appears on the MFD at the upper ITT
aircraft when not in use. scale and indicates voltage to one or both ex-
citer boxes. Within ten seconds, combustion
should occur as evidenced by rising ITT. As the
engine accelerates through 45% N 2 , the GCU
starter overspeed sensor automatically termi-
nates the start sequence. The electric boost
pump is deenergized, the GEN OFF and igni-
tion lights go out. The start relay opens, and
the engine instrument and overhead flood-
lights return to the FLOOD rheostat. The 45%
N 2 GEN overspeed sensor terminates the start
sequence and the engine accelerates to idle power starts are planned, the generator switches
rpm of 53.4% (53.4 ±2.5%) N 2 . should remain in the OFF position until exter-
nal power has been removed from the aircraft.
The starter-generator reverts to generator Otherwise, when the first generator comes on
operation, and the GCU closes the power relay line, the external power relay is opened and the
after start termination and when the genera- EPU is automatically disconnected from the hot
tor output equals or exceeds system voltage. battery bus, and the second engine start be-
comes a generator-assisted start. First engine
For a second engine start on the ground, the ground starts through 10,000 feet MSL may be
operating generator assists the battery in battery or EPU starts.
providing current to the starter. The operating
engine must be at idle rpm. When the
remaining start button is activated, the elec- ABNORMAL
tric boost pump operates, the ignition is armed, Battery overheat can result from an exces-
the engine instrument and overhead flood- sive rate of charge or discharge, or internal
lights illuminate to full bright, and both battery damage. The greatest damage which
start relays close (the light in each starter can result from a battery overheat lies in the
button illuminates). possibility of runaway heating, in which in-
ternal failures cause the heat to continue in-
When one generator power relay is closed and creasing out of control.
the other is energized as a starter, the battery
disable relay causes the battery relay to open A battery overtemperature
the circuit between the crossfeed bus and the BATT warning system is provided to
hot battery bus in order to protect the 225- O’TEMP
warn the pilot of abnormally
ampere current limiter. high battery temperatures. An internal temper-
ature of 145°F (63°C) will illuminate a flash-
An engine start accomplished in flight using the i n g r e d BAT T O ’ T E M P a n d a f l a s h i n g
start button is a battery start only. Generator- MASTER WARNING light.
assist capability is disabled by the squat switch
when airborne. Only the associated start relay If the temperature reaches
closes, the boost pump on that side activates, > 160° 160°F (71°C) the red >160°
the ignition circuit to that engine arms, and the light and BATT O’TEMP light
engine instrument floodlight illuminates. The will both flash. The master warning will also
only difference between this start in flight and flash (if previously reset). When an overheat
one accomplished on the ground with one gen- condition exists, the battery switch should be
erator on line is that the start relay on the same placed in the EMER position to open the bat-
side as the operating generator will not close. tery relay. If the amps drop slightly when the
This isolation of the start circuit from the op- battery switch is moved to EMER, this is con-
erating generator and buses in flight is through firmation that the battery relay opened and
left squat switch logic and is required by cer- isolation occurred. The drop in amps on the
tification regulations. The protection circuit ammeter was the charging current flowing to
for the 225-ampere current limiter is the same the malfunctioning battery. If no amp drop is
as previously described. observed, the view shifts to the voltmeter to
see a one volt drop in 30 seconds to two min-
An external power unit may also be used for utes. A one volt drop from 29 volts to 28 volts
engine starts. However, prior to use, the unit over 30 seconds to two minutes confirms the
should be checked for voltage regulation (28 battery relay opened and isolation took place.
to 29 volts maximum) and an availability of 800 If so, the battery switch is selected to OFF. If
to 1,100 amperes maximum. When external
at the end of two minutes the voltage is still It self-tests all LEDs at power-up. Flashing
29 volts, the battery relay is stuck or welded LEDs can be extinguished by resetting the ap-
closed. The checklist requires the battery propriate generator switch three times within
switch to be selected to BATT so the battery three seconds if no fault exist.
disconnect switch circuit can function.
Loss of a single generator is an-
The battery disconnect switch is selected to GEN nunciated by a flashing amber
OFF
DISC, opening the battery disconnect relay. L or R GEN OFF light and a
This stops generator current flow into the bat- L R steady MASTER CAUTION
tery and allows the battery cool-down time. If light. Dual generator failure is
the pilot cannot get the charging current off of annunciated with flashing L and R GEN OFF
the battery using the battery relay, then the bat- lights, a steady MASTER CAUTION, and a
tery disconnect relay on the ground-side of the flashing red MASTER WARNING.
battery should be used to get the current off.
The voltmeter is inoperative with the battery If unable to restore any generator, the “Loss of
switch off. Both Generators” checklist will direct the pilot
to place BATTERY SWITCH to EMER. In this
If the speed-sensing switch fails to terminate situation, the pilot would have the emergency
start sequence, the START DISG button can be bus items, the standby vertical gyro, and an
used to terminate the start. Its use causes no emergency battery pack for cabin lighting and
damage to any component in the system. The egress through the cabin escape hatch.
GCU then permits the generator to come on line
after the start sequence has been terminated. Should it be necessary to disable the circuit-
breaker panel at the pilot position (left CB
Monitoring the ammeters may provide an in- panel), it can be accomplished by pulling
dication of impending generator problems. the three 75-ampere circuit breakers labeled
Ampere readings may indicate unparalleled L BUS NO 1, NO 2, NO 3, under DC power
operation if they are different by more than L BUS. It must be noted that, to totally dis-
10% of the total load. able the circuit-breaker panel, the following
emergency bus items must be pulled:
When a flashing L or R GEN
GEN OFF light illuminates on the • L STBY N1
OFF
annunciator panel, a check of • R PITOT STATIC
L R the voltmeter indicates whether
the field relay or only the power • AS/ALT VIB
relay has opened. An open field relay could be • LANDING GEAR (WARNING)
caused by a feeder fault (short circuit), over-
voltage, or by actuation of the engine fire • FLOOD
switch. A tripped field relay is indicated by
near zero voltage; it may possibly be reset • FLAP CONTROL
with the generator switch. An undervoltage or • HYD CONTROL
reverse current causes the generator control
unit to open the power relay. If voltage is ob- • GEAR CONTROL
served on the voltmeter when the affected gen-
erator is selected with the voltage selector Also, the L CB panel 35-ampere circuit
switch, generator reset is not probable. breaker, on the lower right side of the copilot
circuit-breaker panel, must be pulled to dis-
The GCUs have four built-in test equipment able the right crossover bus items.
(BITE) lights for fault detection. GCU fault
lights may indicate a GCU fault, overvoltage, The reverse procedure is necessary to disable
a ground fault, or a system wiring problem. the copilot circuit-breaker panel, and because
the emergency bus is located behind the copi- failed prior to ground start, neither engine can
lot panel, SEVEN component circuit breakers be started until the limiter is replaced.
must also be pulled:
The flashing AFT J-BOX or CB amber light
• COMM 1
indicates the left or right start circuit breaker
• NAV 1 on the aft J-box has popped. This would deen-
ergize the starting PC board and no engine
• R STBY N1
start would be possible. Try resetting the cir-
• STDBY HSI cuit breakers (if popped). If unable to reset,
circuit-breaker maintenance is required.
• AHRS 2
• AUDIO 1 When the battery switch is in the EMER posi-
tion, emergency DC power is supplied from the
• AUDIO 2
hot battery bus through the emergency power
relay to the emergency bus circuit breakers on
NOTE each cockpit circuit-breaker panel. If the bat-
When the three 75-ampere main bus tery switch is in the BATT position, generator
breakers are pulled, the crossover power is supplied through the battery relay
bus to the opposite circuit-breaker from the crossfeed bus to the hot battery bus
panel is also disabled. and charges the battery. The emergency bus is
powered from the crossfeed bus while the bat-
tery switch is in either BATT or OFF.
Failure of a 225-ampere cur-
AFT rent limiter can be detected by
J-BOX Power is available to these items (see Table 2-
the AFT J-BOX LMT annunci- 1) for a minimum of 30 minutes from a nor-
LMT CB ator and during the generator mally charged battery with the generators OFF
check which is accomplished and the battery switch in EMER. The pilot
after engine start. When one generator switch audio panel is normally powered by normal DC
is placed to OFF, the other generator should but is powered by the hot battery bus when the
pick up the entire system load as indicated on battery switch is in EMER.
the respective ammeter. If this does not occur,
a failed current limiter could be the cause. If In the event of loss of normal DC power and the
this is the case, when the generator on the side selection of emergency on the battery switch,
with the failed limiter is selected to OFF, the communications can be maintained in the COMM
buses on that side lose power. This is most eas- 1 transmit and receive position with the speaker
ily detected by observing the engine instru- system or headphones (Figure 2-12). The use of
ments. The aircraft should not be flown in this EMER/COMM 1 might conserve battery power
condition. If a 225-amp current limiter has but necessitates the use of headsets.
QUESTIONS
1. A good battery should supply power to the 6. If the generators are not operating, the
hot battery bus and the emergency bus voltmeter reads battery voltage when the
for approximately: battery switch is in:
A. 2 hours A. OFF
B. 1 hour B. BATT
C. 30 minutes C. EMER
D. 10 minutes D. B and C
2. The crossfeed bus serves as: 7. The light in each engine start button
A. A power-off DC source illuminates to indicate:
B. An emergency power source A. Starting is complete
C. An extension bus B. Opening of the start relay
D. A generator tie bus C. Closing of the start relay
D. Generator disconnect
3. In flight, with the generators on line, the
battery is isolated from any charging 8. The generator field relay opens when:
source when the battery switch is in: A. An internal feeder fault is sensed
A. OFF B. An overvoltage condition is sensed
B. BATT C. An engine fire switch is activated
C. EMER D. All of the above
D. Both A and C
9. If a battery start is intended, the genera-
4. If manual termination of a start sequence tor switches should be placed to:
is desired, the switch to press is: A. OFF
A. ENGINE START B. GEN
B. START DISG C. RESET
C. L START D. ON
D. R START
10. With the battery as the only source of
5. The voltage read on the voltmeter with power and the battery switch in the OFF
the selector switch in BATT is sensed position, the bus(es) powered are:
from the: A. Crossfeed bus, hot battery bus
A. Crossfeed bus B. Hot battery bus
B. L feed bus C. Emergency bus, crossfeed bus
C. Hot battery bus D. Emergency bus, crossfeed bus, hot
D. R feed bus battery bus
11. With the battery as the only source of power 15. Regarding the engine starting sequence
and the battery switch in the EMER posi- (battery start on the ground):
tion, the following bus(es) are powered: A. It is normally terminated by the
A. Crossfeed bus, hot battery bus pilot with the START DISG button.
B. Emergency bus, crossfeed bus, hot B. The boost pumps and ignition
battery bus switches must both be in the ON po-
C. Emergency bus only sition before the start button is de-
D. Emergency bus, hot battery bus pressed.
C. A minimum of 57% N 2 is required
on the operating engine prior to
12. With the battery as the only source of starting the second engine.
power and the battery switch in the BATT D. It is terminated normally by the 45%
position, the following condition exists: N2 speed-sensing switch on the
A. All DC buses are powered for 10 starter-generator.
minutes.
B. All buses except the emergency bus
16. The most correct statement is:
are powered.
C. Only the left and right main DC A. The illumination of the engine
buses are powered. START DISG button is a function of
the panel lights control night-dim
D. Only the battery, emergency, and hot
switch.
battery buses receive power.
B. The generator switches are placed
in the OFF position for an EPU
13. The primary item that receives power start.
directly from the hot battery bus is: C. A failed left 225-ampere current
A. Seat belt sign limiter prevents starting of the left
B. Nose baggage compartment light engine.
C. L pitot-static heater D. All of the above.
D. Audio 1 and Audio 2
17. With the electrical system operating nor-
mally (both generators on the line with the
14. In flight, an engine start accomplished battery switch in BATT):
with the start button (not a windmilling
start): A. The generator control units (GCUs)
serve to automatically regulate,
A. Is a generator-assist start to prevent parallel, and protect the generators.
excessive battery drain
B. The battery will supply power to the
B. Is not possible; only windmilling hot battery and emergency buses.
air starts are possible
C. Each generator will supply power to
C. Is a battery start as the generator the equipment on its respective feed
assist is disabled in flight to protect and feed extension buses.
the operating generator
D. The voltage of the battery and gener-
D. Must be manually terminated by the ators may be read by momentarily
starter disengage button. selecting the desired position with the
voltage selector switch.
18. Placing the battery switch in EMER with 21. The NiCad BATT O’TEMP light comes on
the generators on the line: steady and remains steady when the flash-
A. Will cause loss of power to the ing MASTER WARNING is pressed out:
emergency bus since the generators A. A fire and explosion hazard now
are on the line exists.
B. The emergency bus is powered by B. Move the battery switch to EMER
the battery and see the amps and volts drop.
C. Will still provide charging power to C. Select BATT switch to OFF.
the battery D. All of the above.
D. Should result in the battery voltage
remaining at 29.0 volts
22. Both engines are started and the AFT
J-BOX LMT light is observed on:
19. Loss of both generators: A. You are airworthy; go ahead and fly.
A. R and L GEN OFF annunciator light B. The start relay is stuck closed.
illuminates. C. A 225 amp current limiter is blown
B. R and L GEN OFF annunciator light repair this before flight.
will not illuminate, but the MAS- D. If a generator fails, the other one will
TER CAUTION will flash. be able to pick up the load.
C. R and L GEN OFF annunciator light
and MASTER CAUTION lights
illuminate. 23. The battery disconnect switch is used for:
D. R and L GEN OFF annunciator light A. Stuck start relay
and MASTER CAUTION and warn- B. Stuck battery relay during battery
ing lights illuminate. overtemperature
C. Test
20. During engine start, the speed sensing D. All of the above.
switch will terminate the start sequence
thus removing power from the:
A. Starter-generator, engine-driven
fuel pump, and the fuel firewall
shutoff valve
B. Electric fuel boost pump, ignitors,
and the starter-generator
C. Electric fuel boost pump, motive
flow shutoff valve, and the fuel low
pressure sensor
D. Starter-generator, generator power
relay, and manual fuel shutoff valve
CHAPTER 3
LIGHTING
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 3-1
GENERAL .............................................................................................................................. 3-1
INTERIOR LIGHTING .......................................................................................................... 3-2
Cockpit Lighting.............................................................................................................. 3-2
Passenger Compartment Lighting.................................................................................... 3-4
Emergency Lighting ........................................................................................................ 3-7
Baggage Compartment Lighting ..................................................................................... 3-7
EXTERIOR LIGHTING ......................................................................................................... 3-8
Navigation Lights ............................................................................................................ 3-8
Anticollision Lights ......................................................................................................... 3-8
Beacon Light.................................................................................................................... 3-8
Landing/Recognition/Taxi Lights .................................................................................... 3-8
Wing Inspection Light ..................................................................................................... 3-9
Tail Floodlights (Optional) ............................................................................................ 3-11
Automatic Pulselite System........................................................................................... 3-11
QUESTIONS......................................................................................................................... 3-12
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
3-1 Interior Lighting Controls ........................................................................................ 3-2
3-2 Cockpit Floodlights.................................................................................................. 3-3
3-3 Map Lights and Controls ......................................................................................... 3-3
3-4 Typical Electroluminescent Control Panel Lighting................................................ 3-3
3-5 PFD/MFD–DIM Rheostat........................................................................................ 3-4
3-6 Passenger Reading Lights ........................................................................................ 3-4
3-7 Cabin Lighting Control ON ..................................................................................... 3-5
3-8 Entry Light Switch ................................................................................................... 3-5
3-9 Entry or Emergency Exit Lights .............................................................................. 3-6
3-10 Lighting Control Switches ....................................................................................... 3-6
3-11 Seat Belt/No Smoking Light.................................................................................... 3-7
3-12 Optional Aisle (Footwell) Lights ............................................................................. 3-7
3-13 Nose Baggage Compartment Light and Switch....................................................... 3-7
3-14 Aft Baggage Compartment Lighting ....................................................................... 3-8
3-15 Exterior Lighting Locations ..................................................................................... 3-9
3-16 Exterior Lighting Switches ...................................................................................... 3-9
3-17 Navigation, Anticollision, and Beacon Lights....................................................... 3-10
3-18 Landing Lights (Recessed) .................................................................................... 3-10
3-19 Pilot Switch Panel.................................................................................................. 3-10
3-20 Wing Inspection Light ........................................................................................... 3-10
3-21 Optional Tail Floodlights ....................................................................................... 3-11
CHAPTER 3
LIGHTING
EXIT
INTRODUCTION
Lighting on the Citation CJ2 is used to illuminate the cockpit area and all flight instru-
ments. The majority of the instruments are internally lit. For general illumination, flood-
lights and a map light are conveniently located at the pilot and copilot positions. Standard
passenger advisory lights are available for the cabin area, and emergency exit lights are
located over the cabin door and emergency exit. Exterior lighting consists of the naviga-
tion, anticollision (strobes), landing, wing inspection, and red flashing beacon lights.
GENERAL
Aircraft lighting is divided into interior and panels, and map lights. Cabin lighting consists
exterior lighting. Interior lighting is further di- of passenger reading lights, floodlights illu-
vided into cockpit, cabin, and emergency light- minating the main cabin door and emergency
ing. Cockpit lighting consists of instrument exit, an aft compartment light, lighted signs,
panel lights, floodlights, electroluminescent and optional indirect fluorescent lights.
STANDBY INSTRUMENT
FLOOD LIGHT
Figure 3-2. Cockpit Flood Lights
MAP LIGHT RHEOSTAT (EACH SIDE)
Control Panel Lights Figure 3-3. Map Lights and Controls
The control of panel lighting is provided by
electroluminescent light panels, consisting of
a layer of phosphor sandwiched between two
electrodes and encapsulated between layers of
plastic (Figure 3-4). White lettering on a gray
background is used on the panel faces.
CP PFD
DIM SWITCH
A microswitch mounted on the left and right controlled by a NAV switch with ON and OFF
baggage door hinge turns the light off regard- positions. The NAV circuit breaker is on the
less of rocker switch position when both left circuit-breaker panel.
baggage doors are closed.
ANTICOLLISION LIGHTS
Aft Baggage
The anticollision lights are white strobe lights
Compartment Lighting mounted in each wingtip (Figure 3-17) and are
A manual toggle switch mounted on the for- controlled with the ANTI-COLL switch lo-
ward side of the access door frame in the cated on the instrument panel (Figure 3-16).
tailcone (Figure 3-14) controls DC power to The switch furnishes DC power to the anti-
the light assembly. collision lights. Each light has its own power
supply. The ANTI-COLL circuit breaker is on
A microswitch will turn the light off regard- the left circuit-breaker panel.
less of switch position when the door is closed.
BEACON LIGHT
The beacon light is a red flashing beacon
mounted on top of the vertical stabilizer (Fig-
ure 3-17) controlled by the BEACON switch
with ON and OFF positions (Figure 3-16).
The BEACON circuit breaker is on the left cir-
cuit-breaker panel.
LANDING/RECOGNITION/TAXI
LIGHTS
Figure 3-14. Aft Baggage The combination LANDING/RECOGNI-
Compartment Lighting TION/TAXI lights are mounted below the
fuselage in front of the bottom fairing (Figure
3-18). Each light is a fixed-position, sealed
EXTERIOR LIGHTING beam lamp, controlled by separate switches lo-
cated on the pilot switch panel (Figure 3-19).
The exterior lighting system consists of nav- The landing lights are protected behind tem-
igation, landing/recognition/taxi, anticolli- pered glass covers and are situated and in-
sion, flashing red beacon, and wing inspection stalled so the crew is shielded from the glare
lights. The exterior lighting system provides and halation from the lamps. The LANDING
necessary illumination for aircraft operation selection causes the brightest illumination for
during the day or night. Exterior lighting lo- landing; RECOG/TAXI position inserts a
cations are illustrated in Figure 3-15 and ex- resistor into the circuit causing a lower illu-
terior lighting controls are shown in Figure mination. Lamp life can be significantly ex-
3-16. tended by using the RECOG/TAXI position.
The LANDING position is to be used just
prior to takeoff roll and secured shortly after
NAVIGATION LIGHTS landing. An optional pulse light switch is avail-
A green navigation light is installed on the able which makes the landing lights pulse on
right wingtip, a red light on the left, and a and off. Landing light circuit breakers are on
white light on top of the upper vertical stabi- the aft J-box.
lizer (Figure 3-17). The navigation lights are
BEACON NAVIGATION
LIGHTS
NAVIGATION LIGHT
ANTICOLLISION
LIGHT
BEACON
NAVIGATION
(TAIL) LIGHT
Normal Procedures
Before Landing
Select LANDING L AND R–ON prior to 300
feet AGL.
NOTE
The RECOG/TAXI lights must be
ON for the automatic Pulselite
system to operate.
Figure 3-21. Optional Tail Floodlights
QUESTIONS
1. The lighting rheostat labeled “LEFT” 4. The map lights are controlled with
controls: rheostats located on the:
A. Pilot instrument panel lights A. Center pedestal
B. Center instrument panel lights B. Pilot and copilot instrument panels
C. Copilot instrument panel lights C. Overhead lights panel
D. Both circuit-breaker panel lights D. Forward side of the left and right side
consoles
2. The lighting rheostat that controls the
electroluminescent lighting is labeled: 5. When the CABIN LIGHT switch is
A. LEFT pressed the first time, the fluorescent
lights illuminate:
B. CENTER
C. RIGHT A. Full bright
D. EL B. Dim
C. And dim should be used during engine
ground starts
3. Turning the NIGHT DIM master switch D. After three seconds
to ON:
A. Activates the control rheostats
6. When the landing gear is retracted, the
B. Dims the annunciator panel lights
landing lights:
C. Illuminates the STARTER DISEN-
GAGE button A. Automatically extinguish
D. All of the above. B. R e m a i n i l l u m i n a t e d a n d m u s t b e
manually switched OFF
C. Are selected to LAND for longest life
D. Alternately flash right, left, etc.
CHAPTER 4
MASTER WARNING SYSTEMS
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 4-1
GENERAL .............................................................................................................................. 4-1
ANNUNCIATOR PANEL....................................................................................................... 4-2
MASTER WARNING RESET LIGHTS (RED)..................................................................... 4-2
MASTER CAUTION RESET LIGHTS (AMBER) ............................................................... 4-3
INTENSITY CONTROL ........................................................................................................ 4-3
TEST FUNCTION .................................................................................................................. 4-3
ILLUMINATION CAUSES .................................................................................................... 4-3
AUDIO WARNING SYSTEM................................................................................................ 4-3
QUESTIONS ......................................................................................................................... 4-11
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
4-1 Rotary Test Switch ................................................................................................... 4-3
4-2 Annunciator Panel.................................................................................................... 4-4
TABLES
Table Title Page
4-1 Annunciator Illumination Causes ............................................................................ 4-5
4-2 Rotary Test Indications ............................................................................................ 4-8
4-3 PFD Flags and Warnings ....................................................................................... 4-10
CHAPTER 4
MASTER WARNING SYSTEMS
INTRODUCTION
The master warning systems on the Citation CJ2 provide a warning of aircraft equip-
ment malfunctions, indication of an unsafe operating condition requiring immediate at-
tention, and indication that some specific systems are in operation.
GENERAL
The master warning and master caution annun- WARNING, CAUTION, and ADVISORY. All
ciator panel light system consists of two mas- except those associated with Electronic Flight
ter warning light switches and two master Instrument System (EFIS), autopilot, avionics
caution light switches, and an annunciator and engine fire warning/suppression are lo-
panel light cluster which provides a visual cated in the glareshield annunciator panel.
indication to the pilots of certain conditions The abnormal and emergency procedures in
and/or functions of selected systems. Each this section are keyed, where applicable to
annunciator segment has a legend which these annunciators. Warning lights are gener-
illuminates to indicate an individual system ally red (except failure of both generators). Red
fault. Annunciator lights are classified as lights indicate a warning malfunction which
requires immediate corrective action. The red ADVISORY lights are white and do not trig-
warning lights in the annunciator panel will ger a MASTER WARNING but will cause a
cause the MASTER WARNING RESET lights MASTER CAUTION when the aircraft is in
to flash. Failure of both generators (amber flight and the thrust attenuators are unlocked.
annunciators) is a red function and triggers the When an advisory light illuminates, the check-
MASTER WARNING lights. Illumination of list may require an action. If required, the ac-
the L or R ENGINE FIRE light does not trig- t i o n w i l l b e f o u n d i n t h e “A b n o r m a l
ger the MASTER WARNING lights. Procedures” check list or in the AFM.
L INTENSITY CONTROL
GEN
The annunciator lights will dim automa-
tically when the PANEL LIGHT CONTROL
TEST NIGHT/DIM switch is placed in the ON position.
OFF FIRE
ANNU WARN
TEST FUNCTION
ANTI LDG A rotary test switch (Figure 4-1) is located on
SKID GEAR the left side of the pilot instrument panel.
Positioning the switch to ANNU causes all
OVER BATT annunciators, MASTER CAUTION, and the
SPEED TEMP MASTER WARNING lights to illuminate.
Illumination verifies only annunciator lamp in-
W/S TEMP AOA tegrity. Some other associated system lights
RUDDER also illuminate when this switch is activated.
BIAS
VF > 160° L R L R L R L R L R L R
I
DA
E I F/W EMERG W/S AIR P/S HTR ENG WING BLD AIR TAIL DEICE TAIL DEICE
OL SHUT OFF PRESS ON O’HEAT OFF ANTI-ICE ANTI-ICE O’HEAT FAIL PRESS
FRESH AOA HTR AIR DUCT
AF L R L R L R L R L R L R
UA AIR FAIL O’HEAT
D I
I GEN AFT DOOR NOT FLAPS PWR BRK HYD FLOW HYD PRESS ATTEN ATTN STOW
OL OFF J-BOX LOCKED > 35° LOW PRESS LOW ON UNLOCK SELECT
DOOR ANTI-SKID SPD BRK GROUND
L R LMT CB L R L R
SEAL INOP EXTEND IDLE
FlightSafety
international
Figure 4-2. Annunciator Panel
FlightSafetyinternational
The red oil pressure warning light The white ATTN STOW
advises that oil pressure is below ATTN STOW SELECTED annunciator indicates
OIL PRESS
25 psi in the left or right engine. SELECTED that the stow position has been
WARN
Illumination of either light also selected on the thrust attenuator
triggers the MASTER WARNING switch. The thrust attenuators will
L R
lights flashing. The optional voice not operate.
annunciation advises “Left Engine Oil
Pressure” or “Right Engine Oil The external yellow RUDDER
RUDDER BIAS light illuminates during rotary
Pressure”.
BIAS test to indicate the rudder bias
solenoid is spring loaded to the
FUEL The amber FUEL GAUGE light
tailcone ambient pressure
indicates that a fault has been
GAUGE reference or bias not available
detected in the respective fuel
position. The light is out when the
gauging system.
L R rudder bias solenoid is energized
or during loss of normal DC power.
The amber GEN OFF light advises The white HYD PRESS ON light
GEN that the associated generator power HYD PRESS indicates the hydraulic bypass
OFF relay is open. Illumination of both ON valve is closed and the system is
lights will trigger the MASTER pressurized.
L R WARNING lights flashing. The
optional voice annunciation advises The white SPD BRK EXTEND light
“Generator Failure” for a single SPD BRK advises that the left and right
GEN OFF light. EXTEND speedbrakes are fully extended.
The amber AFT J-BOX LMT light The white ATTEN UNLOCK light
AFT advises that the aft J-box left or ATTEN indicates that the respective thrust
J-BOX right 225A current limiter circuit UNLOCK attenuator is not in the stowed
breaker is opened, indicating (locked) position.
LMT CB probable blown current limiter. L R
The amber DOOR SEAL light The amber ENG ANTI-ICE light
DOOR indicates a loss of 23 psi service air ENG indicates engine inlet temperature
SEAL pressure to primary cabin door seal. ANTI-ICE is below safe level for satisfactory
The light indicates door seal pressure ice protection. The light illuminates
is 5.5 psi above cabin pressure. L R steady one minute after the cowl
undertemperature of 10°C (50°F). If
The white TAIL DEICE PRESS light still undertemperature after 2
TAIL DEICE indicates proper boot inflation
PRESS minutes, the light flashes and
pressure: L 6 seconds ON, then 6 MASTER CAUTION comes on
seconds OUT; then R 6 seconds ON,
steady.
L R then OUT for the balance of 3 minutes
and cycles again, while the switch is
The amber WING ANTI-ICE
ON. In manual, both lights are ON. WING
indicates wing leading edge is
ANTI-ICE
undertemperature, overtemperature,
The amber TAIL DEICE fail light or when in flight under 75% N2 rpm.
TAIL DEICE illuminates during any one of the L R There is a one-minute delay for the
FAIL following conditions: 1) when either light to come on steady for under-
the voltage to the valve or pressure speed in flight, or undertemperature.
to the deice boots are not what If still undertemperature or under-
they should be during a boot speed after 2 minutes, the light
inflation or deflation cycle, 2) when flashes and MASTER CAUTION
the clock to the deice timer has comes on steady.
stopped, or 3) when the TAIL
DE-ICE circuit breaker is pulled.
The amber BLD AIR O’HEAT light
The amber W/S AIR O’HEAT light BLD AIR indicates that a malfunction has
W/S AIR advises that bleed air to the O’HEAT caused the bleed air leaving the
O’HEAT windshield exceeds safe temperature respective precooler to exceed
limits 149°C (300°F) with the control L R allowable temperature of 293°C
switch in HI or LOW. With the switch (560°F). It goes out on cool down
in OFF, it indicates the shutoff valve below 282°C (540°F).
has failed open or is leaking bleed air,
allowing line pressure to exceed 5 psi. The amber AIR DUCT O’HEAT light
AIR DUCT
The amber AOA HTR FAIL light advises that the temperature in the
O’HEAT
AOA HTR advises that the heating element in duct leading to the cabin exceeds
FAIL the angle-of-attack probe is safe limits, over 149°C (300°F).
inoperative, or the pitot heat switch The amber VIDEO FAIL light
is off. VF indicates failure of the visual annun-
I A ciator test. Pressing either of the
P/S HTR The amber P/S HTR OFF light D I MASTER WARNING RESET
OFF advises that the PITOT HEAT switch EL switches for 2 to 3 seconds will cause
is off or, if the switch is on, that O the annunciator to leave the test
power has been lost to any pitot tube
L R heater or any static port heaters.
mode and resume operation until
AF cause of the test failure can be
UA determined.
On the ground, the white GND IDLE D I
GND I L The amber AUDIO FAIL light
light illuminates with NORMAL
IDLE selected on the GND IDLE switch. In O indicates failure of the audio annun-
flight, it means the engines may ciator test. Caution: one or more
reduce to ground idle speed if audio warnings may be inoperative.
throttles are reduced to idle stop.
ROTARY SWITCH
INDICATION
POSITION
OFF The red light is extinguished and the test system is inoperative. When the rotary test
switch is not off, the red light indicates you are in the test modes.
FIRE WARN Both L or R red ENGINE FIRE lights illuminate and associated aural warning will be
heard. The voice annunciation LEFT ENGINE FIRE/RIGHT ENGINE FIRE will be heard
(voice system only). Avionics power must be on or a headset must be worn to hear the
audio warnings.
LDG GEAR The green NOSE, LH, RH, and the red GEAR UNLOCKED lights, and associated aural
warning tone or the voice annunciation LANDING GEAR (voice system) will be heard. The
voice announcement or tone may be silenced by pressing the horn silence button on the
landing gear panel if flap position is 15° or less. Avionics power must be on or a headset
must be worn to hear the audio warnings.
BATT TEMP The BATT O’TEMP light first flashes for over 145°F then followed by the whole light
segment flashing for >160°F to show circuit integrity. The MASTER WARNING lights
illuminate, accompanied with associated aural warning. Avionics power must be on or a
headset must be worn to hear the audio warnings. The BATT O’TEMP is on for eight
seconds after it is deselected.
AOA The stick shaker will operate. The angle-of-attack meter needle rotates past the red area.
The indexer red chevron light (optional) will flash on and off. Avionics power must be on to
test the EADI and indexer functions. THE AOA1 and AOA2 red lights in the AFDs are on.
RUDDER BIAS Moving the rotary test knob to the RUDDER BIAS position deenergizes the control valve,
spring-loading the valve to the bleed air not available position. The crew detects the
illumination of the amber RUDDER BIAS remote annunciator (and MASTER CAUTION)
indicating the valve has failed to the bleed air not available position. Selecting the rotary
test knob to any other position energizes the valve back to the normal bias available
position, extinguishing the RUDDER BIAS annunciator.
W/S TEMP The W/S AIR O-HEAT light should illuminate when LOW or HI is selected on the
windshield bleed-air switch, and the bleed air-solenoid control valve closes. The MASTER
CAUTION light will illuminate after a four-second timer delay in HI and LOW positions.
Check both HI and LOW positions.
OVER SPEED The audible Mach warning signal sounds (four rapid chirps and a pause, then repeats
eight times). Avionics power must be on or a headset worn to hear the audio warnings.
With the optional voice annunciatorion system, a series of ten tones will be heard four
times.
ROTARY SWITCH
INDICATION
POSITION
Selecting the ANTISKID test position initiates a full dynamic self-test of the digital
ANTISKID
anti-skid system. The ANTISKID INOP light flashes about 6 seconds and goes out.
The annunciator panel video and audio fail lights illuminate. The annunciator panel
lights illuminate by rows. The MASTER WARNING and MASTER CAUTION lights
repetitively flash four times and pause as the top row illuminates and goes out. The
MASTER WARNING and MASTER CAUTION lights again flash four times and pause
as the middle row of lights illuminate and go out, repeating for the lower row, top row,
etc., until any other rotary test position is selected. The MASTER WARNING and
MASTER CAUTION lights cannot be reset during this test. The standby N1 LCDs flash
ANNU 88.8’s for 15 seconds, then two zeros. The mode select panel(s) yellow button lights
illuminate. The FAN 1 (COMM 1) and FAN 2 (COMM 2) amber lights illuminate. The
standard altimeter ALT amber light comes on steady. The optional Honeywell Ametek
AM-250 round digital altimeter amber light is on steady. Extinguished GPWS and DME
lights are tested. The RUDDER BIAS amber light and tilt panel compressor on green
light illuminates. The autopilot panel yellow TURB light is on and the XFR button light, if
installed. If a voice annunciation is installed, a voice annunciation TEST will be heard
periodically. The three optional AOA indexer lights illuminate steady. The Davtron and
digital cabin pressure controller lights are not tested. If all tests are successfully
completed with the voice system, READY will be heard at the end.
QUESTIONS
1. An annunciator panel light will 3. The rotary test switch:
extinguish: A. Illuminates all annunciators in the
A. When pressed ANNU position
B. Upon landing B. Is spring-loaded to OFF
C. When the malfunction is corrected C. Only illuminates all red annunciators
D. If the master warning system is reset in the ANNU position
under all conditions D. Only illuminates all amber annunci-
ators in the ANNU position
2. The MASTER WARNING lights illumi-
nate flashing: 4. Amber annunciator lights illuminate:
A. When any annunciator panel light A. Steady
illuminates B. Flashing, then go steady when the
B. When a red annunciator panel light il- steady MASTER CAUTION switch-
luminates light is pressed out
C. When both the L and R GEN OFF C. And go out only when they burn out
annunciators illuminate D. Then are pressed out by the MASTER
D. Both B and C WARNING switchlights
CHAPTER 5
FUEL SYSTEM
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 5-1
GENERAL .............................................................................................................................. 5-1
DESCRIPTION AND OPERATION ...................................................................................... 5-2
Fuel Storage ..................................................................................................................... 5-2
MAJOR COMPONENTS FUEL TRANSFER SYSTEM—NORMAL OPERATION ......... 5-4
Boost Pumps .................................................................................................................... 5-4
Ejector Pumps .................................................................................................................. 5-4
Fuel Transfer Valve .......................................................................................................... 5-4
Fuel Heaters and Sump Temperature Sensors ................................................................. 5-4
SHUTOFF VALVES................................................................................................................ 5-5
Firewall ............................................................................................................................ 5-5
Controls............................................................................................................................ 5-5
INDICATING SYSTEM ......................................................................................................... 5-5
Quantity Indication .......................................................................................................... 5-5
Fuel Quantity Signal Conditioner.................................................................................... 5-6
Annunciator Lights .......................................................................................................... 5-7
OPERATION ........................................................................................................................... 5-7
Fuel Transfer System Operation ...................................................................................... 5-9
FUEL SERVICING............................................................................................................... 5-11
General........................................................................................................................... 5-11
Safety Precautions ......................................................................................................... 5-11
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
5-1 Right Wing Tank ...................................................................................................... 5-2
5-2 Fuel Vent Scoop (NACA) ....................................................................................... 5-2
5-3 Fuel Port Assemblies................................................................................................ 5-3
5-4 Fuel Filler Cap ......................................................................................................... 5-3
5-5 Three Drains Per Wing............................................................................................. 5-3
5-6 Ejector Pump............................................................................................................ 5-4
5-7 Fuel System Controls............................................................................................... 5-5
5-8 Normal MFD Fuel Quantity and Fuel Flow Display............................................... 5-6
5-9 MFD/PFD Reversion Switch and Compressed Displays ........................................ 5-6
5-10 Fuel Quantity Signal Conditioner ............................................................................ 5-6
5-11 Fuel Transfer System—Normal Operation .............................................................. 5-8
5-12 Fuel Transfer Switch ................................................................................................ 5-9
5-13 Fuel Transfer System—Fuel Transfer Operations.................................................. 5-10
5-14 Filler Port ............................................................................................................... 5-11
CHAPTER 5
FUEL SYSTEM
4 6
MAIN
FUEL
2 8
LBS X 100
0 10
INTRODUCTION
This chapter presents the fuel system of the Citation CJ2. The fuel transfer system is
used for both normal feed and fuel balancing operations.
GENERAL
Each wing tank provides fuel to its respective on the multifunction display (MFD) or primary
engine. Fuel flow to the engines is accom- flight displays (PFDs) if reverted. The airframe
plished with an electrically driven boost pump fuel system up to the engine-driven fuel pump
and an ejector pump, one in each tank. The sys- is presented in this chapter. For description
tem is controlled by switches and a selector on and operation of the engine fuel system, refer
the pilot instrument panel, and is monitored to Chapter 7, “Powerplant.”
by colored annunciator lights and fuel displays
L R
ENGINE ENGINE
TRANSFER FIRE FIRE
EJECTOR
PUMP TRANSFER
EJECTOR
FUEL LOW FUEL TRANSFER PUMP FUEL LOW
LEVEL OFF FUEL BOOST LEVEL
L R L ON R L R
L R L R
SUMP TRANSFER
SUMP
PRIMARY VALVE
PRIMARY
EJECTOR FAILSAFE
EJECTOR
PUMP CLOSED FUEL FILTER FUEL PUMP
BYPASS GAUGE
LEFT FUEL L R L R RIGHT FUEL
FIREWALL LEFT RIGHT FIREWALL
SHUTOFF BOOST PUMP TEMP TEMP BOOST PUMP SHUTOFF
F/W FUEL
SENSOR SENSOR
ENGINE- SHUT OFF TRANSFER
DRIVEN L R
FUEL PUMP
FlightSafety
CAUTION FUEL FILTER
(BYPASS)
DC POWER (BYPASS)
HM RESET
L GEN BATT R GEN FCU HM
SLINGER SLINGER
FCU
OFF OFF
international
START NOZZLE
RESET EMER RESET
9 PPH INCLUDED
IN F/F
F/W
Illumination of the amber L or The left and right engines continue to receive
SHUT OFF R F/W SHUT OFF annunciator their normal supply of fuel from the primary
light verifies that the fuel and ejector pumps. A slight back-pressure from
L R hydraulic firewall shutoff normal primary ejector pump supply to the
valves have closed. engines moves the one-way check valves
closed just downstream of the electric boost
A pressure switch illuminates the amber L or pumps, creating a closed route for fuel to move
R FUEL LOW PRESS annunciator if fuel pres- from one operating electric boost pump to the
sure fails. If the L or R FUEL BOOST pump other nonoperating boost pump.
switch is in NORM, the boost pump is ener-
gized, as indicated by illumination of the white Monitor the FUEL QTY indicator on the MFD
L or R FUEL BOOST ON annunciator. If the for fuel balancing or the QTY LBS indicator
boost pump can provide adequate pressure in on the PFDs if reverted. To verify that fuel
the fuel supply line, the amber L or R FUEL transfer is occurring, it is necessary to moni-
LOW PRESS light will go out. However, the tor the fuel quantity white tape pointers or
boost pump will remain on until it is manually digital indicators. Fuel will normally transfer
reset (Figure 5-13). to the selected tank at approximately 10
pounds-per-minute, or 600 pounds-per-hour.
Maximum normal fuel imbalance is 200
FUEL TRANSFER pounds. Maximum emergency fuel imbalance
SYSTEM OPERATION is 600 pounds.
Fuel balancing is controlled by the fuel trans- To terminate fuel transfer and return the sys-
fer switch on the pilot left switch panel tem to normal operation, move the fuel trans-
(Figure 5-12). fer switch to OFF. The electric boost pump is
deenergized, the FUEL TRANSFER white
light goes out, and the fuel transfer valve
FUEL TRANSFER
springloads closed. The system is now back
OFF
to normal operation, with each engine being
supplied by its respective tank. If electrical
L R power fails during fuel transfer operation,
TANK TANK
the fuel transfer solenoid valve fails to the
L R closed position.
ENG ENG
NOTE
Figure 5-12. Fuel Transfer Switch If the boost pump switch is OFF, the
fuel transfer circuit will not function.
Using the fuel transfer system, fuel from the
heavy wing tank sump can be transferred to
the opposite wing tank sump. Selecting the
NOTE
fuel transfer switch L TANK to R TANK If both FUEL BOOST ON annunci-
energizes the left tank electric boost pump ators come on when fuel transfer is
and electrically opens the fuel transfer valve. selected, both boost pumps have
Left tank boost pump pressure supplies fuel been energized and fuel transfer can-
from the left wing tank sump through the open not occur. Cycle the FUEL BOOST
transfer valve, through the nonoperational pump switch for the nonselected tank
right electric boost pump into the right wing to ON, then back to NORM. This
tank sump. should deenergize the pump in the
tank not selected and allow fuel
transfer to begin.
L R
ENGINE ENGINE
TRANSFER FIRE FIRE
EJECTOR
PUMP TRANSFER
EJECTOR
FUEL LOW FUEL TRANSFER PUMP FUEL LOW
LEVEL OFF FUEL BOOST LEVEL
L R L ON R L R
L R L R
SUMP SUMP
PRIMARY TRANSFER PRIMARY
TEMP EJECTOR
EJECTOR VALVE
FUEL SENSOR PUMP
PUMP ENERGIZED FUEL FILTER
OPEN BYPASS GAUGE
LEFT FUEL L R L R RIGHT FUEL
FIREWALL OPERATING FIREWALL
SHUTOFF NONOPERATING SHUTOFF
BOOST PUMP TEMP F/W FUEL RIGHT
SENSOR BOOST PUMP
ENGINE- SHUT OFF TRANSFER
DRIVEN L R
FUEL PUMP
FlightSafety
FUEL FILTER CAUTION
(BYPASS) FUEL FILTER
DC POWER (BYPASS)
HM RESET
L GEN BATT R GEN FCU HM
SLINGER SLINGER
FCU
international
OFF OFF START NOZZLE
RESET EMER RESET
9 PPH INCLUDED
IN F/F
NOTE
Figure 5-14. Filler Port Fuel is considered contaminated
when it contains any foreign sub-
Refuel to the FULL indicating tab in the filler stances that are not provided under
neck for maximum usable fuel for flight plan- the fuel specification. These foreign
ning. If the wing is fueled to the refueling cap substances normally consist of water,
level, this may not allow room for expansion rust, sand, dust/dirt, microbial
and may result in fuel spillage through the growth, unapproved additives, and
NACA vents. approved additives mixed at im-
proper ratios to the fuel.
Fuel is filtered by a screen in the filler neck.
This screen is the in-tank system filter in each
wing and must not be damaged or removed. REFUELING
Approved fuels for operation of the Model 525A
All motive flow fuel is heated as it circulates are listed in the limitations and specifications
through the oil/fuel heat exchanger. Periodic section of the AFM. No Avgas is allowed.
use of a biocidal agent is necessary, such as
Sohio Biobor or Prist.
DEFUELING
Defueling is accomplished by uncowling the
engine, disconnecting the main fuel supply
line and using the wing tank fuel boost pump
to offload fuel. Remember, no fuel can be off
loaded from the wing fuel caps due to the filler
neck design. Do not run the boost pumps dry.
Any further defueling is accomplished through
fuel drains.
QUESTIONS
1. The most correct answer is: 4. If the L or R FUEL BOOST ON white an-
A. The FUEL BOOST pump switches do nunciators illuminate without any action
not have to be on for engine start. by the crew (engine operating normally),
the probable cause is:
B. Wi t h t h e F U E L B O O S T p u m p
switches off, the respective boost A. The engine-driven fuel pump has
pump cannot turn on. failed
C. The fuel boost pump will be automat- B. The firewall shutoff valve has closed
ically energized anytime the FUEL C. The low-pressure sensing switch has
BOOST switches are in NORM and energized the boost pump
the START button is depressed, FUEL D. The fuel flow compensator has ener-
TRANSFER is selected, or low fuel gized the boost pump below 4.4 psi
pressure (4.4 psi) is sensed in the en-
gine supply line (throttle at IDLE or
above). 5. To verify that fuel transfer is in fact oc-
D. All of the above. curring, it is necessary to:
A. Monitor the fuel quantity indicators
for appropriate quantity changes
2. After engine start, the fuel boost pump is
B. Only observe that the white FUEL
deenergized by:
TRANSFER light is on
A. The FUEL BOOST pump switch C. Ensure both white FUEL BOOST ON
B. Start circuit termination lights are illuminated
C. Discontinuing fuel transfer D. Ensure that the FUEL BOOST pump
D. A time-delay relay switch for the tank being fed is on
CHAPTER 7
POWERPLANT
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 7-1
GENERAL .............................................................................................................................. 7-1
MAJOR SECTIONS ............................................................................................................... 7-1
Intake and Fan Section ...................................................................................................... 7-3
Compressor Section ........................................................................................................... 7-3
Combustion Section........................................................................................................... 7-3
Turbine Section.................................................................................................................. 7-4
Exhaust Section ................................................................................................................. 7-4
Accessory Section.............................................................................................................. 7-4
OPERATION ........................................................................................................................... 7-4
ENGINE INDICATING SYSTEM (EIS) ............................................................................... 7-5
Oil Pressure........................................................................................................................ 7-7
Controls and Indications.................................................................................................... 7-7
Data concentration Units (DCUs) ..................................................................................... 7-7
Engine Data Concentrators (EDCs)................................................................................... 7-8
ENGINE SYSTEMS ............................................................................................................... 7-8
Oil System ......................................................................................................................... 7-8
Fuel System ..................................................................................................................... 7-12
Ignition System................................................................................................................ 7-15
Instrumentation................................................................................................................ 7-17
N1 REF ............................................................................................................................ 7-18
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
7-1 General View of Williams FJ44-2C Engine............................................................. 7-2
7-2 Major Sections ......................................................................................................... 7-2
7-3 Inlet .......................................................................................................................... 7-3
7-4 Exhaust..................................................................................................................... 7-4
7-5 FJ44-2C Gas Flow ................................................................................................... 7-5
7-6 Engine Indicating System Display........................................................................... 7-6
7-7 MFD Expanded Engine Instrument Display (EIS).................................................. 7-6
7-8 Oil Servicing Access ................................................................................................ 7-9
7-9 Nacelle...................................................................................................................... 7-9
7-10 Oil System.............................................................................................................. 7-13
7-11 Collins Multifunction Display (MFD) Engine Indicating System (EIS) .............. 7-14
7-12 Engine Fuel System (CJ2) ..................................................................................... 7-15
7-13 Ignition Switches ................................................................................................... 7-16
7-14. Ignition System (Left Engine Start) ...................................................................... 7-17
7-15 L and R Standby N1s on Emergency Bus (LCD).................................................. 7-18
7-16 MFD/PFD Reversion Switch ................................................................................. 7-19
7-17 ITT Source Data Fails............................................................................................ 7-20
7-18 Throttle Quadrant on Pedestal ............................................................................... 7-21
7-19 Airstart Envelope ................................................................................................... 7-22
7-20 Engine SYNC Switch ............................................................................................ 7-25
CHAPTER 7
POWERPLANT
#1 DC
GEN
INTRODUCTION
This chapter deals with the powerplant installed in the Citation CJ2. The following as-
sociated powerplant monitoring and operating systems are discussed: engine oil, fuel,
ignition, engine displays, engine power control, engine starting, and engine synchro-
nization. Thrust attenuators are discussed in Chapter 13, “Hydraulic Power Systems.”
Collins Pro Line 21 EFIS is used to normally display the engine indicating system (EIS)
on the upper half of the multifunction display (MFD) or during reversion to display the
EIS compressed on the PFD(s).
COMBUSTION SECTION
This section consists of a single folded
annular-flow, infusion-cooled combustor. A
precise volume of the compressor airflow en-
ters the combustion chamber. Fuel is added by
a rotating slinger that atomizes and delivers
fuel uniformly to the primary combustion
zone. The expanding and accelerating gases are
directed rearward to the turbine.
Fuel Slinger
The fuel slinger is part of the HP rotary group.
Fuel is supplied to the underside of the slinger
by the fuel manifold. Fuel is then ejected ra-
dially outboard by high pressure and centrifu-
gal force into the combustion chamber through
a series of tiny laser-drilled holes/slots in the
slinger.
Figure 7-4. Exhaust
TURBINE SECTION
This section consists of a single high- bypass airflow produces the total propulsive
pressure and two low-pressure turbines. force for the aircraft. The exhaust diffuser
mixes bypass air with core air reducing the
The high-pressure turbine is connected to the sound level.
high-pressure compressor by a rotor shaft.
The function of the high-pressure turbine is to
extract sufficient energy from the expanding
ACCESSORY SECTION
combustion gases to drive the high-pressure The accessory section consists of a gear assem-
compressor and the accessory section. bly encased and mounted on the underside of
the engine. The accessory gear is driven by the
The high-pressure compressor and turbine as- high-pressure rotor shaft through a tower shaft
sembly form the high-pressure spool. The rpm and bevel gear. It functions to drive the follow-
of the high-pressure spool is designated “N 2 ” ing accessories:
or “turbine.”
• Oil pump
The low-pressure turbine is two-stage. It is
connected to the low-pressure compressor by • Hydraulic pump
a rotor shaft that runs through the high- • Fuel pump and fuel control unit
pressure compressor rotor shaft. The function
of the low-pressure turbine is to extract suf- • Starter-generator
ficient energy from the combustion gases to The starter spins up the N 2 shaft for starting,
drive the low-pressure compressor and fan. and when powered, the N 2 shaft will spin the
generator shaft for DC electrical power.
The low-pressure compressor and its turbine
form the low-pressure spool. The rpm of the
low-pressure spool is designated “N1,” or “fan.”
OPERATION
EXHAUST SECTION Air is directed from the nacelle inlet to the en-
gine air intake (Figure 7-5). The outer span sec-
This section consists of the primary exhaust tion of the fan compresses and accelerates a
duct and the bypass air duct. The primary ex- large mass of air at a low velocity into the
haust includes a tapered cone (Figure 7-4) and full-length bypass duct.
struts. The combination of primary exhaust and
CORE
AIR FLOW
BYPASS
DUCT AIR
Simultaneously, the inner span section com- or crosswind conditions, may result
presses and accelerates a volume of air to the in rpm fluctuations. This is normal at
primary gas path axial compressor stage. Air high-power settings during static or
pressure is increased by the three booster l ow - s p e e d o p e r a t i o n s . S t a r t t h e
stages and directed to the high-pressure com- downwind engine first.
pressor which accelerates the air mass and di-
rects it through a diffuser. The diffusion
process changes the velocity energy to pres-
sure energy. A relatively small portion of the
ENGINE INDICATING
air enters the combustion chamber where fuel SYSTEM (EIS)
is added and ignition occurs. The combustion
process produces expansion and acceleration. The EIS engine display format (Figures 7-6
The rest of the compressed air is used to op- and 7-7) is made up of full-time display of N 1,
erate various bleed-air services on the aircraft an N 1 reference (bug), interstage turbine tem-
and for internal cooling in the engine. perature (ITT) N 2, oil pressure, oil tempera-
ture, and fuel flow (separate for each engine).
The high-pressure turbine extracts energy to Fuel quantity is also provided. Alerts and warn-
drive its compressor and the accessory section. ings are provided for operation outside normal
The low-pressure turbine extracts energy to limits.
drive the low-pressure compressor (fan and
boosters). The remaining energy is directed Two data sources for N 1 , N 2 , and ITT exist for
into the exhaust section where it joins with the each engine. One is the data concentrator unit
bypass airflow to provide thrust. (DCU) and the other is the engine data con-
centrator (EDC). The DCU is normally the
NOTE source of all displayed engine data. The EDC
is a secondary source for N 1 , N 2 , and ITT.
Airflow disturbances across the en-
gine intake, particularly during gusty
70 1000
700
50
500
600 5 °C 5
30
400 FUEL
99.2 99.2 200 430 PPH 430 1220 1210
KTKK
I-S
50 KOXV
< FMS1 FORMAT >
FMS2
25 KPEA
< DATA
GS 450 TAS 400 RAT–34 °C SAT–39 °C ISA 0 °C
BRT
DIM
Oil Filter
The oil filter, which is a disposable cartridge,
is used to remove solid contaminants. It has
bypass capability; however, there is no an-
nunciator light indicating the filter is bypass-
ing. A bypass warning indicator on the oil
filter is checked “not extended” during the
exterior preflight and postflight by touching
the indicator button through an access panel
on the lower right engine nacelle (Figure 7-9).
Figure 7-8. Oil Servicing Access The pilot feels the metal button to see if it is
extended (popped). More than 15-psi differ-
ential pressure pops the button. The fingertip
Check the oil within 10 minutes after shut- is pointed straight up through the hole in the
down. Ensure the dipstick is properly secured cowl to feel the button.
after the oil check and the cowl door are se-
cured. The dipstick is marked at FULL and
ADD. On the test stand, the oil volume be-
tween FULL and ADD is 1.0 quart. The way
the engine is attached to the airframe makes this
volume approximately 3/4 quart (slightly
canted and tilted). Do not fill above the FULL
mark. Total oil in each engine is 4.0 U.S. quarts.
The oil pressure display consists of an analog Oil pressure digital readout is as follows:
and part-time digital display for each engine. Red ........................................................ ≤44 psi
A digital readout of oil pressure is displayed 91–100 psi ≥5 min
if an overlimit condition is detected with any ≥101 psi
oil parameter.
Yellow.................................. 91–100 psi <5 min
Oil pressure scale markings are as follows:
Red band ................................................ ≤25 psi NOTE
≥101 psi
Pointer and digital readout will flash
Yellow band........................................ 26–34 psi red or yellow for five seconds, then
91–100 psi remain steady if outside normal op-
erating limits with the following ex-
Green band ........................................ 35–90 psi
ception: for oil pressure 91 to 100
psi, the pointer will change to yel-
low, but digits will not be displayed
NOTE until 4 minutes have elapsed, at
Oil pressure indicator scale mark- which time both yellow digits and
ings do not change with varying N 2 . pointer will flash for 5 seconds, then
remain steady.
1 2 3 4 5 LEGEND
RELIEF
VALVE SCAVENGE
PUMP
N2
OIL TO 91.8 % 91.8
ACCESSORY
GEAR BOX OIL PSI OIL °C
SCAVENGE ACCESSORY
PUMP GEAR BOX
MASTER OIL PRESS
WARNING WARN
OIL COOLER FUEL FLOW
RESET
L R
FlightSafety
430 PPH 430
FUEL IN FUEL OUT
15-PSI 25-PSI
BYPASS SPRING TRANSDUCER TEMP
SENSOR
international
TOTAL OIL—4 US QTS
RESERVOIR—2.5 QTS
OIL FILTER
7-13
The governing section senses N2 rpm and throt- The fuel-flow display is DC powered (the left
tle position then modifies the signals transmit- display from the left extension bus and the right
ted by the computing section to the metering display from the right extension bus). If nor-
section. This determines the position of the fuel mal DC fails, the MFD goes blank.
metering valve, and consequently, the volume
of fuel delivered to the combustion chamber.
NOTE
Fuel-flow indication is disabled when
Acceleration Bleed Valve the associated throttle is moved to
A fuel control unit (FCU) moves a cable con- cutoff. This prevents erratic fuel-
nected to a butterfly bleed valve on top of the flow indications when rpm decreases
engine in the interstage housing. The acceler- below 10%.
ation bleed valve is open at start, closes over 85%
N 2 during engine acceleration, and reopens at Fuel flow is normally in pph. Optional kilo-
approximately 85% N 2 during deceleration. grams per hour (kph) may be displayed. The
The bleed valve unloads the HP compressor, al- fuel flow displays consist of digital readouts
lowing improved acceleration response by vent- for each engine. A white FUEL FLOW legend
ing bleed air into the bypass duct. is displayed between the left and right digital
readouts. The CJ2 legend is FUEL PPH; dis-
Emergency Fuel Shutoff play range is 0 to 1,050 pph (0 to 1,000 kph).
Fuel flow values are displayed in green.
An N1 shaft separation detection device detects
N 1 shaft movement. This prevents N 1 rotor The displayed fuel flow values include 9 pph
overspeed if N 1 shaft separation occurs. If N 1 for unmetered start nozzle fuel flow. The fuel
shaft moves more than .050 inches, the FCU flow signal must be valid. Four yellow dashes
fuel shutoff lever is automatically closed- are displayed if fuel flow from all sources is
, terminating fuel flow. failed. Automatic source selection between
DCUs: L DCU is priority source for left en-
Fuel Flow Indication gine; R DCU is priority source for right engine;
cross-side DCU is secondary source.
A flow meter senses metered fuel flow down-
stream from the FCU and displays fuel flow
in pounds per hour digitally on the MFD
(Figure 7-11).
70 1000
700
50
500
600 12 °C 12
30
400 FUEL
99.2 99.2 200 430 PPH 430 1220 1210
Figure 7-11. Collins Multifunction Display (MFD) Engine Indicating System (EIS)
COMBUSTION
CHAMBER
FUEL
SLINGER
LEGEND
LOW-PRESSURE FUEL
HIGH-PRESSURE FUEL
START NOZZLE
9PPH
INCLUDED IN FUEL
FUEL FLOW MANIFOLD
FUEL
FUEL LOW FUEL FLTR FILTER
PRESS BYPASS FUEL FLOW
FROM WING
P
FUEL TANKS FUEL FUEL CONTROL FUEL FLOW
FILTER UNIT METER OIL
CENTRIFUGAL
OUT
ENGINE-DRIVEN HIGH-PRESSURE
FUEL PUMP ENGINE-DRIVEN
FUEL PUMP
Figure 7-12. Engine Fuel System (CJ2)
through an igniter lead. Dual plugs are pro- In this case, the left engine ignition power is
vided for redundancy only. One plug is suffi- supplied by the right crossover bus, and the
cient to start or sustain the engine. With one right engine ignition power is supplied from
igniter inoperative, the start will be neither the left extension bus.
slower nor hotter.
When the IGNITION switch is in NORM, turn-
Ignition operation is divided into automatic ing on an engine ANTI-ICE switch (Figure
and selective phases. 7-14) will also provide continuous ignition for
the selected engine (refer to Chapter 10, “Ice and
Automatic ignition is available during engine Rain Protection”). DC power is supplied from
starting and is terminated automatically when the same sources as previously described for the
the start sequence is terminated. Ignition also IGNITION switch.
automatically activates when engine anti-ice
is selected on. There is no time limit for ignition operation;
however, continuous use will reduce igniter life.
Control
NOTE
The ignition system is controlled by a switch
for each engine, located on the pilot switch The IGNITION switches must be on
panel (Figure 7-13). The IGNITION switch is for all takeoff and landing operations
labeled ON and NORM. and during flight in heavy precipita-
tion or turbulence, and stall practice.
When the IGNITION switch is in NORM, au-
tomatic ignition will occur during engine start-
ing when the desired START button (Figure Indication
7-13) is pushed to arm the ignition circuit A green light near each IGNITION switch
and the associated throttle is moved from the will be on whenever power is available to one
cutoff position to idle at 8 to 12% N 2 and N 1 or both exciters. These lights do not indicate
rotation. Ignition and starter operation are that the associated exciter or plugs are firing.
both terminated by a 45% N 2 speed sensor on
t h e s t a r t e r- g e n e r a t o r w h e n e n g i n e s e l f - The green IGN legend is displayed adjacent
sustaining speed is achieved. to the upper center of the applicable analog ITT
scale when the respective engine’s ignition
Selecting the IGNITION switch to ON pro- discrete is received by a DCU (from the
vides continuous ignition (for the selected en- on-side ignition system).
gine) regardless of the position of the throttle.
T
H
R
O
T
T
L
E
S
IDLE
OFF
L IGNITER R IGNITER
PC BOARD PC BOARD
ENGINE FUEL
ENGINE START IGNITION
L FUEL L L FW L L
CONTROL BOOST SHUT OFF FIRE DET IGNITION
L DISENGAGE R L R
START 5 15 71/2 5 5
DISG
NOTE ITT °C
Tape will turn red and pointer will
flash red for five seconds, then re- F 600 F
main steady red if outside normal A A
starting limits. I 400 I
L L
200
Engine running red line and yellow
band do not apply, white ITT start Figure 7-17. ITT Source Data Fails
limit (red triangle) is in view.
Four yellow dashes and a decimal point are dis- During the start sequence and upon reading 8
played if all sources of N 2 are failed. L DCU to 12% N 2 and indication of N 1 rotation, the
is priority source for left engine. R DCU is pri- throttle is advanced to idle. Lift the latch and
ority source for right engine. Cross-side DCU quickly advance the throttle halfway up the
is secondary source. EDC is third priority race, releasing the latch, and snap it back
source. Automatic source selection between against the idle stop. This will activate the ig-
data sources is provided. nition microswitch. With fuel and ignition,
the ITT should increase within 10 seconds.
DC power failure will cause the MFD and EIS
displays to fail. See Chapter 10, “Ice and The start sequence terminates at 45% N 2 by
Rain,” for N 2 failure’s effect on wing and en- the starter-generator overspeed sensor. The
gine anti-ice protection. engine then drives to GND IDLE rpm 53.4
±2.5% N 2 . If the ground idle switch is se-
Oil Pressure lected to high, the N 2 drives to FLT IDLE of
See Oil System, this chapter. 64.3 ±2.5% N 2 .
35
30
25
20
ALTITUDE—1,000 FEET
15
10
0
0 50 100 150 200 250 300
AIRSPEED—KIAS
LEGEND
STARTER ASSIST ONLY
WINDMILLING OR STARTER ASSIST
NOTE:
• AT LOW AIRSPEEDS, IT MAY APPROACH 1,000°C. THE ITT MUST BE
MONITORED SO AS NOT TO EXCEED THE LIMITS OF FIGURE 2-4 IN THE
AFM. INTENTIONAL STARTER ASSISTED AIRSTARTS SHOULD BE
CONDUCTED ABOVE 150 KIAS TO ENSURE COOLER START TEMPERATURE
AND TO PROLONG ENGINE LIFE.
• IF THE ENGINE IS TO BE SHUT DOWN FOR INTENTIONAL AIRSTARTS, IT
SHOULD BE ALLOWED TO COOL AT IDLE FOR THREE MINUTES PRIOR TO
SHUTDOWN AND THEN ALLOWED TO COOL FIVE MINUTES WHILE SHUT
DOWN PRIOR TO RESTARTING.
1. Full Cycle:
a. Engine start, takeoff power setting,
followed by engine shutdown, re-
gardless of duration
b. In-flight start
Control
The engine synchronizer is controlled by a
three-position rotary switch (Figure 7-20)
labeled “ENGINE SYNC FAN–OFF–TUR-
BINE.” Turning the switch off permits the con-
troller to run the actuator (located in the right
nacelle) to a null or center position. Selecting
FAN or TURBINE permits the controller to
synchronize the left and right fan or turbine
rpm as selected. Select FAN for passenger com-
fort or TURBINE for crew comfort. Figure 7-20. ENGINE SYNC Switch
Indication
When the ENGINE SYNC switch is at the
FAN or TURBINE position, an amber EN-
GINE SYNC light (Figure 7-20) will be on.
The system is turned on by the pilot when de-
sired after takeoff. The monopoles (turbine
and fan) supply rpm signals to the synchro-
nizer controller. The controller computes the
error difference of the selected (fan or turbine)
inputs and transmits an output signal to the
actuator in the right nacelle, which adjusts the
right FCU to synchronize the right rpm to
that of the left engine.
QUESTIONS
1. The primary thrust indicator for the 6. Of the following statements concerning
Williams FJ44-2C is: the FJ44-2C engine, the correct one is:
A. Fuel flow A. Fuel from the engine fuel system is
B. N 1 used to cool the engine oil through a
C. ITT fuel-oil heat exchanger.
D. N 2 B. The engine accessory gearbox has its
own oil lubricating system (independ-
ent of the engine itself).
2. If one igniter should fail during engine C. The indication of low oil pressure is
start: only the L or R OIL PRESS WARN an-
A. The engine will start normally. nunciator light.
B. It will result in a “hot” start. D. Electrical power is not required to
C. Combustion will not occur. power the ITT instrument since it is
self-generating.
D. The exciter box will act as a backup
and the engine will start.
7. The L or R OIL PRESS WARN light on
the annunciator panel illuminates when-
3. Ignition during normal engine start is ever:
activated by:
A. Oil temperature exceeds 136°C
A. Turning the IGNITION switches on at
8 to 12% N 2 B. Oil pressure is less than 25 psi
B. Moving the throttle to IDLE at 8 to C. Oil filter clogs and bypasses oil
12% N 2 and N 1 rotation D. The fuel-oil cooler becomes clogged
C. Depressing the start button
D. Nothing; ignition not needed during 8. The maximum allowable operating oil
normal engine start consumption for the FJ44-2C engine is:
A. 0.8 quart per hour
4. Ignition and boost pump operation during B. .023 U.S. gallon per hour
engine start are normally terminated by: C. .5 gallon every 40 hours
A. Turning the IGNITION switches off D. No specified figure since it depends
B. T h e s p e e d - s e n s i n g s w i t c h o n t h e upon TBO
starter-generator at approximately
45% N 2
9. I f t h e N 1 fa n s h a f t s h i f t s m o r e t h a n
C. Turning the boost pump switch off .050 inch:
D. Opening the ignition circuit breakers
A. The engine automatically shuts down.
on the right circuit-breaker panel
B. T h e v i b r a t i o n d e t e c t o r c a u s e s
illumination of the MASTER WARN-
5. Power will be automatically applied to
ING lights.
the igniters when the IGNITION switch
is in NORM anytime: C. The synchronizer shuts the engine down.
D. Nothing occurs.
A. The start button is depressed and the
throttle is out of OFF.
B. The surface deice system is activated.
C. The engine anti-ice switch is on.
D. Both A and C
10. The following engine instruments are 14. What is the maximum engine ground start
available in the event of a loss of normal tailwind component?
DC electrical power: A. 15 KTS
A. N 1 rpm and ITT B. 16 KTS
B. N 1 rpm, N 2 rpm, and ITT C. 13 KTS
C. N 1 rpm (pointer only) D. 10 KTS
D. N 1 rpm (standby LCD digital display)
15. Maximum oil consumption for an operat-
11. The ENGINE SYNC switch: ing engine is:
A. Should be in FAN for takeoffs and A. 0.5 gallon per hour
landings B. 1.5 pints per hour
B. Should be in TURBINE at altitude C. 0.5 quarts per hour
C. Can be placed in FAN or TURBINE D. .023 gallon per hour
after takeoff and should be left there
for the remainder of the flight
D. Should be off for large power changes 16. During inflight windmilling, the engine
will vent oil overboard. Typical consump-
tion is approximately:
12. The FJ44-2C: A. .20 gallon per hour
A. Start fuel nozzle pump 9 pph constant B. 2 gallons per hour
B. Green ignition light confirming one or C. 1 quart per minute
both exciters powered D. 3 quarts per hour
C. Mobil Jet II and Mobil 254 are approved
D. All of the above
17. What is the maximum engine ground start
crosswind component?
13. Left fuel filter is bypassed: A. 16 KTS
A. The engines will flame out immedi- B. 10 KTS
ately, and the aircraft should be landed C. 21 KTS
immediately.
D. 12 KTS
B. The fuel boost pump will automati-
cally be activated.
C. Fuel transfer should be selected to -
in-sure that the fuel is filtered before
reaching the engine.
D. Dirty fuel bypasses through the left
engine’s fuel filter. The L fuel filter by-
pass annunciator will illuminate.
Flame out is possible.
CHAPTER 8
FIRE PROTECTION
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 8-1
GENERAL .............................................................................................................................. 8-1
ENGINE FIRE DETECTION AND INDICATORS............................................................... 8-2
Components ....................................................................................................................... 8-2
Engine Fire Sensor............................................................................................................. 8-2
ENGINE FIRE Switchlights.............................................................................................. 8-2
ENGINE FIRE-DETECTION TEST ...................................................................................... 8-4
ENGINE FIRE EXTINGUISHING ........................................................................................ 8-4
Extinguishing Bottles ........................................................................................................ 8-4
Operation ........................................................................................................................... 8-4
PORTABLE FIRE EXTINGUISHER..................................................................................... 8-6
QUESTIONS ........................................................................................................................... 8-7
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
8-1 Engine Fire-Detection Sensor ................................................................................. 8-3
8-2 ENGINE FIRE Switchlights and Controls ............................................................. 8-3
8-3 Rotary Test Switch .................................................................................................. 8-4
8-4 Engine Fire-Extinguishing System ......................................................................... 8-5
8-5 Portable Fire Extinguisher ...................................................................................... 8-6
CHAPTER 8
FIRE PROTECTION
FIRE
WARN
FIRE PULL
INTRODUCTION
The Citation CJ2 is equipped with engine fire-detection and fire extinguishing systems
as standard equipment. The detection system consists of two separate detection circuits
(one for each engine) which provide visual and aural warnings. The fire-extinguishing
system consists of two fire bottles that are activated from the cockpit. The two fire bot-
tles are interconnected so that both bottles may be used for either engine. A hand-held
fire extinguisher provides fire protection inside the aircraft.
GENERAL
The engine fire and overheat detection system two fire bottles charged with extinguishing
consists of a detector/sensor, detection con- agent, pressurized with nitrogen, and dis-
trol unit, and a fire warning light. The system charged by electrically activated squibs. The
requires normal DC power and is tested by bottles are armed and activated manually from
the rotary test switch located on the left panel. the cockpit. In addition, the bottles are guarded
The engine-extinguishing system consists of against overpressure.
ENGINE FIRE DETEC- the guard is lifted and the switchlight is de-
pressed, the following occurs:
TION AND INDICATORS
• The fuel and hydraulic firewall shutoff
valves close.
COMPONENTS
• The field relay on the generator is tripped.
The engine fire-detection system consists
of engine fire sensors, detection control units, • Both fire bottles are armed, white lights
ENGINE FIRE switchlights, and a rotary illuminate.
test switch.
Firewall shutoff and extinguisher arming are
ENGINE FIRE SENSOR indicated by the illumination of the following
annunciator panel lights:
Each engine fire sensor (Figure 8-1) is a flex-
ible stainless steel tube containing a fixed vol- • BOTTLE 1/2 ARMED
ume of inert gas (helium). An increase in • L or R F/W SHUTOFF
temperature on any part of the tube increases
the pressure of the gas. A detector unit con- • L or R FUEL LOW PRESS
taining two pressure switches is connected to • L or R FUEL BOOST ON
the end of the tube. One switch is for alarm and
the other for integrity. When a fire or overheat • L or R HYD FLOW LOW
condition causes the gas pressure to increase • L or R GEN OFF
sufficiently to close the alarm switch, an elec-
trical signal is sent to the fire detection con- • MASTER CAUTION
trol unit. This illuminates the red ENGINE • L or R OIL PRESS Warning
FIRE switchlight in the cockpit. When the
pressure decreases, the alarm switch opens If the fire switchlight has been activated, de-
and deactivates the ENGINE FIRE switch- pressing the switchlight a second time reopens
light. The integrity switch is normally closed. the appropriate valves and extinguishes the
respective annunciator lights. It should be em-
phasized that it will not reset the generator
NOTE field relay.
Illumination of the ENGINE FIRE
switchlight does not activate the
MASTER WARNING lights.
NOTE
The red L or R OIL PRESS WARN
annunciator will illuminate as oil
ENGINE FIRE SWITCHLIGHTS pressure drops below 25 psi as engine
spools down. The MASTER WARN-
The red ENGINE FIRE switchlights (Figure ING also illuminates.
8-2) are located in the center of the cockpit
glareshield. Four bulbs are in each FIRE
switchlight. These lights are guarded switch-
lights labeled L or R ENGINE FIRE. When
LOWER COWL
DOOR
FIRE DETECT
SENSOR TUBE
ELECTRICAL
CONNECTOR
CLAMP
CLAMP
CLAMP
CLAMP
L R
ENGINE ENGINE
FIRE FIRE
BOTTLE 1 BOTTLE 2
ARMED ARMED
PUSH PUSH
L R
ENGINE ENGINE LEGEND
FIRE FIRE P PRESSURE SWITCH
EXTINGUISHING AGENT
BOTTLE 1 BOTTLE 2
ARMED ARMED CONTROL BOX
PUSH PUSH
ELECTRICAL WIRING
CONTROL
UNIT
BOTTLE 1
P FUSIBLE PLUG P
FIRE
DETECTION
LOOP
HELIUM-FILLED
GAGE TUBE
BOTTLE 2
PLACARD
ON DOOR
PORTABLE FIRE
EXTINGUISHER
One portable hand-held fire extinguisher is
installed in the cockpit and is accessible from
either the pilot or copilot positions (Figure 8-
5). The portable 2 1⁄2-pound hand-held fire ex-
tinguisher is mounted to the floor to the left
side of the copilot seat in a quick-release
mounting bracket. The portable extinguisher
is a pressurized bottle containing Halon Type
1211 extinguishing agent. The extinguisher is
rated for class A, B, and C fires. Check pres-
sure in the green arc.
QUESTIONS
1. An ENGINE FIRE switchlight illumi- 5. If the contents of a bottle have been dis-
nates when: charged into a nacelle and the ENGINE
A. It is depressed. FIRE switchlight remains on for 30 sec-
onds:
B. T h e M A S T E R WA R N I N G l i g h t s
illuminate for an engine fire. A. The fire has been extinguished.
C. Temperature in the engine reaches B. The other bottle can be discharged into
500°F. the same nacelle by depressing the other
D. A pressure switch trips due to ther- BOTTLE ARMED switchlight.
mally induced inert gas expansion in C. The fire still exits, but no further ac-
a stainless tube. tion can be taken.
D. The same BOTTLE ARMED switch-
light can be depressed again, firing a
2. In order to fire the explosive cartridges on second charge of agent from the same
the fire-extinguisher bottles: bottle.
A. DC power need only be available to
the emergency bus.
6. Depressing the ENGINE FIRE switch-
B. Normal system DC power is required.
light a second time:
C. The right BOTTLE ARMED light
must be pressed for a right engine fire A. Opens the fuel firewall shutoff valve
and the left BOTTLE ARMED light B. Opens only the hydraulic firewall
for a left engine fire. shutoff valve
D. The ENGINE FIRE switchlight need C. Resets the generator field relay
not be previously activated. D. All of the above.
3. After a bottle has been discharged into a 7. An engine fire or overheat is indicated by:
nacelle: A. Illumination of a red ENGINE FIRE
A. No cleaning of the engine and nacelle light and a flashing MASTER WARN-
area is required. ING light
B. A thorough cleaning of the engine B. Illumination of the ENGINE FIRE
and nacelle area is required. light and automatic arming of the ex-
C. An inspection of the engine and na- tinguisher bottles
celle area is required to determine if C. Illumination of the red ENGINE FIRE
cleaning is necessary. warning light
D. None of the above. D. Automatic closing of the firewall shut-
off valves and subsequent engine
flameout
4. When the fire-extinguishing system is
armed (both white bottle armed lights
ON):
A. The FUEL LOW PRESS and FUEL
BOOST ON lights come ON.
B. T h e H Y D F L OW L OW l i g h t
illuminates.
C. The GEN OFF light illuminates.
D. All of the above.
CHAPTER 9
PNEUMATICS
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................... 9-1
GENERAL .............................................................................................................................. 9-1
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION ...................................................................................................... 9-2
Distribution ...................................................................................................................... 9-2
Precoolers......................................................................................................................... 9-4
Control ............................................................................................................................. 9-4
QUESTIONS ........................................................................................................................... 9-7
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
9-1 Pneumatic System Diagram ..................................................................................... 9-3
9-2 Air Source Selector .................................................................................................. 9-4
TABLE
Table Title Page
9-1 Source Selections, Valve Positions, and Flow Rates ............................................... 9-6
CHAPTER 9
PNEUMATICS
BLEED AIR CO
L R
AIR
15
5
20
LV
VA E
INTRODUCTION
The pneumatic system in the Citation CJ2 uses engine compressor bleed air. The air is
extracted from both engines and routed through control valves into a pneumatic mani-
fold for distribution to systems requiring pneumatics for operation. In the event of
single-engine operation, air from one engine is sufficient to maintain all required sys-
tem functions. Safety devices are incorporated to prevent excessive pressure. A control
switch and condition indicating lights are installed in the cockpit.
GENERAL
Bleed air from each engine is extracted from Precooler discharge air temperature is regulated
the engine high-pressure compressor section by a fan bypass air modulating valve system
at approximately 900°F and routed to: (uses 23-psi air) to approximately 246°C
(475°F) and is directed to the following:
• The engine inlet and generator inlet
when anti-iced • Wing anti-ice system and pylon ram-air
inlets
• The precooler
• Rudder bias system
HEAT VENT
L ENG R ENG
ANTI-ICE ANTI-ICE
SHUTOFF SHUTOFF
23 PSI WINDSHIELD PR 23 PSI VALVE
VALVE PR
SOV ANTI-ICE SOV
FCV CONTROL FCV
VALVE
REG 4 4 REG
T 475°F 8 8
475°F T
PRSOV—16-PSI PRESSURE
BLD AIR REGULATING AND SHUTOFF
O’HEAT VALVE; FAILSAFES OPEN
FCV—FLOW CONTROL VALVE PYLON
PYLON L R REGULATES AT 4 OR 8 PPM;
PRECOOLER 23-PSI SERVICE AIR REG. PRECOOLER
FAILSAFE TO 4 PPM
FlightSafety
RUDDER
BIAS
RUDDER BIAS
CONTROL
VALVE
international
LEGEND
WINDSHIELD ANTI-ICE AIR/
ENGINE BLEED AIR RAM AIR SERVICE BLEED AIR CABIN AIR (NORMAL)
EMERGENCY PRESSURIZATION
9-3
PRECOOLERS
The precoolers are stainless steel crossflow AIR SOURCE SELECT
heat exchangers, mounted in the pylons, that BOTH
reduce hot bleed air from 482°C (900°F) to
246°C (475°F) that is suitable for use in the L R
aircraft anti-ice, environment, and pneumatic
systems. The precoolers are the primary means
of regulating the upper temperature of the FRESH
bleed air going to all bleed-air systems. The AIR EMER
precoolers have two fundamental paths: the hot OFF
bleed-air path and the cooling air path.
SOURCE
L PRSOV/ R PRSOV/ EMER NET FLOW TO CABIN
CONDITION SELECTOR
FCV–PPM FCV–PPM VALVE–PPM PPM/TEMP/PRESS
POSITION
Two engines operating BOTH Open 4 Open 4 Closed 0 8 ppm 65°–85°F
Two engines operating L Open 8 Closed 0 Closed 0 8 ppm 65°–85°F
Two engines operating R Closed 0 Open 8 Closed 0 8 ppm 65°–85°F
Two engines operating EMER Closed 4/0 Closed 4/0 Open 6 6 ppm 120°F***
Two engines operating FRESH AIR Closed 0 Closed 0 Closed 0 0 Depressurize to ambient
Two engines operating OFF Closed 0 Closed 0 Closed 0 0 Leak rate
until depressurized
L throttle OFF,
R engine operating BOTH/R Closed 0 Open 8 Closed 0 8 ppm 65°–85°F
L engine operating,
R throttle OFF L/BOTH Open 8 Closed 0 Closed 0 8 ppm 65°–85°F
L engine OFF and
lost DC power Any position Open 4 Open 4 Closed 0 4 ppm cabin may rise
R engine OFF and
lost DC power Any position Open 4 Open 4 Closed 0 4 ppm cabin may rise
L engine flameout, L throttle
idle, R engine operating BOTH/R Open 4 Open 4 Closed 0 4 ppm cabin may rise
R engine flameout, L throttle
idle, R engine operating L/BOTH Open 4 Open 4 Closed 0 4 ppm cabin may rise
NOTES:
1. The (4 or 8 ppm) flow control valve (FCV) failsafes to the 4 ppm position with lost DC power and the pressure regulating
and shutoff valve (PRSOV) normally regulates 16 psi is a failsafe open valve.
2. With both engines operating in BOTH at 4 + 4 = 8 ppm flow to the cabin.
3. With L or R selected, the selected FCV is energized to a full 8 ppm to cabin, while the nonselected FCV is closed by logic.
4. Anytime a throttle is selected to OFF, the remaining engine FCV is energized to 8 ppm flow to the cabin by logic.
5. In the unlikely event of engine failure and the loss of normal DC power, the operating engine FCV failsafes open to 4 ppm
flow to the cabin. At half the normal flow rate to the cabin, cabin pressure may rise and differential pressure reduce.
6. Should an engine flameout, the 8 ppm command will not signal the live engine FCV until the dead engine throttle is
selected to OFF. In the meantime, 4 ppm is available from the live engine FCV and the cabin may rise.
*** Windshield bleed air OFF = 49°C (120°F)
Windshield bleed air HI = 138°C (280°F)
Windshield bleed air LOW = 127°C (260°F)
QUESTIONS
1. The EMER PRESS ON light can only be 3. The L and R PRSOVs, when open, allow
selected ON by the source selector and the engine bleed air to feed:
air source is: A. L and R FCVs at 4 ppm (total 8 ppm)
A. Left engine bleed air only and cabin heat exchanger for normal
B. Either/both engine bleed air through heating, cooling, and pressurization
the W/S heat exchanger at 120°F and B. 23-psi service air to the main cabin
regulated by the EMER valve at 6 ppm door seal
C. Right engine bleed air only C. The windshield anti-ice valve
D. Ram pylon inlet air D. All of the above.
2. The systems that use pneumatic bleed air 4. Fresh air draws pylon ram inlet air:
for operation are: A. To pressurize the cabin
A. Instrument air, emergency brakes, and B. To circulate air during unpressurized
the entrance door ground/inflight operations
B. Ta i l d e i c e , w i n d s h i e l d a n t i - i c e , C. Turns on a fan to the lower ducts
entrance door seal, and cabin or D. B and C above.
emergency pressurization
C. Entrance door seal, ACM, and thrust
reversers
D. Ta i l d e i c e , w i n d s h i e l d a n t i - i c e ,
entrance door seal, and ACM
CHAPTER 10
ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION................................................................................................................. 10-1
GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 10-2
ANTI-ICE SYSTEMS .......................................................................................................... 10-3
Pitot and Static Anti-ice System.................................................................................... 10-3
Ice Detection System..................................................................................................... 10-4
Precooler........................................................................................................................ 10-4
Windshield Anti-ice and Rain Removal System ........................................................... 10-5
Windshield Alcohol System .......................................................................................... 10-7
Rain Removal System ................................................................................................... 10-8
Engine Anti-ice System ................................................................................................. 10-8
Pylon Ram-Air Scoops................................................................................................ 10-10
Wing Anti-ice System ................................................................................................. 10-10
TAIL DEICE ....................................................................................................................... 10-16
Operation ..................................................................................................................... 10-16
QUESTIONS ...................................................................................................................... 10-19
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
10-1 Ice-Protected Surfaces .......................................................................................... 10-2
10-2 ANTI-ICE/DE-ICE Switches ............................................................................... 10-3
10-3 Windshield Ice Detection Lights and Switch ........................................................ 10-4
10-4 Wing Inspection Light and Switch ....................................................................... 10-4
10-5 Precooler Intake and Exhaust Bypass ................................................................... 10-5
10-6 Windshield Bleed-Air Knobs ................................................................................ 10-6
10-7 Windshield Anti-ice System ................................................................................. 10-6
10-8 Alcohol Sight Gage and Nozzles .......................................................................... 10-7
10-9 Rain Removal Controls and Doors ........................................................................ 10-8
10-10 Pylon Ram-Air Scoops ........................................................................................ 10-10
10-11 Wing/Engine Anti-ice System—Both Engines ................................................... 10-11
10-12 Wing/Engine Anti-ice System—One Engine ..................................................... 10-12
10-13 Tail Deice System ............................................................................................... 10-18
TABLE
Table Title Page
10-1 WING/ENG ANTI-ICE Light Operation ............................................................ 10-13
CHAPTER 10
ICE AND RAIN PROTECTION
INTRODUCTION
The Citation CJ2 is equipped with both anti-icing and deicing systems. The aircraft is
approved for flight into known icing conditions when the equipment is functioning prop-
erly. These systems should be checked prior to flight if icing conditions are anticipated.
Anti-ice protection systems are incorporated into wing, engine components, windshield,
pitot-static, and angle-of-attack systems, and pylon ram-air scoops. These systems
should be activated prior to entering icing conditions.
The tail deice system consists of pneumatic boots on the horizontal stabilizers.
GENERAL NOTE
Anti-ice systems and the tail deice
Electrically operated solenoid valves, controlled system should be turned on in flight
by switches on the pilot panel, control the flow when icing conditions exist. Icing
of bleed air to anti-ice the wing leading edge and conditions exist when the MFD dis-
engine nacelle lip. played RAT in flight is +10°C or
below, and visible moisture in any
Engine bleed air is discharged through nozzles form is present. Icing conditions
in front of the windshield for anti-ice protection exist on the ground when RAT is
of the windshield. Isopropyl alcohol is available +10°C or below and where surface
for anti-icing the left windshield in the event that snow, slush, ice or standing water
bleed air is unavailable. Rain removal is provided may be ingested by the engines or
by deflecting air away from the windshield via freeze on engine nacelles, or engine
a set of doors. sensor probes. The wing/engine anti-
ice systems may be operated in the
Ice formation on the windshield causes a red WING/ENG position and the wind-
halo reflection of the glareshield ice detector shield anti-ice and tail deice may be
lights at night. The ice and rain system switches OFF provided it can be visually ver-
are green capped for easy identification. ified that no ice is accumulating. Se-
lecting engine anti-ice also initiates
continuous ignition.
BLD AIR
23-PSI SERVICE AIR
O’HEAT
WINDSHIELD PNEUMATIC TEMPERATURE
L R PROBE REGULATOR
ANTI-ICE SYSTEM
PRECOOLER
FAN AIR
ENGINE MODULATING
VALVE
900°F
CORE AIR
CROSSFLOW
EXHAUST
(HEAT
COOLER EXTRACTED)
BYPASS
DUCT
AIR
PNEUMATIC
ACTUATOR REGULATED
SERVICE AIR
149°C
TAIL
TEMPERATURE PRESSURE W/S AIR
BLEED HI SENSOR SWITCH O'HEAT
O AIR
F TEMP
F CONTR
HI 138 ±6°C 5 PSI
LOW RAM-AIR
LOW 127 ±6°C CONTROL
HEAT VALVE
HEAT PYLON RAM
EXTRACTED, AIR IN
DUCTED EXCH
OVERBOARD
W/S BLEED-AIR
SOLENOID VALVE
(FAILS OPEN)
L R
BLEED AIR SUPPLY
W/S AIR
An overtemperature sensor, is pressure monitoring, and when the switch
O’HEAT located near the discharge noz- is on HI or LOW it is temperature monitoring.
zles, automatically energizes
the electrical solenoid bleed-air shutoff valve If the EMER position is selected in flight on
closed and illuminates the W/S AIR O’HEAT the source selector, with the windshield bleed-
annunciator if the temperature exceeds 149°C air system off the 5-psi pressure switch and W/S
(300°F). This condition should not occur un- AIR O’HEAT light are deactivated for pressure.
less a sustained high-power, low-airspeed con-
dition is maintained or a system malfunction
occurs. The overheat sensor will also auto- WINDSHIELD
matically reopen the windshield bleed-air so- ALCOHOL SYSTEM
lenoid valve and extinguish the annunciator
light as the system cools. If the overheat light The backup windshield anti-ice system con-
illuminates, the windshield bleed-air valves sists of an alcohol reservoir, electrical pump,
should be partially closed to reduce airflow. and nozzles to provide ten minutes of contin-
uous alcohol anti-ice capability for the pilot
A pressure switch in the windshield duct illu- windshield only. Six alcohol spray tubes are
minates the W/S AIR O’HEAT light if the duct incorporated in the pilot windshield bleed-air
pressure exceeds 5 psi with the WINDSHIELD nozzle assembly. The sight gage for the alco-
BLEED AIR switch in the OFF position. The hol reservoir is located in the right-hand nose
pilot should ensure that the manual windshield storage compartment, and the nozzles are
bleed-air valves are in the OFF position. When shown in Figure 10-8.
OFF is selected, the ram-air control valve
drives closed within 12 seconds.
The capacity of the alcohol reservoir is 1.9 For rain removal, the PULL RAIN handle
liters (2 quarts), and it uses an isopropyl al- should be pulled out, the WINDSHIELD
cohol-based fluid (TT-I-735). The system is BLEED AIR knobs on the pilot control panel
designed to be used in the event the wind- should be rotated to the MAX position, and the
shield bleed-air anti-ice system fails. It is con- W/S BLEED switch positioned to LOW. Rain
trolled by the WINDSHIELD ALCOHOL door opening is difficult above 175 KIAS and
switch, which has positions “ON” and “OFF.” if the windshield bleed-air is already flowing
The electrical power source is the crossover out of the nozzles. To increase airflow to the
bus through the windshield alcohol circuit windshield during periods of low-power set-
breaker on the left circuit-breaker panel. tings, such as during landing flare, rotate the
copilot WINDSHIELD BLEED AIR–RIGHT
knob to the OFF position. This will divert all
RAIN REMOVAL SYSTEM available bleed air to the pilot windshield. In
The rain removal system uses the normal bleed- addition, the use of an approved rain repellent
air anti-ice system for rain removal, with rain agent applied to the windshield before flight
doors to provide deflected airflow over each greatly enhances the effectiveness of the rain
windshield in heavy rain. The doors are manu- removal system.
ally operated by pulling the PULL RAIN handle
located under the WINDSHIELD BLEED AIR During takeoffs or landings, the nosewheel
knobs on the pilot panel (Figure 10-9). chine deflects water and slush away from the
engine inlets to prevent flameout. For normal
operations, takeoffs, and landings, avoid slush
and water depths of more than 3/4 inch.
ENG
The ENG ANTI-ICE system is
ANTI-ICE monitored by an undertemper-
ature sensor on the ground and
Figure 10-9. Rain Removal Controls L R in flight. The L or R ENG
and Doors ANTI-ICE annunciator lights
illuminate if the temperature drops below
10°C (50°F) (undertemperature). The ENG
ANTI-ICE lights do not come on for the first Leave the switches in ENG ON and pull the
minute of undertemperature on the ground or throttles to IDLE. If the ENG ANTI-ICE lights
in flight to avoid nuisance trips of the lights. come on for undertemperature, cycle the throt-
The vigilant pilot would notice and correct the tles as often as required to keep the ENG
situation during that first minute, avoiding ANTI-ICE lights out.
unwanted caution lights. At the end of a
minute, the ENG ANTI-ICE lights illuminate Ground operations are similar for the
steady (no MASTER CAUTION lights) to at- WING/ENG selection, except the switches
tract the pilot’s attention to correct the under- are moved from WING/ENG to ENG ON when
temperature on the ground or in flight. At the the lights extinguish to protect the wings from
end of two minutes, the ENG ANTI-ICE lights overheat and the engines from icing.
flash with steady MASTER CAUTION lights
to attract the pilot’s attention to correct the un- During in flight icing operations, anti-ice idle
dertemperature. There is no overtemperature 70% N 2 is automatically selected on by ENG-
protection installed or needed for the engine ON or WING/ENG anti-ice switch position. If
anti-ice system. throttles were pulled to the IDLE stop, the
minimum idle rpm is 70% N 2 , which assures
The MASTER CAUTION lights are initially minimum heat to anti-ice the engine.
disabled when ENG ON is first selected, until
the system heats and the ENG ANTI-ICE lights Preheating the inlets and wings speeds extin-
extinguish the first time. guishing the ENG ANTI-ICE and WING
ANTI-ICE lights when ready for takeoff.
NOTE Selecting ENG ON or WING/ENG uses nor-
Bleed air will be supplied to the engine mal DC to operate the following:
anti-ice regardless of power setting
while in ENG ON or WING/ENG on • Igniters
the ground or in flight.
• T T2 heaters
These DC-powered items do not cause engine
Engines should be heated at all times in icing power loss like windshield, wing, and engine
conditions in flight and during ground taxi. To heat that use engine bleed air.
test only the engine anti-ice system when not
in icing conditions, set the throttle(s) above Landing distance is predicated on flight idle
75% N 2 power setting and select ENG ON (this 65% N 2 . Anti-ice idle 70% N 2 assures mini-
75% is for volume of bleed air not valve open- mum bleed air heat to anti-ice the engines.
ing/closing). Observe the ENG ANTI-ICE lights Lowering the landing gear increases drag and
initially on for undertemperature and out in as forces the pilot to increase throttle position for
little as 30 seconds on the ground or about two speed and the higher throttle setting assures
minutes in flight. The nacelle and generator sufficient heat to anti-ice the engines. Idle
inlets are now properly heated over 10°C (50°F). speed logic automatically changes anti-ice
Turn the switches OFF and pull the throttles to idle 70% N 2 to flight idle 65% N 2 when the
IDLE. The test is complete. The ITT may rise landing gear is extended so that landing dis-
slightly and N1 and N2 drop slightly, proving tance is correct.
the engine anti-ice valves opened.
If DC power fails, the engine anti-ice shutoff
During ground operations in icing conditions, valves fail open and N 1 power should be com-
advance the throttles above 75% N 2 and select puted with engine anti-ice ON. Opening the
ENG ON. The ENG ANTI-ICE lights come on engine anti-ice valve causes ITT to increase
as undertemperature lights for a few seconds and N 1 and N 2 to decrease.
and go out. The nacelle and generator inlets are
now properly heated warmer than 10°C (50°F).
PYLON RAM-AIR SCOOPS wing leading edges and pylon ram-air scoops.
Hot bleed air travels by the undertemperature
When the wing/engine anti-ice switches are se- sensors at the wing root outward through the
lected to WING/ENG, bleed air is supplied to wing leading edge and exits through louvers
the pylon ram-air scoops (Figure 10-10). The on the lower surface of the wingtips. During
heat prevents ice from blocking ram cooling the walkaround, check the louvers are unob-
air to the cabin and windshield heat exchang- structed. A crossflow valve (XFLOW–OFF
ers, which could result in the loss of cabin switch) provides anti-ice capability to both
and windshield bleed temperature control. wings and pylon ram-air scoops if one engine
is shut down.
104°C
T
293°C (560°F) MAX
BLEED-AIR HEATED PYLON
WING RAM-AIR SCOOPS WHEN
ANTI-ICE LEGEND WING ANTI-ICE IS ON
FlightSafety
ENGINE BLEED AIR
L R
PRECOOLED BLEED AIR 10°C (50°F)
MINIMUM TT
RAM AIR
international
ELECTRICAL HEATER
10-11
ANTI-ICE/DE-ICE
WING/ENGINE
WING XFLOW L WING/ENG R WING /ENG
10°C (50°F) T
O MINIMUM
F
F
OFF ENG ON ENG ON
104°C
PURGE AIR T
BLD AIR ENG
SHUTOFF VALVES
T
O’HEAT ANTI-ICE
WING CROSSFLOW WING ANTI-ICE PRESSURE
SHUTOFF VALVE REGULATING SHUTOFF VALVES
L R L R
(FAILS CLOSED) (FAILSAFE OPEN)
PURGE AIR T
INTAKE
T
110°C (230°F) MIN
104°C
(220°F)
MAX
T
293°C (560°F) MAX
BLEED-AIR HEATED PYLON
WING RAM-AIR SCOOPS WHEN
ANTI-ICE WING ANTI-ICE IS ON
LEGEND
ENGINE BLEED AIR
L R
FlightSafety
PRECOOLED BLEED AIR 10°C (50°F)
MINIMUM TT
RAM AIR
ELECTRICAL HEATER
international
Figure 10-12. Wing/Engine Anti-ice System—One Engine
FlightSafety
international
During ground operation in icing conditions, just as before the failure. If either WING ANTI-
advance the throttles above 75% N 2 and select ICE light comes on, it is a wing undertemper-
WING/ENG. Note the ITT increases slightly ature and the pilot knows to advance the
and the N 1 and N 2 drop slightly, indicating the remaining good engine for more heat. The
wing engine anti-ice valves opened. The WING bleed-air-heated pylon ram-air scoops are
and ENG ANTI-ICE lights illuminate as un- heated to avoid ice blockage of pylon ram-air
dertemperature lights for approximately 30 scoop cooling air to the main cabin and wind-
seconds and then extinguish. The engine and shield heat exchangers. During an inflight en-
wings are now properly heated. Select the gine shutdown, set above 75% N 2 to prevent
switches down to ENG ON and reduce the illumination of the WING and ENG ANTI-ICE
throttles to IDLE. lights for undertemperature. If normal DC fails
(no generators and BATT switch in EMER
If visible accumulations of ice are observed on position), the XFLOW valve fail-safes closed
the wing leading edges, preheating is again and the inoperative engine wing cannot be
required. Advance the throttles above 75% N 2 heated.
and select WING/ENG until the lights
extinguish. Then select ENG ON and reduce The XFLOW selection is used (1) to anti-ice the
the throttles to IDLE. If the ENG ANTI-ICE inoperative engine wing, (2) to heat a wing if the
lights illuminate at IDLE RPM (undertemper- operating engine wing anti-ice valve has failed
ature) and no ice is accumulating on the wings, closed, and (3) during an overtemperature in non-
remain in ENG ON and cycle the throttles icing flight conditions with the switches off. An
above 75% N 2 until the ENG ANTI-ICE lights overtemperature of the wings is improbable dur-
extinguish, then reduce the throttles to idle. Pre- ing flight, but if the switches are off and a WING
heat as often as required. If stopped, set the ANTI-ICE light illuminates, a wing overtemper-
parking brakes and guard the brakes to prevent ature is indicated. Undertemperature and under-
inadvertent movement of the aircraft at mod- speed monitoring is turned off in this case. This
erate power settings. When ready for takeoff, could mean a wing anti-ice valve has failed open
request a 30-second delay to activate the anti- allowing hot bleed air to flow to a wing. Reduc-
ice systems. When cleared into position, line- ing power and selecting XFLOW directs half the
up, with the nosewheel centered and brakes on. bleed air to the apparently overheated wing and
Set the throttles above 75% N 2 , and wait for half to the opposite wing to reduce heat.
the lights to extinguish (approximately 30 sec-
onds). When cleared for takeoff, you’re rolling Wing overtemperature is normally not a
down the runway with full confidence the anti- problem during flight; however, it can be a
ice equipment is operating correctly. During problem during ground operations where cool-
day operations, the wings can be easily ob- ing air is not available to extract the wing
served for ice accumulation and the need to bleed-air heat. Any wing structural overtem-
anti-ice them. During night operations, the perature over 104°C (220°F) or BLD AIR
wing inspection light may be used to see ice O’HEAT light (precooler discharge air over
accumulations on the left wing (standard). 293°C (560°F) could damage the wing lead-
Don’t forget the very important check for wing ing edge. Either overtemperature situation
icing five minutes prior to takeoff. If ice is immediately closes the wing anti-ice valves to
accumulating behind the heated wing leading- protect the wings. This condition can occur
edge area, deice fluid spray is required prior during sustained ground operation at high
to takeoff. That same icing is on the horizon- rpm. Checklist procedure has the pilot retard-
tals and other wing. ing the throttle to assist in cooldown for either
kind of overtemperature malfunction. Wing
I f a n e n g i n e i s s h u t d ow n , l e av i n g t h e structural overtemperature protection is active
WING/ENG switch on the inoperative engine in any switch position (WING/ENG, OFF, and
side in the WING/ENG position allows the ENG ON). If a wing overtemperature occurs
pilot to monitor for undertemp on that side, the (1) WING ANTI-ICE light(s) immediately
middle six-second time period, both control If the tail deice boot(s) fail, if able, monitor
valves remain deenergized open. Then, the the tips of the horizontal stabilizers for ob-
right control valve closes inflating the right hor- served icing and limit flaps to 15° maximum
izontal boot for six seconds. At the completion to avoid unexpected pitch transients due to
of the last cycle, both control valves remain tailplane icing.
deenergized for three minutes from initiation
of the cycle, and then repeat the cycle. Keep the speed of 160 KIAS minimum in
sustained icing until necessary to slow down
As each set of boots is inflated, for approach and landing.
TAIL DEICE a 16-psi pressure switch illu-
PRESS
minates the white L or R TAIL The descent from high altitude, cold soaked
L R DEICE PRESS annunciator airframe into icing conditions at temperatures
light to indicate actuating pres- near –35°C require the following thoughtful
sure has been applied (Figure consideration: should the pilot inflate the tail
10-13). deice boots at temperatures slightly warmer
than –35°C? The boots could be damaged
The amber TAIL DEICE FAIL because they are still cold soaked colder than
TAIL DEICE light illuminates during any –35°C. No guidance in this area is available.
FAIL
one of the following condi- The pilot should exercise caution before start-
tions: (1) when either the voltage to the valve ing inflation cycles on the boots. If activated
or pressure to the deice boots are not correct too early after being cold soaked, boot failure
during boot inflation cycle (pressure), (2) is possible.
when the clock to the deice timer has stopped,
or (3) when the TAIL DEICE circuit breaker
is pulled.
23-PSI REGULATOR
EJECTOR
VALVES
16-PSI
PRESSURE
SWITCH
PS PS
TAIL DEICE
PRESS
TAIL DEICE
L R FAIL
LEGEND NOTE:
FOR ANY ICING ENCOUNTER WITH INOPERATIVE HORIZONTAL BOOTS,
VACUUM AIR
THE MAXIMUM FLAP SETTING THROUGH LANDING IS 15°. MAINTAIN
SERVICE BLEED AIR 160 KIAS MINIMUM UNTIL THE APPROACH PHASE.
QUESTIONS
1. Anti-ice systems should be turned on in 5. S e l e c t t h e o n e c o r r e c t s t a t e m e n t
flight when operating in visible moisture c o n c e r n i n g t h e W / S A I R O ’ H E AT
with a MFD displayed RAT of: annunciator light:
A. +10°F and +30°F A. If the light illuminates when the sys-
B. –30°F tem is operating, the solenoid valve
C. –20°C should close, cutting off windshield
air.
D. +10°C or below
B. The light can only illuminate when
the windshield bleed-air switch is po-
2. The P/S HTR OFF light: sitioned to the MAX, LEFT or RIGHT.
A. Will illuminate, with the system se- C. T h e l i g h t a l w a y s i n d i c a t e s t h a t
lected, when current fails to any pitot the temperature of the air is
or static heating element uncontrolled.
B. Will illuminate, with the system se- D. When the light is illuminated, the
lected, if the AOA heating element rain removal augmenter doors will
has failed not operate.
C. Will not illuminate if the pitot heat
switch is OFF 6. Failure of the normal electrical system
D. Indicates that icing has caused all will result in:
pitot static instruments to be inoper-
A. Complete failure of the windshield
ative
anti-icing system
B. Continuous flow of hot bleed air, with
3. At night, ice formation can be detected by: windshield temperature control pos-
A. Wing inspection lights on the right sible only through regulation of the
side (only) of the aircraft volume of bleed air permitted to the
windshield
B. Red windshield ice detection lights
C. Continued windshield anti-icing with
C. I l l u m i n a t i o n o f t h e I C I N G D E - complete control of the bleed-air tem-
TECTED annunciator light perature
D. Any of the above are correct. D. Continuous isopropyl alcohol flow to
the windshield, to replace the normal
4. In the windshield anti-icing system: bleed-air anti-icing
A. The windshield bleed-air control valve
will fail electrically in the closed po- 7. T h e W / S A I R O ’ H E AT l i g h t w i l l
sition. illuminate:
B. An overtemperature condition is not A. If 5-psi pressure is sensed in the duct
critical since neither the ducting nor with the WINDSHIELD BLEED AIR
the windshield are vulnerable to over- switch in OFF
heat. B. If the temperature of the air going to
C. An overheat light, with the system the windshield exceeds 149°C with
ON, indicates excessive bleed-air tem- the WINDSHIELD BLEED AIR
perature. switch in the MAX, LEFT or RIGHT
D. During rain removal, the W/S AIR position
O’HEAT light will not function. C. If DC power fails
D. Both A and B are correct.
8. When using rain removal: 12. The L or R ENG ANTI-ICE light illumi-
A. The augmenter doors can be easily nates if the engine inlet temperature of the
pulled open with windshield bleed air engine drops below:
in LOW or HI flow. A. 300°C
B. The volume of bleed air to the wind- B. 10°C
shield is regulated by the LEFT–MAX C. 90°C
or RIGHT–MAX WINDSHIELD D. 120°C
BLEED AIR switch.
C. A windshield bleed overheat will not
affect rain removal. 13. The cockpit indications of the engine anti-
D. T h e a u g m e n t e r d o o r s s h o u l d b e ice system operating, and the opening of
opened prior to applying bleed air on the valves will be:
the windshield. A. Illumination of the MASTER CAU-
TION lights
B. The stator valve opens and the ENG
9. The windshield alcohol system:
ANTI-ICE light comes ON
A. Is a backup system for the windshield C. ITT rise, N 1 and N 2 decrease and the
anti-ice system amber L and R ENG ANTI-ICE annun-
B. Energizes ejectors that apply alcohol ciator panel lights ON
to both the pilot and the copilot wind- D. The nacelle temperature exceeds
shields 320°F, and the MASTER CAUTION
C. Utilizes a pump that supplies alcohol light illuminates
to the pilot windshield only for a max-
imum of ten minutes
D. Both A and C are correct. 14. If the MASTER CAUTION and WING
ANTI-ICE lights illuminate:
A. Bleed-air temperature entering the
10. Once conditions necessary to extinguish wing leading edge is less than 110° C
the ENG ANTI-ICE annunciator lights (230°F).
are satisfied, a minimum power setting
B. T h e m i n i m u m p ow e r s e t t i n g t o
to sustain the operation in flight is:
extinguish the WING ANTI-ICE is
A. 70% N 1 rpm 85% N 2 .
B. Anti-ice idle 70% N 2 rpm C. If the left engine is shut down, the
C. 60% N 2 rpm left wing cannot be anti-iced.
D. 80% N 2 rpm D. T h e m i n i m u m p ow e r s e t t i n g t o
extinguish the WING ANTI-ICE is
60% N 2 .
11. The time for the ENG ANTI-ICE annun-
ciator lights to extinguish after initiat-
ing operation in flight will vary with 15. When using the TAIL DEICE boots:
outside air temperature at cruise or climb A. They may be cycled at any temperature
thrust settings. Normally, no more than:
B. If the AUTO mode of operation is in-
A. 30 seconds operative, then the switch must be
B. 2 minutes placed to MANUAL twice to inflate
C. 10 seconds all boots
D. 5 minutes C. Illumination of the SURFACE DEICE
light always indicates a system
malfunction
D. MANUAL mode serves as a backup
way to inflate the boots
CHAPTER 11
AIR CONDITIONING
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 11-1
GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 11-1
SYSTEM DESCRIPTIONS .................................................................................................. 11-2
General........................................................................................................................... 11-2
Pylon Precoolers ............................................................................................................ 11-2
SOURCE CONTROL............................................................................................................ 11-3
Temperature Control ...................................................................................................... 11-5
System Protection .......................................................................................................... 11-8
VAPOR-CYCLE AIR CONDITIONING ............................................................................. 11-8
Introduction.................................................................................................................... 11-8
General........................................................................................................................... 11-9
Evaporators .................................................................................................................. 11-10
Controls ....................................................................................................................... 11-10
Compressor Controls ................................................................................................... 11-12
Fan Controls ................................................................................................................ 11-12
Flood-Cooling Vent ..................................................................................................... 11-13
AIR DISTRIBUTION ......................................................................................................... 11-13
Description................................................................................................................... 11-13
COCKPIT AIR DIST Knob ........................................................................................ 11-15
Defog Fan .................................................................................................................... 11-15
QUESTIONS....................................................................................................................... 11-18
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
11-1 PRESSURIZATION–ENVIRONMENTAL Control Panel ................................... 11-2
11-2 Precooler Intake and Exhaust................................................................................. 11-3
11-3 Air Source Selector ................................................................................................ 11-4
11-4 Left Pylon Ram-Air Scoop .................................................................................... 11-4
11-5 Windshield Bleed-Air Valves................................................................................. 11-5
11-6 Environmental Control Panel................................................................................. 11-5
11-7 Air Supply to Cabin ............................................................................................... 11-6
11-8 Pneumatic Equipment in Aft Baggage Compartment............................................ 11-7
11-9 COMPRESSOR ON Light..................................................................................... 11-8
11-10 Overhead WEMAC Valves..................................................................................... 11-9
11-11 Air-Conditioning Equipment ............................................................................... 11-10
11-12 Vapor Cycle Air-Conditioning System ................................................................ 11-11
11-13 Forward Evaporator.............................................................................................. 11-11
11-14 Fan Switches ........................................................................................................ 11-12
11-15 Flood-Cooling Vent.............................................................................................. 11-13
11-16 Cabin/Cockpit Distribution.................................................................................. 11-14
11-17 COCKPIT AIR DIST Knob................................................................................. 11-15
11-18 Cockpit Tilt Panel ................................................................................................ 11-16
TABLE
Table Title Page
11-1 Recommended Environmental Panel Comfort Settings ...................................... 11-17
CHAPTER 11
AIR CONDITIONING
INTRODUCTION
The environmental system uses engine bleed air to heat, cool, and pressurize the cabin
and defog the cabin and cockpit windows. Most functions are automatic. The only man-
ual inputs required are temperature and fan selection. Controls for air conditioning are
on the environmental control panel. A vapor-cycle air conditioner is standard.
GENERAL
The aircraft has a conditioned environment The pilot can select the left engine, the right
with automatic and manual temperature control. engine, or both engines to supply bleed air for
Hot bleed air is tapped off each engine, cooled system operation on the ground or in flight. The
by precoolers located in the pylons, pneumat- cabin can be supplied with fresh air during
ically controlled, manifolded to and cooled in ground or low altitude operations. Emergency
the main cabin heat exchanger by the air from pressurization is also available in flight from
the pylon ram-air inlet, and routed to the cabin. either engine.
If further cooling is necessary, two vapor-cycle
evaporator units in the cabin are plumbed to a
compressor and condenser in the tail cone.
FAN AIR
PRECOOLER
MODULATING
ENGINE VALVE
900°F
COOLER CENTRIFUGAL
BYPASS CROSSFLOW
COMPRESSOR
DUCT EXHAUST
AIR
AIR (HEAT EXTRACTED)
REGULATED
SERVICE AIR
PNEUMATIC
ACTUATOR
BLD AIR
As cooled bleed air exits the SOURCE CONTROL
O’HEAT precooler, it passes a 293°C
(560°F) overtemperature sensor The AIR SOURCE SELECT switch (Figure
L R that illuminates the yellow L 11-3) determines the sources and amount of
or R BLD AIR O’HEAT annun- bleed air that enters the cabin. The control
ciator light to inform the pilot that bleed air switch has positions labeled OFF–FRESH
entering aircraft systems is too hot. Reducing AIR–L–BOTH–R–EMER.
power (rpm) should extinguish the light below
282°C (540°F). The OFF position energizes the L and R pres-
sure regulating and shutoff valves (PRSOVs)
NOTE and the W/S bleed-air shutoff valve closed. The
When the BLD AIR O’HEAT annun- EMER valve is deenergized closed. Bleed air
ciator illuminates it shuts off the is still available to the service air system, but
wing anti-ice pressure regulating no bleed air enters the pressure vessel from the
valve on the side of the overheat, engines. The aircraft will fully depressurize
until the system cools to protect the at normal leak rate.
wing leading edge from heat damage.
HEAT VENT
L ENG R ENG
ANTI-ICE ANTI-ICE
SHUTOFF
SHUTOFF 23 PSI WINDSHIELD PR 23 PSI
PR VALVE
VALVE ANTI-ICE SOV
SOV
FCV CONTROL FCV
VALVE
REG 4 4 REG
T 475°F 8 8
475°F T
FlightSafety
FCV—FLOW CONTROL VALVE PYLON
PYLON L R REGULATES AT 4 OR 8 PPM;
PRECOOLER PRECOOLER
FAILSAFE TO 4 PPM
LEGEND
ENGINE BLEED AIR SERVICE BLEED AIR
international
PRECOOLED BLEED AIR CABIN AIR (NORMAL)
WINDSHIELD ANTI-ICE AIR/
RAM AIR EMERGENCY PRESSURIZATION
WINDSHIELD HEAT
LEFT PYLON RAM SCOOP EXCHANGER MAIN CABIN RIGHT PYLON RAM
COOL AIR HEAT EXCHANGER SCOOP COOL AIR
MUFFLER
EXTRACTED HEAT
FRESH AIR FAN
OVERBOARD
AFT PRESSURE BULKHEAD
THIS OPENING IS
BEHIND THE
ATTENUATOR
COOLING AIR IN
COOLING AIR IN
HEAT
EXCHANGER
FAN
HEAT
EXTRACTED
OUT
CONDENSOR
AIR CONDITIONING IN
RIGHT REAR TAIL CONE
HEAT
EXTRACTED
OUT
EVAPORATORS CONTROLS
There are two evaporators (Figure 11-12) in Controls for the air-conditioning system con-
the vapor-cycle system. The forward evapora- sist of a three-position compressor control
tor is on the left side, forward of the cabin entry switch and two three-position fan switches,
door, while the rear evaporator is mounted on located on the environmental control panel.
the cabin side at the bottom of the aft pressure The aft fan (evaporator) switch also controls
bulkhead under the hump cover. The aft evap- the flood-cooling diverter door solenoid valve.
orator is connected to the overhead WEMAC Additionally, the system is controlled by the
distribution system as well as a flood-cooling cabin temperature control system. The air-
outlet located near the upper rear bulkhead. craft is also equipped with automatic load
Care should be taken to ensure evaporator in- shedding. In flight, both generators must be
lets are not blocked. The air is driven across operating in order for the compressor drive
the evaporator coils with electrically powered motor to operate. In the event of a generator
blowers (Figure 11-13). failure, the compressor is automatically dis-
connected from the power source. The fans are
energized anytime the air-conditioning se-
lect switch is placed in the AUTO or FAN po-
sitions. A COMPRESSOR ON green light
will illuminate when there is power applied
to the compressor.
RECEIVER/DRYER
CONDENSOR
MODULE
DEFOG FAN
AFT PRESSURE
BULKHEAD
FLOOR WEMACS
GRILL
COMPRESSOR CONTROLS bleed air) and the limit switch on. This will
power the compressor. The cabin is provided
The air-conditioning switch is labeled with refrigerant cooling while the ram-air
AUTO–OFF–FAN (Figure 11-14). The com- modulating valve controls bleed-air
pressor is wired to run in OFF/FAN if DEFOG temperature to the cabin. As conditions change
HI or LOW is selected. and the ram-air modulating valve drives 50%
closed, a second limit switch will remove
The cabin temperature sensor is located in the power from the compressor. On the ground
inlet duct to the aft evaporator. Therefore, the no ram air is available, the ram-air valve will
AIR COND switch must be in AUTO or FAN drive full open any time the cabin temperature
to enable the aft fan to operate in LOW, HI or is above the cabin temperature control set
FLOOD, and for the automatic cabin temper- point engaging the compressor. The ram-air
ature control system to function properly (have modulating valve will drive toward closed any
steady air flow). Care must be taken not to time the cabin temperature is below the se-
block the aft evaporator fan inlet, at the rear lected temperature removing power from the
of the dropped aisle, with baggage. Blocking compressor. This provides temperature control
the aft evaporator fan inlet will cause erratic of the vapor-cycle system in flight and on the
cabin temperature control. ground.
In the AUTO position, the blowers and the
cabin temperature control system are ener- FAN CONTROLS
gized. Power is also applied to the ram-air The forward (FWD) evaporator fan switch,
modulating valve, which controls the amount labeled LOW–AUTO–HI (Figure 11-14), con-
of pylon ram inlet air used for the cabin air heat trols the forward evaporator fan. In the AUTO
exchanger and operates the compressor limit position, the forward fan will operate at a low
switches. In flight, with warm cabin condi- speed only while the compressor is activated.
tions, the ram-air modulating valve will drive The LOW and HI positions will continuously
full open (asking for maximum cooling of the
O
F FRESH EMER
F AIR
OFF
FAN
FAN
COMPRESSOR AFT FWD DEFOG
ON FLOOD HI HI
A
H U O
I T F
O F
LOW LOW LOW
The circuit breakers for the evaporator fans are When selecting fresh air, a yel-
FRESH
located on the left-side cockpit circuit-breaker AIR low FRESH AIR annunciator and
panel with the other environmental breakers. a yellow MASTER CAUTION
light illuminates steady.
FLOOD-COOLING VENT
The flood-cooling vent assembly (4 inches by OPERATION
8 inches) is located behind the interior panel The overhead ventilation system is routed
near the top of the aft pressure bulkhead (Fig- along the ceiling forward of the aft pressure
ure 11-15). The flood solenoid is spring-loaded bulkhead. The system recirculates cabin air
to the flood position in the absence of 23-psi through the aft evaporator and operates only
service air pressure, i.e., no engine running. The when the AIR COND switch is set to FAN or
flood-cooling door closes if the AFT fan switch AUTO. At least one engine must be operating
is in the LOW or HI position when the service to provide engine bleed air to move the flood
air system is pressurized (any engine operating) vent solenoid closed, forcing all aft evapora-
and the air flows to the overhead WEMACs. tor air to the overhead WEMACs.
ARMREST DUCT
FLOOR DUCT
WINDSHIELD
BLEED-AIR DUCT MUFFLER
RAM AIR
MODU-
FLOOR DUCT
23 PSI
LATING
VALVE
ARMREST DUCT
WING ANTI-ICE DUCT
LEGEND
CHECK VALVES
SHUTOFF VALVES
TEMP SENSORS
COCKPIT AIR DIST KNOB and armrest outlets. Passenger armrest outlets
are located along the outboard cabin wall at
The left half of the PRESSURIZATION– passenger seat armrest level. Air outlet holes
ENVIRONMENTAL tilt panel has the COCK- are located under the armrest cover assembly
PIT AIR DIST knob in the top center panel area with the origin of air being identical to the
(Figure 11-17). There are two solenoid valves footwarmer outlets.
at the lower right aft pressure bulkhead giving
four positions. The four detents of the COCK-
PIT AIR DIST knob electrically controls and DEFOG FAN
pneumatically actuates the two spring-loaded A DEFOG fan is located in the right cockpit
(retracted) valves, using 23-psi service air. This sidewall (Figure 11-18). The two-speed blower
provides the crew a more comfortable environ- is controlled by a DEFOG (HI–OFF–LOW)
ment and better windshield moisture control. switch on the environmental control panel (see
Figure 11-14). The forward evaporator diverter
The selected positions are as follows: valve is installed under the pilot and copilot
SWITCH CREW PASSENGER
floor area. It is spring-loaded to direct the for-
DETENTS AIR AIR ward evaporator air to the flush-floor grille. The
DEFOG fan switch should be selected to HI
NORM (9 O’CLOCK) 50% 50% prior to descent and approach.
(11 O’CLOCK) 60% 40%
(1 O’CLOCK) 70% 30%
Selecting HI or LO operates the vapor-cycle air-
conditioning system at all altitudes if the re-
MAX (3 O’CLOCK) 80% 20%
frigerant is sufficiently warm, regardless of
switch position (even OFF). Selecting HI or LO
The COCKPIT AIR DIST knob is normally
automatically turns on the vapor-cycle com-
kept in NORM for climb and cruise and is se-
pressor, the FWD evaporator fan speed to HI,
lected to MAX for descent and approach.
and sends 23-psi service air to the diverter
valve pneumatic actuator. This overcomes the
Pilot and copilot footwarmer air flows from the
spring moving the diverter door to direct the
sidewall ducts at floor level under the rudder ped-
majority of air from the floor grille to the
als and picollos the air vertically across the feet.
DEFOG fan inlet. The DEFOG fan, at HI or LO
fan speed, boosts the dry evaporator air to the
Passenger footwarmer outlets are located along
inside windshield surface. Water condensa-
the outboard cabin walls at floor level. The
tion is routed overboard through two heat vents
outlets receive air from underfloor ducting
under the fuselage, one near the forward evap-
near the aft pressure bulkhead. A single cabin
orator and the other near the aft evaporator.
side duct supplies air to both the footwarmer
Table 11-1 shows AFM-recommended envi-
ronmental panel comfort settings. Cabin nor-
COCKPIT AIR DIST mal settings are listed in the left column and
variations from normal are listed for the con-
ditions in the columns to the right. It is rec-
ommended that the autotemperature selector
N remain at the 1-o’clock position. Recom-
O M mended settings for descent are also listed.
R A
M X
CABIN IF IF IF
NORMAL CABIN COCKPIT COCKPIT
SETTINGS WARM COOL
AIR SOURCE
OR IF INITIALLY
INITIALLY WARM
COOL OR OR
COLD HOT
SELECT BOTH
QUESTIONS
1. When controlling the cabin temperature 5. The cabin heat exchanger ram-air
with the manual temperature toggle modulating valve is opened for cooler
switch, the ram-air modulating valve is cabin air or closed for warmer cabin
positioned from full hot to full cold in ap- source air by:
proximately: A. Automatic temperature control
A. 18 seconds B. Manually toggling the 15-second
B. 6 seconds motorized valve
C. 3 seconds C. A and B
D. 15 seconds D. COCKPIT AIR DIST knob
2. The AIR DUCT O’HEAT annunciator 6. The source of bleed air when the EMER
light illuminates when the: PRESS ON annunciator is illuminated in
A. ACM shuts down flight is:
B. Temperature of air in the duct to the A. Either the left, right, or both engines
cabin is over 149°C (300°F). B. Left engine only
C. Temperature of the air going to the C. Right engine only
windshield is excessive. D. Ram air
D. EMER source is selected unless the
left throttle is retarded.
7. The vapor-cycle compressor may be on
(green light—on) when:
3. How can the windshield anti-ice shutoff A. Air conditioner in AUTO on a hot day
valve be opened? with the ram-air modulating valve full
A. Lost DC power open
B. S e l e c t w i n d s h i e l d a n t i - i c e t o H I B. Any altitude in AUTO
or LOW C. On the ground without ram air, the
C. S e l e c t E M E R p r e s s u r e m o d e ram valve will motorize FULL OPEN
(6 ppm) any time cabin temperature is above
D. All of the above the cabin temperature control set point
engaging the compressor
D. All of the above
4. Hot engine bleed air through the precooler
is cooled by:
A. Engine bypass air 8. The vapor-cycle compressor is off (green
light—out) when:
B. A 23-psi fan air modulating valve
system A. AIR COND circuit breaker is popped
C. Ram scoop air B. Ram-air modulating valve more than
D. A and B 50% closed in AUTO
C. A u t o m a t i c l o a d - s h e d d i n g c i r c u i t
during engine or generator failure
D. All of the above
9. What closes the L and/or R PRSOVs: 14. During climb and cruise, the COCKPIT
A. Selecting L or R AIR DIST knob is selected to:
B. S e l e c t i n g F R E S H A I R , E M E R A. MAX, 80% air to crew
or OFF B. 11 o’clock, 60% air to crew
C. In AUTO, during cabin taxi tempera- C. NORM, 50% air to crew
tures over 18°C (65°F), temperature D. 10 o’clock, 70% air to crew
sensor closes the PRSOVs
D. All of the above
15. Cabin air is circulated through two evap-
orators; one is in the forward left cabin,
10. The pilot and copilot footwarmer outlets just ahead of the main cabin entry door,
are located: and one is on the aft pressure bulkhead.
A. On the cockpit sidewalls The aft evaporator provides conditioned
air to the:
B. Under the pilot and copilot rudder
pedals A. Forward diffuser
C. On the side of the throttle pedestal B. Overhead WEMAC valves
D. Under the pilot and copilot seats C. Side-wall outlets
D. Flood-cooling vent only
11. In the AUTO position, the forward fan is
OFF except: 16. The cabin air temperature in the AUTO
A. When flood cooling is selected mode will keep the cabin temperature in
a selectable range of:
B. When the compressor is on, then op-
erating at low speed A. 12° to 35°C
C. When the compressor is on, then op- B. 50° to 75°F
erating at high speed C. 65° to 85°F
D. When the compressor is on, then op- D. 18° to 29°C
erating at medium speed
17. The ram-air modulating valve controls:
12. The AFT fan switch is labeled: A. The amount of cooling ram inlet air
A. LOW, OFF or HI that passes through the main cabin
B. LOW, HI, and FLOOD heat exchanger
C. LOW, AUTO or HI B. The amount of air flowing into the
D. LOW, MED or HI cabin from the pylon ram air inlets
when the FRESH AIR position is se-
lected
13. The forward fan switch is labeled: C. B e l ow 1 8 , 0 0 0 f e e t , a b a r o m e t r i c
A. LOW, AUTO or HI switch shuts OFF the operation of the
B. LOW, OFF or HI ram air modulating valve
C. LOW, MED or HI D. Air to the aft evaporator
D. AUTO, OFF or HI
18. Selecting the FRESH AIR position: 19. The EPU is powering the compressor and
A. Turns on the refrigerant to cool the both evaporators in AUTO on a hot day be-
cabin fore engine start. The pilot is concerned
t h a t n o c o o l a i r i s ve n t i n g t h e c r ew
B. Depressurizes the cabin in flight
o v e r h e a d W E M AC s w h e n t h e A F T
C. Must not be used during ground op- evaporator fan switch is in HI or LOW:
erations
A. This is normal.
D. Will not affect normal pressurized
flight B. The flood-cooling door springloads to
the flood cool (open) position without
23-psi service air.
C. With any engine running, 23-psi serv-
ice air will close the flood-cooling doors,
thus sending all aft evaporator cooling
air to the overhead WEMACs.
D. All of the above
CHAPTER 12
PRESSURIZATION
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION................................................................................................................. 12-1
GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 12-1
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................... 12-2
Digital Pressure Controller ............................................................................................ 12-2
Outflow Valves .............................................................................................................. 12-2
PRESSURIZATION CONTROL .......................................................................................... 12-3
General........................................................................................................................... 12-3
Automatic Mode ............................................................................................................ 12-5
Isobaric Mode ................................................................................................................ 12-5
Manual Pressurization Control ...................................................................................... 12-6
Exercise Test Button...................................................................................................... 12-6
Emergency Cabin Dump ............................................................................................... 12-7
High Altitude Departures............................................................................................... 12-8
KAPS Autoschedule Control Zones—Takeoff, Climb, and Cruise............................ 12-10
QUESTIONS ...................................................................................................................... 12-18
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
12-1 Environmental Control Panel................................................................................. 12-2
12-2 Pressurization System Diagram ............................................................................. 12-3
12-3 Primary Outflow Valve Operation ......................................................................... 12-4
12-4 Pressurization Controller ....................................................................................... 12-5
12-5 Pressurization MANUAL–AUTO Switch ............................................................. 12-5
12-6 Cabin Controller—EXER Exercise Test Button.................................................... 12-7
12-7 CABIN DUMP Switch .......................................................................................... 12-7
12-8 Modified Cabin Rate Limits .................................................................................. 12-8
12-9 Autopressurization Schedule ................................................................................. 12-8
12-10 Climb/Descent Examples on Pressurization Controller with Autoschedule ......... 12-9
12-11 Pressurization Example........................................................................................ 12-11
12-12 Aircraft Altitude vs Cabin Altitude Chart ........................................................... 12-17
CHAPTER 12
PRESSURIZATION
INTRODUCTION
The pressurization system on the Citation CJ2 is used to maintain a lower cabin (pres-
sure vessel) altitude than actual airplane altitude. This is accomplished by ducting bleed
air into the cabin, and then controlling the amount of air allowed to escape overboard.
On the Citation CJ2, the pressurization and air-conditioning system employ a common
airflow; therefore, cabin pressurization is accomplished with conditioned air.
GENERAL
Two elements are required to provide cabin automatically or manually. Automatic control
pressurization. One is a constant source of air. requires DC power and is not available dur-
The other is a method of controlling outflow ing emergency electrical power operations.
to achieve the desired differential pressure and Selecting AUTO mode with the air data sen-
resultant cabin altitude. In the Citation CJ2, sor operating, generates an autoschedule
airflow to the cabin is fairly constant (through based on the departure field elevation, the
a wide range of engine power settings), and maximum altitude reached, and the pilot input
the outflow of air is controlled by the two of destination elevation. Maximum cabin dif-
outflow valves located on the aft pressure ferential pressure is 9.0 psid.
bulkhead. The outflow valves are controlled
CHERRY PICKER
NOSEWHEEL SECONDARY
VACUUM OUTFLOW
CHERRY VALVE
PICKER
CABIN DIFFERENTIAL VALVE
PRESSURE GAGE
15 20 FILTER
10 25
FL 13%
4 5 SET ALT
3 6 30
2 7 DIGITAL PRESSURE
FL EXER
5 1 8 35 CONTROLLER
0 9 40
0 45 0%
SET
RATE
ALT
PRESSURIZATION - ENVIRONMENTAL
C
A PRESS SYSTEM SELECT
B MANUAL UP
I
N DEPRESSURIZATION CABIN
D
BEFORE LANDING PRIMARY
U
M AUTO OUTFLOW
P DOWN VALVE
LH RH CHERRY
FULL FULL PICKER
T T
H H CABIN ALTITUDE MAX DIFF
R R 85% N2 CLIMB DIAPHRAGM
O O LIMIT VALVE VALVE
T T SOLENOID
T T
L L DIVE
E E DC POWER
S S
BATT SOLENOID
OFF
SQUAT 23-PSI SERVICE SYSTEM AIR
OFF OFF SWT
EMER
VACUUM
EJECTOR NOTE:
Condition—Ground Taxi Mode
LEGEND
CABIN PRESSURIZED AIR VACUUM OR PRESSURE TO OUTFLOW VALVES VENTURI AIR
VACUUM FROM NOSE WHEELWELL OUTFLOW AIR TO TAIL CONE CLIMB SOLENOID VACUUM FROM EJECTOR
CABIN PRESSURIZED AIR TO CHERRY PICKER 23-PSI SERVICE SYSTEM AIR
MANUAL
PRESSURIZATION
CONTROL VALVE
MAX
DIFF
DOWN
(PRESSURE)
CABIN ALT
LIMIT VALVE
FLIGHT
LANDING GEAR
SQUAT SWITCH
AUTO
PRESSURE
MAX
SENSOR PORT DIFF
(WORKING WITH ADC)
CABIN ALT
MANUAL PRESSURE LIMIT VALVE
MANUAL–AUTO
SWITCH CABIN DUMP
SWITCH
LEGEND
SERVICE
AMBIENT AIR PRESSURE (23 PSI) AIR 23 PSI
CABIN AIR VACUUM CONTROL AIR
The primary outflow valve has two normally When the AUTO–MANUAL switch (Figure
closed solenoids that let air into and out of the 12-5) is in the AUTO position, the pilot selects
valve control chambers. When the cabin dive destination elevation (accomplished during
solenoid is energized open, it allows 23-psi the “Before Taxi” checklist). Descent and
service air to pressurize both valve control landing are made by setting the controller to
chambers and push the valves toward closed. destination elevation.
When the cabin climb solenoid is energized
open, it allows vacuum from the 23-psi serv-
ice air ejector to move both valves toward PRESS SYSTEM SELECT
open. The solenoid airflow is designed so it MANUAL UP
cannot overpower (1) the maximum cabin al-
titude limit valves, (2) the maximum differen-
tial pressure valves, or (3) the manual toggle
valve. The solenoids receive DC electrical AUTO
pulses from the controller that cause the so- DOWN
lenoids to momentarily pop open and gener-
ate gradual pressure changes in the control Figure 12-5. Pressurization
chambers. Audible clicks are produced when MANUAL–AUTO Switch
the solenoids pop open. The clicks can be
heard when the engines are off. The system is In flight, the controller continuously gener-
designed to respond rapidly to small cabin ates an autoschedule based on the departure
pressure variations and correct them before field elevation, the maximum altitude reached
passengers and crew detect any discomfort. in the current flight (per the air data sensor
computer), and the operator input destina-
tion elevation. The controller determines the
AUTOMATIC MODE pressure rate of change and the cabin pressure
The pressurization controller is comprised of altitude based on the autoschedule and the
two digital windows marked SET ALT and air data computer pressure altitude. The con-
RATE, an FL button, an EXER button, and a troller sends DC pulses through the primary
SET ALT knob (Figure 12-4). outflow valve climb and dive solenoids to ob-
tain a specific cabin pressure. The autosched-
ule will have the cabin completely
depressurized at the SLA (selected landing
pressure altitude) before touchdown.
ISOBARIC MODE
If the left air data computer information is in-
SET ALT terrupted, the controller will automatically
switch the flight mode from AUTO to ISO-
FL EXER BARIC. A yellow caution light appears on the
upper left corner of the pressurization con-
troller display face to advise of this malfunc-
tion. The pilot-selected destination elevation
on the controller display will be replaced with
flight level (FL), allowing the pilot to set the
SET RATE desired cruising altitude. The controller uses
ALT the flight level to control the cabin pressure rate
of change and the cabin pressure altitude to
maintain near maximum differential pressure
Figure 12-4. Pressurization Controller (Figure 12-6).
The pilot may recall the selected destination The cabin pressure rate of change is limited
field altitude by pressing the FL pushbutton by the orifice in the MANUAL toggle valve and
on the controller. The selected flight level on is not adjustable by the pilot. The MANUAL
the controller display will be replaced with toggle valve orifice cannot overpower the
cabin altitude (CA), allowing the pilot to set maximum differential pressure valve or the
the desired cabin altitude prior to landing. maximum altitude limit valve, but can over-
The controller then controls the cabin pressure ride the solenoid valves. Manual toggle valve
rate of change to maintain the displayed cabin operation requires considerable attention to as-
altitude. The pilot may “flip-flop” between sure reaching desired cabin altitude.
the FL and CA displays at any time by press-
ing the FL pushbutton on the controller. CABIN
The cabin pressure controller
ALT and ARINC 421 bus will cause
If the air data computer information resumes, the CABIN ALT warning light
the controller automatically removes the FL to illuminate at 10,000 feet if the pressure
indication and the yellow caution light extin- controller is set at or below 8,000 feet. The
guishes to normal operation. cabin pressure controller will cause the CABIN
ALT light to illuminate at 14,500 feet if the
Complete cabin pressure controller failure is controller is set to land above 8,000 to 14,000
indicated by a steady red light in the upper left feet destination elevation. The controller is ad-
corner of the controller. The digits go blank justed for nonstandard baro settings.
and the outflow valves capture and hold cur-
rent cabin pressure. The red knob must then
be used to manually control cabin pressure. EXERCISE TEST BUTTON
The pilot is provided with a preflight ground
MANUAL PRESSURIZATION test function. It is activated with an engine run-
ning and the entrance door closed and locked
CONTROL by pressing and holding the system exercise
When the MANUAL–AUTO switch is in the (EXER) button on the face of the pressuriza-
MANUAL position, electric power to open tion controller on the cockpit tilt panel (Fig-
the climb and dive solenoids is removed. The ure 12-6). If the button is held, the cabin will
pilot must control the cabin pressure altitude gradually pressurize at 100 fpm to 200 feet
by moving the MANUAL toggle valve. Cabin below field elevation in about two minutes. Re-
altitude can be increased or decreased by hold- leasing the button terminates the exercise.
ing the red knob (cherry picker) in the UP or Punching the EXER button in flight is a light
DOWN positions. Manual control uses cabin test and does not effect pressurization.
air for positive pressure to stop outflows, and
it uses nosewheel compartment air, through a The light test consists of pressing the EXER
regulator, for vacuum to open both outflow button for approximately one second and re-
valves. This system is independent of airplane leasing the button. The SET ALT and RATE
vacuum or electrical power. The UP position displayed numbers disappear and the four
allows outflow valve control chamber air to be LEDs illuminate in sequence. First, the SET
vented into the nose wheel well. The DOWN ALT LEDs and yellow light (upper left corner)
position allows cabin air pressure into the out- come on briefly, then the SET ALT goes blank
flow valve control chamber, closing the out- (yellow light still on). Then, the RATE LEDs
flow valve causing cabin pressure altitude to come on with the yellow light (upper left cor-
dive (see Figure 12-2). ner) still on. The test ends as the former num-
bers reappear to set destination elevation for
takeoff in the SET ALT window from (–) 1,000
feet to 14,000 feet.
C
FL A
SET ALT B
I
FL EXER N
D
U
SET RATE M
ALT
P
2,000
1,500
1,000
HIGH ALTITUDE DEPARTURES
500 Departing from high altitude airports between
0
8,000 and 14,000 feet require the three follow-
8,000 9,000 10,000 11,000 12,000 13,000 14,000 ing conditions before the controller switches
AIRFIELD ALTITUDE (FT) to the high altitude mode:
LEGEND
DIVE CLIMB • Aircraft on the ground (left squat switch
GOG)
Figure 12-8. Modified Cabin Rate Limits • Aircraft altitude greater than 8,000 feet
Landing at high altitude airfields between • Cabin altitude greater than 8,000 feet
8,000 and 14,000 feet, the two following con- For a 14,000-foot elevation airport takeoff
ditions have to be met before the controller and landing at a 3,000-foot elevation airport:
switches to the high altitude mode: After takeoff, the cabin altitude begins a dive
toward 8,000 feet at 1,500 fpm. The cabin al-
• Set landing altitude (SLA) is greater titude should reach 8,000 feet at or before the
than 8,000 feet aircraft is at FL 250, depending upon the air-
• Aircraft altitude is between 8,000 and craft climb rate. During descent, as the aircraft
25,000 feet descends 500 feet below cruise altitude, the
cabin begins to rate down towards SLA (3,000
Landing at a high altitude airport, cabin pres- feet). The cabin should reach SLA when the
sure should not exceed 8,000 feet prior to the aircraft is 1,500 feet above landing field ele-
aircraft altitude descending below FL 245. vation and maintain this altitude until landing
Descending below FL 245, the cabin altitude (Figures 12-9 and 12-10).
30,000
DESCENT TO SET
25,000 LANDING FIELD
10,000
0
0 2,000 4,000 6,000 8,000 10,000 12,000 14,000
500 FEET
500 FEET UNDER
45,000 FEET HIGHEST CRUISE
ALTITUDE, THE CABIN
PASSING 1,500 FEET AGL STARTS DOWN
IN CL CABIN DRIVES STRAIGHT-LINE
DOWN TO 8,000 FEET 1,500 FEET AGL TO AIRPORT
ELEVATION
8,500 FEET
8,300 FEET
HIGH ALTITUDE AIRPORT
(AUTOSCHEDULE) CABIN PRESSURE
8,000 FEET
NORMAL AIRPORT
(AUTOSCHEDULE)
7,500 FEET
7,300 FEET
NOTE:
USE CHERRY PICKER
TO DRIVE CABIN LOWER,
IF DESIRED, AT HIGHER
TAKEOFF ELEVATIONS.
20,000 FEET
1,500 FEET
1,300 FEET AGL
1,100 FEET CABIN AT
AIRPORT ELEVATION
CABIN STARTS UP AT
SL –200 FEET
AUTOSCHEDULED ALTITUDE
Zone 2
Cabin Altitude Above
Autoschedule Boundary
Zone 2 control—Whenever the aircraft is in
proximity to the aircraft’s top altitude and
cabin altitude is greater than the autoschedule
boundary, but less than the cabin operational
ceiling, the controller commands cabin altitude
to climb (depressurize) to the autoschedule
boundary at the maximum cabin climb rate of
600 fpm.
PRESSURIZATION EXAMPLE 1:
• TAKEOFF ELEVATION—1,000 FT
• TOP CRUISE ALTITUDE—16,000 FT
• SELECTED LANDING ELEVATION—3,000 FT
20
CJ2 SCHEDULE
BOUNDARY 16,000 FT TOP
CRUISE ALTITUDE ZONE 4
15
TO 15,000 FT
AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
10
ZONE 3
CLIMB/CRUISE 4,500 FT
5
NEGATIVE
1,500 FT
ΔP LINE
TO 1,000 FT
3,000 FT ELEVATION
800 FT
–2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CABIN ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
AUTOSCHEDULE
BOUNDARY 16,000 FT TOP
CRUISE ALTITUDE 15,500 FT
4,500 FT
1,500 FT
3,000 FT ELEV
1,000 FT ELEV
CABIN PRESSURE
800 FT 800 FT
PREPRESSURIZATION
MODE
PRESSURIZATION EXAMPLE 2:
• TAKEOFF ELEVATION—1,000 FT
• TOP CRUISE ALTITUDE—35,000 FT
• SELECTED LANDING ELEVATION—3,000 FT
SLA
35
FL345
ZONE 2
30
AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
25
ZONE 2
CJ2 SCHEDULE
20 BOUNDARY
19,000 FT
ZONE 4
15
10
5,100 FT
ZONE 3
CLIMB 4,500 FT
5
1,500 FT
TO 1,000 FT
NEGATIVE
0 3,000 FT ΔP LINE
800 FT ELEVATION
–2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CABIN ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
35,000 FT
500 FT 34,500 FT
ULE 19,000 FT
ED
S CH RY
TO A
AU OUND CABIN PRESSURE 4,500 FT MSL
B
5,100 FT 1,500 FT
3,000 FT ELEV
1,000 FT ELEV
800 FT
PRESSURIZATION EXAMPLE 3:
• TAKEOFF ELEVATION—7,000 FT
• TOP CRUISE ALTITUDE—37,000 FT
• SELECTED LANDING ELEVATION—3,000 FT
45
40
FL370
36,500 FT
35 SLA
ZONE 2
30
AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
CJ2 SCHEDULE
25 BOUNDARY
20 ZONE 1
ZONE 4
15
10
TO 7,000 FT
ZONE 3 6,800 FT
4,500 FT
5
1,500 FT 5,600 FT
LANDING NEGATIVE
0 3,000 FT ΔP LINE
–2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CABIN ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
37,000 FT
36,500 FT LE
U
ED RY
H A
SC ND
O
T U
AU BO 7,000 FT ELEV
1,000 FT ELEV
PRESSURIZATION EXAMPLE 4:
• TAKEOFF ELEVATION—9,000 FT
• TOP CRUISE ALTITUDE—37,000 FT
• SELECTED LANDING ELEVATION—5,000 FT
45
40
(–) 100 FPM
FL370
TO 5,600 FT
36,500 FT CABIN
35 BOUNDARY
SLA
ZONE 4
ZONE 2
(–) 100 FPM
30
AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
CJ2 SCHEDULE
25 BOUNDARY
20 ZONE 1
ZONE 4
15
ZONE 1
(–) 500 FPM
10
6,500 FT
ZONE 3
9,000 FT
1,500 FT
5 8,000 FT
5,600 FT
LANDING
5,000 FT
0
NEGATIVE
ΔP LINE
–2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CABIN ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
37,000 FT
36,500 FT
9,000 FT ELEV
LE
DU 8,800 FT
C HE Y
S R 7,800 FT
TO DA
AU OUN
B (–) 500 FPM
CABIN PRESSURE ZONE 1
5,600 FT (–) 100 FPM
6,500 FT 1,500 ZONE 4
FT
5,000 FT ELEV
PRESSURIZATION EXAMPLE 5
(HIGH ALTITUDE LANDING MODE):
• TAKEOFF ELEVATION—5,000 FT
• TOP CRUISE ALTITUDE—37,000 FT
• SELECTED LANDING ELEVATION—14,000 FT
45
40
37,000 FT
35
30 CJ2 SCHEDULE
BOUNDARY
AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
DESCENT THROUGH
7,800 FT 24,500 FT
25 CABIN
PRESSURE
CABIN RISES
AT 2,500 FPM
20
1,500 FT
–2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
CABIN ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
E 15,500 FT
D UL 1,500 FT
Y
HE AR 14,000 FT ELEV
SC ND
TO U 2,500 FPM
AU BO
7,800 FPM
PRESSURIZATION EXAMPLE 6
(HIGH ALTITUDE TAKEOFF MODE):
• TAKEOFF ELEVATION—14,000 FT
• TOP CRUISE ALTITUDE—37,000 FT
• SELECTED LANDING ELEVATION—5,000 FT
45
36,500 FT
35
25
7,800 FT ZONE 1
CABIN
AUTO
20 PRESSURE
SCHEDULE 1,500 FT
15,000 FT
ZONE 4 14,000 FT
15 13,800 FT
CABIN RISES
(–) 1,500 FPM
TAKEOFF
10
(–) 100 FPM
6,500 FT HIGH ALTITUDE TAKEOFFS:
1,500 FT
• WEIGHT ON WHEELS
5 5,000 FT • ARINC ACFT ALT >8,000 FT
7,800 FT NEGATIVE
ΔP LINE ZONE 4
SLA CABIN • CABIN ALT >8,000 FT
5,800 FT
0
–2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
CABIN ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
37,000 FT
36,500 FT
Y LE
AR U
14,000 FT ELEV
D D
N E
U CH
BO OS
7,800 13,800 FT
T
AU
FPM
(–)1,500 FPM
5,800 FT
6,500 FT (–)100 FPM
1,500 FT ZONE 4
5,000 FT ELEV
45
40
35 SLA
ZONE 2
30
AIRCRAFT ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
CJ2 SCHEDULE
25 BOUNDARY
20 ZONE 1
ZONE 4
15
10
ZONE 3
NEGATIVE
0 ΔP LINE
–2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
CABIN ALTITUDE (X 1,000 FEET)
QUESTIONS
1. Pressurization of the airplane is normally 5. What CLOSES the two outflow valves to
maintained by: dive the cabin?
A. Controlling the amount of air enter- A. AUTO uses digital cabin pressure con-
ing the cabin troller to meter 23-psi service air pres-
B. Controlling the amount of air escap- sure to close the primary valve
ing the cabin B. In the MANUAL switch position,
C. Modulating the temperature of the using the red knob to manually meter
cabin temperature controller cabin pressurized air to the secondary
D. Manipulating the throttles valve
C. None of the above
D. A and B above
2. The normal outflow valve control modes
are:
A. Ground taxi mode 6. If control vacuum becomes excessive in
flight, cabin altitude:
B. Prepressurization mode
C. Flight mode A. Explosively decompresses to cruise
altitude
D. All of the above
B. Stays where it is
C. Rises to the maximum altitude limit
3. Both throttles are advanced above 85% N2 valve setting of 14,500 feet, where
on the ground. The outflow valves slowly cabin pressure enters the valve reduc-
close, driving cabin pressure 200 feet ing vacuum effect and the cabin lev-
below field altitude. This is the: els at 14,500 feet
A. Flight mode D. Decreases to a value as determined
B. Ground mode by the maximum differential pressure
C. Prepressurization mode valve setting
D. None of the above
7. The normal mode for controlling cabin
pressure is the:
4. What OPENS the two outflow valves to
climb the cabin? A. AUTO mode
A. AUTO uses the digital cabin pressure B. MANUAL mode
controller to meter ejector vacuum to C. Isobaric mode
the climb solenoid of the primary D. None of the above
valve
B. The CABIN DUMP switch sends DC
8. The source of bleed air for cabin pressur-
power to the climb solenoid and the
ization when the EMERG PRESS ON
cabin rises to the 14,500 feet cabin al-
light is illuminated in flight is:
titude limit valve
C. With the MANUAL switch selection A. Vapor-cycle air
and using the red knob to manually B. Right engine
meter ambient low pressure air to the C. Either or both engines
secondary valve D. Pylon ram air
D. All of the above
9. The source of bleed air for cabin pressur- 12. During taxi out, the controller is set to:
ization when the EMERG PRESS ON A. Destination elevation
light is illuminated is:
B. Cruise plus 1,000 feet in the FL mode
A. Freon C. Field pressure altitude plus 500 feet
B. 120°F bleed air from the windshield D. 300 to 500 fpm on the cabin rate-of-
anti-ice bleed-air shutoff valve and 6 climb control
ppm flow from the EMER valve
C. Left and right bleed-air shutoff valves
D. Pylon ram-scoop air 13. The controller on the tilt panel continu-
ously generates an autoschedule while in
flight, based on:
10. The DC-powered pressure controller A. Departure field elevation, the maxi-
modes are: mum altitude reached, and pilot input
A. Isobaric mode of destination elevation
B. AUTO mode B. I n f o r m a t i o n i n p u t s m a d e i n
C. MANUAL mode MANUAL using red knob
D. A and B above C. Cabin always at maximum differential
pressure
D. Departure field elevation only
11. I f t h e a i r d a t a c o m p u t e r f a i l s
in flight:
A. T h e c o n t r o l l e r a m b e r l i g h t 14. O n t h e g r o u n d , w i t h e i t h e r e n g i n e
illuminates and CA switches to operating below 85% N 2 :
FL isobaric mode. A. Only the primary outflow valve opens.
B. It remains in the CA AUTO mode. B. Neither outflow will open.
C. Only manual control remains. C. Both outflow valves are open.
D. It automatically switches to the EXER D. Only the secondary outflow valve
mode. opens.
CHAPTER 13
HYDRAULIC POWER SYSTEMS
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................ 13-1
GENERAL ........................................................................................................................... 13-1
MAJOR COMPONENTS .................................................................................................... 13-2
Reservoir ....................................................................................................................... 13-2
Pumps ........................................................................................................................... 13-2
System Bypass Valve .................................................................................................... 13-2
Firewall Shutoff Valves ................................................................................................ 13-3
Filters ............................................................................................................................ 13-3
Flow Switches .............................................................................................................. 13-3
OPERATION ........................................................................................................................ 13-3
HYDRAULIC SUBSYSTEMS ............................................................................................ 13-5
Thrust Attenuators ........................................................................................................ 13-5
QUESTIONS ...................................................................................................................... 13-11
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
13-1 Hydraulic Reservoir .............................................................................................. 13-2
13-2 Hydraulic Reservoir Access Door ........................................................................ 13-2
13-3 ENGINE FIRE Switchlights ................................................................................. 13-3
13-4 Hydraulic System Schematic ................................................................................ 13-4
13-5 Thrust Attenuator .................................................................................................. 13-5
13-6 Thrust Attenuator Switch ...................................................................................... 13-6
13-7 Thrust Attenuator System Schematics (Stowing) ................................................. 13-7
13-8 Thrust Attenuator System Schematics (Deploying) ............................................. 13-8
13-9 Thrust Attenuator Actuator .................................................................................. 13-10
CHAPTER 13
HYDRAULIC POWER SYSTEMS
INTRODUCTION
The Citation CJ2 hydraulic system is pressurized by two engine-driven pumps, one on
each engine. The system provides pressure for four subsystems: landing gear, speedbrakes,
flaps, and thrust attenuators. The system operation is monitored by annunciator lights.
GENERAL
The hydraulic system is classified as “open The reservoir is pressurized to provide an ad-
center,” bypassing pump output to return with equate supply of fluid to the pumps under all
essentially no buildup of pressure. Fluid by- operating conditions. Fluid is filtered prior to
passing ceases and pressure is provided when entering a subsystem enroute to the reservoir.
operation of a subsystem is initiated.
Annunciator lights warn of low flow and in-
The pumps are supplied with fluid through dicate when the system is pressurized.
motorized firewall shutoff valves controlled
from the cockpit.
MAJOR COMPONENTS
RESERVOIR
The reservoir (Figure 13-1) is mounted on the
right side of the fuselage under the right en-
gine pylon. It is pressurized by the 23-psi
service bleed-air system to reduce foaming
and assure positive flow. A relief valve on top
of the reservoir opens at approximately 30 psi
to prevent overpressurization.
PUMPS
The constant-volume hydraulic pumps, driven
by the accessory section of the engines, are
Figure 13-1. Hydraulic Reservoir rated at 3.25 gpm each. The pumps are in op-
eration when the engines are operating. Either
Service connections are provided below the hy- pump is capable of operating all subsystems.
draulic reservoir under the hydraulic access The pumps are cooled, when operating, by
door (Figure 13-2) and do not require equip- system fluid.
ment capable of delivering hydraulic fluid
under pressure. A sight gage is marked at
FULL and ADD levels. The reservoir capac- SYSTEM BYPASS VALVE
ity at the FULL level is 2 liters (125 cubic The solenoid-operated hydraulic bypass valve
inches). The hydraulic reservoir can be hand- is spring-loaded open to route hydraulic pump
filled. Verify that the flaps are zero to 15°, output to the return line. When energized by
speedbrakes and attenuators are retracted, and selecting the operation of a subsystem, the
the landing gear is extended. Push the manual valve energizes closed, increasing hydraulic
relief valve on top of the reservoir to relieve pressure. If electrical power is interrupted,
trapped service air pressure before removing the valve fails to the open position. A me-
filler cap. Pour in clean, red MIL-H-83282 chanical relief valve in parallel with the by-
fluid to the FULL mark and recap. pass valve maintains the system pressure at a
maximum of 1,500 psi.
FIREWALL SHUTOFF VALVES As flow decreases below .35 to .55 gpm, the
HYD FLOW LOW annunciator will illumi-
F/W A hydraulic firewall shutoff nate accompanied by MASTER CAUTION
SHUTOFF valve is installed in the supply lights. A check valve in the flow switch pre-
line to each hydraulic pump. vents backflow into the pump.
L R The valves are motorized and
are controlled by ENGINE
FIRE switchlights on the glareshield (Figure
13-3). The valves are normally open and are OPERATION
to be closed only in the event of an engine
fire or to perform maintenance. The hydraulic When an engine is started, the pump draws
L or R SHUTOFF lights come on when an fluid from the reservoir through the normally
ENGINE FIRE switchlight is pressed. open firewall shutoff valve (Figure 13-4).
Pump output flow through the flow switch
opens a circuit to extinguish the L or R HYD
FLOW LOW light.
F F
LANDING
GEAR R FLOW
SWITCH
HYD FLOW
SPEED- LOW
BRAKES HYDRAULIC
SYSTEM
BYPASS VALVE L R
SPEED SPD BRK RETRACT
L MLG R MLG
L HYD
F/W
SHUTOFF R HYD
F/W
SHUTOFF
L HYD R HYD
PUMP PUMP
F/W
HYD PRESS RESERVOIR SHUTOFF
ON
L R ATTEN
SPD BRK UNLOCK
L THRUST R THRUST
EXTEND ATTENUATOR ATTENUATOR L R
FlightSafety
MASTER
CAUTION
international
RESET
STOWING
STOWING THRUST ATTENUATOR STOWING
ACTUATORS
NOTE:
PISTONS EXTEND MOVING
BELL CRANKS TO STOW
PADDLES
THRUST
ATTENUATOR
SOLENOID
VALVES
STOW
A THRUST
U ATTENUATOR
T
O TEST
PRESSURE
RETURN
ATTEN
UNLOCK
L R HYD PRESS
ON
STOWED
THRUST ATTENUATOR
ACTUATORS
THRUST
ATTENUATOR
SOLENOID
VALVES
LEGEND
ATTEN
UNLOCK TRAPPED FLUID
PRESSURE
L R
RETURN
STATIC PRESSURE
DEPLOYING
DEPLOYING THRUST DEPLOYING
ATTENUATOR
ACTUATORS
NOTE:
PISTONS RETRACT MOVING
BELLCRANKS TO DEPLOY
PADDLES
THRUST
ATTENUATOR
SOLENOID
VALVES THRUST
ATTENUATOR
STOW
A
DEPLOY
U
T
O TEST
PRESSURE
IDLE
STOW
RETURN
ATTEN
UNLOCK
HYD PRESS
L R ON
DEPLOYED
THRUST
ATTENUATOR
ACTUATORS
THRUST
ATTENUATOR
SOLENOID
VALVES
LEGEND
ATTEN
UNLOCK TRAPPED FLUID
PRESSURE
L R
RETURN
STATIC PRESSURE
the similar light indications. Remember the movement of the operating engine throttle
HYD PRESS ON light flashes on and off with will actuate only that engine’s attenuator. If
each deployment and each stowing. one of the thrust attenuator circuit breakers
were popped, the control valve would fail and
On deployment, the attenuator that thrust attenuator would not respond.
ATTEN paddles will deflect to a position
UNLOCK
30° from the exhaust plane of STOW should not be selected during tailwind
L R the engine (68° of movement engine starts. Tailwinds of ±30° could flow
from the stowed position) and into the tailpipe, making warmer starting tem-
will illuminate the white L and peratures. In AUTO, the operating engine’s
R ATTEN UNLOCK annunciator light. De- thrust attenuator paddle automatically de-
ployment of the thrust attenuators in flight ploys when the throttle is moved from OFF to
will also illuminate the MASTER CAUTION IDLE and helps block tailwinds from enter-
lights. ing the tailpipe.
The thrust attenuators can be stowed manually
by moving the stow switch to STOW. Hy- Limitations
draulic pressure causes the actuators to stow
the paddles, and they will move to the stow po- Take off is permitted for flaps 0° and 15°.
sition on the engine pylon. The paddles are held Takeoff field length required is increased by
stowed by trapped hydraulic pressure and are 1.05. Landing is permitted using normal land-
inoperative. In the STOW position, the L and ing procedures with thrust attenuator switch
R ATTEN UNLOCK lights extinguish. in STOW.
A w h i t e AT T N S T OW S E - Emergency
ATTN STOW LECTED light will illuminate
SELECTED If a malfunction causes either thrust attenu-
any time the switch is in the
STOW position. ator to deploy, with either squat switch in
flight, the MASTER CAUTION lights imme-
diately illuminate. Selecting STOW should
NOTE move the paddles to the stow position and
If an attenuator unlock advisory light landing distance is the same. If selecting
should illuminate during flight, the STOW fails to stow the errant thrust attenu-
thrust attenuator switch should be ators, use sufficient power to keep the air-
placed in the STOW position. s p e e d a t s a f e m a rg i n s t h r o u g h f l i g h t t o
touchdown. Engine exhaust blasts on the pad-
dles (hydraulically locked deployed), forcing
During the first engine start, when the throt- the actuator to slide up the cylinder against
tle is advanced to IDLE, only that engine’s spring tension. The paddles should “blow
thrust attenuator bucket deploys. When the back,” even to the full stow position, result-
throttle is advanced during second engine ing in only a small loss of available thrust. If
start, that engine’s thrust attenuator deploys. power is reduced, the internal spring forces
Both paddles deploy or stow at the same time the actuator toward its normal spring-loaded
because a single microswitch controls both position and the paddles redeploy.
left and right thrust attenuator hydraulic ac-
tuators (Figure 13-9). During ground taxi,
with either engine shut down (throttle OFF),
DEPLOY
MICROSWITCH
THRUST ATTENUATOR
LINE
ACTUATOR
IS CENTER
PUSH-PULL
TUBE
SPRING
ENGINE AX
BELL CRANK
THRUST ATTENUATOR
PADDLE STOWED
QUESTIONS
1. The hydraulic system bypass valve is: 6. Access to the hydraulic reservoir sight
A. Spring-loaded closed glass is:
B. Spring-loaded open A. I n t h e r i g h t f o r w a r d b a g g a g e
C. Energized closed compartment
D. Both B and C B. On the copilot instrument panel
C. A h e a d o f t h e t a i l c o n e b a g g a g e
compartment
2. Depressing an ENGINE FIRE switch- D. Under a door behind the right flap
light: under right engine
A. Shuts off hydraulic fluid to the pump
B. Trips the generator field relay
7. The hydraulic system:
C. Arms the fire-extinguishing system
A. Uses only red MIL-H-83282 fluid
D. All of the above
B. Has a reservoir capacity of 2 liters
(125 in. 3 )
3. C l o s i n g o f a h y d r a u l i c va l v e i s C. Is limited to 1,500 psi when loaded
indicated by: D. All of the above
A. A warning horn
B. Illumination of the applicable F/W
8. Hydraulic system operation is indicated
SHUTOFF annunciator if the fuel fire-
by illumination of the:
wall shutoff valve also closes
C. Illumination of the HYD PRESS ON A. HYD LEVEL LO annunciator
annunciator B. HYD PRESS ON annunciator (1,500
D. A flashing MASTER CAUTION light psi)
C. L or R HYD LEVEL LOW annuncia-
tor
4. If DC power is lost, the system bypass D. L or R HYD FLOW LOW
valve: annunciator
A. Spring-loads to the closed position
B. Motorizes open
9. A hydraulic leak may be detected by:
C. Spring-loads to the open position
A. Visible red fluid observed during pre-
D. Pressurizes the system through landing
or post-flight walkaround
B. May be a possibility if both HYD
5. The hydraulic system provides pressure FLOW LOW lights illuminate
to operate the: C. Below ADD on the sight gage
A. Landing gear, speedbrakes, flaps, and D. All of the above
thrust attenuators
B. Landing gear and speedbrakes only
(all aircraft)
C. Antiskid brakes, landing gear, and
flaps
D. Speedbrakes, landing gear, and
wheelbrakes
10. The thrust attenuators are stowed any 12. Thrust attenuators in AUTO will:
time: A. Deploy automatically at touchdown
A. The switch is in STOW. (both squat switches on the ground)
B. During taxi, the switch is in AUTO B. Stow automatically with the throttles
with either throttle forward of the above IDLE for taxi
IDLE STOP. C. Deploy when both piggyback throttles
C. The left and right throttles are both in are pulled up to IDLE–DEPLOY
CUTOFF. D. A and B above
D. All of the above
11. T h e M A S T E R C AU T I O N l i g h t s
illuminate:
A. If in flight and unlocked
B. If in flight with STOW selected and
flaps beyond 15° (normally AUTO for
landing)
C. During taxi with STOW selected and
either throttle above 85% N2
(normally AUTO for takeoff)
D. All of the above
CHAPTER 14
LANDING GEAR AND BRAKES
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION................................................................................................................. 14-1
GENERAL ............................................................................................................................ 14-1
LANDING GEAR................................................................................................................. 14-2
General........................................................................................................................... 14-2
Controls and Indicators ................................................................................................. 14-3
Operation ....................................................................................................................... 14-6
NOSEWHEEL STEERING................................................................................................ 14-10
BRAKES ............................................................................................................................. 14-11
General......................................................................................................................... 14-11
Nosewheel Center Lock .............................................................................................. 14-12
Operation ..................................................................................................................... 14-13
Antiskid System Operation ......................................................................................... 14-15
Touchdown Protection................................................................................................. 14-16
Locked Wheel Crossover Protection........................................................................... 14-16
Self-Monitoring Antiskid System ............................................................................... 14-16
Parking Brakes ............................................................................................................ 14-17
Emergency Brakes....................................................................................................... 14-17
QUESTIONS ...................................................................................................................... 14-19
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
14-1 Left Main Gear and Door ...................................................................................... 14-2
14-2 Nose Landing Gear and Doors .............................................................................. 14-3
14-3 Landing Gear Control Panel .................................................................................. 14-3
14-4 Landing Gear Handle Locking Solenoid and Switches......................................... 14-4
14-5 Landing Gear Position Indicators .......................................................................... 14-5
14-6 Landing Gear Schematic—Retraction ................................................................... 14-7
14-7 Landing Gear Schematic—Extension.................................................................... 14-8
14-8 Landing Gear Emergency Extension ..................................................................... 14-9
14-9 AUX GEAR CONTROL T-Handle ..................................................................... 14-10
14-10 Nose Gear Center Lock (FLY–TOW) ................................................................. 14-12
14-11 Powerbrake and Digital Antiskid System............................................................ 14-14
14-12 PARK BRAKE Handle........................................................................................ 14-17
14-13 Emergency Brake System.................................................................................... 14-18
CHAPTER 14
LANDING GEAR AND BRAKES
INTRODUCTION
The Citation CJ2 landing gear is electrically controlled and hydraulically actuated. When
retracted, the nose gear and the struts of the main gear are enclosed by mechanically ac-
tuated doors. The trailing link main gear wheels remain uncovered in the wheel wells. Gear
position and warning are provided by colored indicator lights and an aural warning.
Nosewheel steering is mechanically actuated through linkage from the rudder pedals.
A self-contained shimmy damper is located on top of the nose gear strut.
Power braking is provided with or without antiskid. Emergency braking is also provided.
GENERAL
Each inboard-retracting main gear uses two hy- Gear position indication is provided by one red
draulic actuators—one for gear actuation and and three green position indicator lights on the
one for uplock release. Two hydraulic actua- landing gear control panel. In addition, an
tors perform identical duties for the forward aural warning sounds when throttle or flap
retracting nose gear. An electrically positioned and gear position are not compatible when the
gear control valve directs hydraulic pressure airspeed is less than 130 KIAS at <85% N 2 .
for gear extension or retraction.
LANDING GEAR
Figure 14-1. Left Main Gear and Door
GENERAL
The main and nose landing gear struts are con- uplock is normally electrically controlled and
ventional air-oil struts. The landing gear is nor- hydraulically unlocked, but it also may be un-
mally hydraulically actuated, but can be locked by the T-handle mechanical cable or by
mechanically and pneumatically released and the round concentric knob releasing high pres-
extended if the normal gear actuation system sure nitrogen from the bottle in the right nose
fails. The gear can be extended or retracted up compartment to push the piston to its unlocked
to 200 KIAS. The maximum airspeed with the position. Fluid is now sequenced to the down
gear extended is 200 KIAS. It takes less than six side of the strut actuator until mechanically
seconds to extend or retract the landing gear. locked at the fully extended position.
Controls
The LDG GEAR control handle actuates
switches to complete circuits to the extend or
retract solenoid of the gear control valve. On
the ground, the solenoid spring-loaded plunger
holds the handle in the DOWN position, pre-
Figure 14-2. Nose Landing Gear venting inadvertent movement of the handle
and Doors to the UP position (Figure 14-4). If the gear
handle is UP at any time on the ground, the red
Three doors are actuated by nose gear move- GEAR UNLOCKED light is on.
ment to completely enclose the nose gear and
wheel at retraction. The two forward doors are
closed with the gear extended or retracted, and
are open only during gear transit. The aft spade
door remains open with the gear extended.
PLUNGER Indicators
The green NOSE, LH, and RH lights on the
gear control panel indicate gear down and
locked. As each gear locks down, its respec-
RETRACT
SWITCH tive green light is illuminated.
EXTEND The red GEAR UNLOCKED light indicates an
SWITCH
unsafe gear condition. It illuminates when the
gear handle is moved out of the UP detent and
remains on until all three gear are down and
LOCKING
SOLENOID
locked. At retraction, the light comes on when
FW
any downlock is released and remains on until
D all three gear are up and locked.
Figure 14-4. Landing Gear Handle
Locking Solenoid and Normal indication with the gear down is three
Switches green lights illuminated. All lights should be
out with the gear retracted.
DOWN AND
LDG GEAR
LOCKED LDG GEAR
NOSE NOSE
UP UP
LH RH LH RH
ANTI- ANTI-
HORN SKID HORN SKID
SILENCE ON SILENCE ON
NOSE GEAR
NOT DOWN
LDG GEAR LDG GEAR
AND LOCKED
NOSE NOSE
UP UP
LH RH LH RH
ANTI- ANTI-
HORN SKID HORN SKID
SILENCE ON SILENCE ON
ONE OR MORE
DOWN GEAR NOT UP DOWN
AND LOCKED
SHUTTLE
VALVE
EMERGENCY GEAR
EXTENSION
HANDLE
UPLOCK HOOK
ACTUATOR NOSE
GEAR
FlightSafety
ACTUATOR
international
14-7
SHUTTLE
VALVE
EMERGENCY GEAR
EXTENSION
HANDLE
UPLOCK HOOK
ACTUATOR NOSE
GEAR
FlightSafety
ACTUATOR
international
Figure 14-7. Landing Gear Schematic—Extension
PRESSURE
MAIN LANDING GEAR CONTROL MAIN LANDING
GEAR ACTUATOR SOLENOID VALVE RETURN GEAR ACTUATOR
SHUTTLE
VALVE
LEGEND
HYDRAULIC PRESSURE
HYDRAULIC RETURN (ACTIVE)
STATIC HYDRAULIC FLUID
PRESSURE BLOW
VENTED LINE GAGE DOWN
FILL
PNEUMATIC (NITROGEN) PRESSURE BOTTLE
PORT
NITROGEN/HYDRAULIC FLUID MIX PRESSURE
VENT EMERGENCY
BRAKE
UPLOCK HOOK
ACTUATOR
FlightSafety
EMERGENCY GEAR
TO UPLOCK EXTENSION HANDLE
NOSE GEAR HOOKS
ACTUATOR
international
14-9
NOTE
Pneumatic pressure should be used to Figure 14-9. AUX GEAR CONTROL
assure positive locking of all three T-Handle
gear actuators.
ing attachment bolts will be sheared with re-
sultant loss of steering capability. If the con-
NOSEWHEEL STEERING trol lock is engaged, towing beyond 60° may
cause structural damage. (Note: Towing oper-
Nosewheel steering is manually actuated ation can be found in the section “Nosewheel
through cables and a mechanical linkage con- Center Lock”.)
nected to the rudder pedals. Steering is oper-
ative with the gear extended. With the gear
retracted, rudder pedal movement does not CAUTION
deflect the nosewheel. If the nosewheel steering bolts are
sheared (indicated by loss of nose-
Normally, steering is limited by rudder pedal wheel steering with the rudder pedals),
stops to 20° nosewheel deflection either side flight should not be attempted. This is
of center. A spring-loaded bungee in the sys- due to the possibility of the nosewheel
tem provides an additional 64° nosewheel de- not remaining centered after takeoff
flection via castering accomplished with even with the gear extended.
application of differential engine power or
braking. The nosewheel is mechanically
centered for retraction. Flying the aircraft with inoperative nose-wheel
steering can also result in violent nosewheel
For towing, ensure that the flight control lock shimmy.
is disengaged, and do not exceed 90° nose
wheel deflection. If 90° is exceeded, the steer-
NOSEWHEEL CENTER LOCK show red for towing and green for taxi and
flight. Centering lock engagement is a pre-
The nosewheel center lock (Figure 14-10) is and postflight item. During the Left Nose
mounted on the nose landing gear shock strut. Check, Nosewheel Centering Lock Assembly,
The main components of the assembly consists disconnect the locking mechanism and verify
of a cam, lever, lock, and spring. While in that the FLY placard is visible (do not tow the
flight and the landing gear extended, the nose aircraft with the nosewheel centering lock as-
wheel center lock assembly holds the nose sembly in the FLY position). If the nose strut
gear in the center position. is overpressurized by maintenance, no turns
would be possible during taxi. During cross-
The centering lock engages with the nose gear wind landings the nose strut will stay cen-
at full strut extension at liftoff and disengages tered. To taxi or fly in TOW or tow in FLY could
as weight compresses the nose strut. The sys- damage the aircraft. A large yellow placard
tem must be manually disengaged by the pilot on each side of the nose gear strut reminds the
at the nose gear strut by rotating a lever to pilot to select the appropriate setting.
PUSH HERE TO
RELEASE FOR FLIGHT
LEGEND
RELEASE
DISENGAGE
DC POWER
BRAKE SYSTEM L GEN BATT R GEN
HYDRAULIC
OFF OFF
RESERVOIR
PILOT/COPILOT RESET EMER RESET
RUDDER PEDALS
29 VDC
HYDRAULIC
OVER BATT
SPEED TEMP
PRESSURE W/S TEMP AOA
SWITCH RUDDER
BIAS
ANTISKID DIGITAL
SERVO VALVE ANTISKID
CONTROL UNIT PWR BRK
LO PRESS
ANTI-SKID
INOP BIT FAULT
INDICATOR
PARKING
BRAKE
NOSE
SHUTTLE VALVE SHUTTLE VALVE
LH RH
GEAR
EMERGENCY UNLOCKED
VENT
BRAKE HANDLE ANTI-SKID
UP
FlightSafety
ON
DOWN OFF
TO EMERGENCY NITROGEN
international
GEAR EXTENSION BLOW DOWN
BOTTLE
stopped prior to moving the rotary test switch open or short occurs with the gear
to ANTISKID because the test could inter- handle up or down in flight, the AN-
fere with system operation. TISKID INOP light will illuminate.
ANTISKID PROTECTION
NOTE
Antiskid protection is provided to allow max-
When the aircraft is in flight with imum braking efficiency, which in turn mini-
the ANTISKID switch on, the anti- mizes landing distances. If the pilot applies
skid control unit is constantly mon- enough brake pedal force to cause slippage
itoring for shorts and opens in the between the tires and the runway, the wheel
transducer and servo-valve circuits. speed transducer data received by the control
This is the self-test function. If an box will indicate a sudden deceleration for the
slipping wheel. The control box will deter-
mine the severity of the impending skid and
send the appropriate current signal to the an-
tiskid servo valve to reduce brake pressure ac-
c o r d i n g l y. A s i n g l e s e r vo va l ve r e d u c e s
pressure for both brakes simultaneously. conditions. The velocity of the two wheels
Therefore, a single wheel skid will result in are compared to each other to determine if
the reduction of brake pressure at both wheels. one wheel is locked. If the velocity of one
wheel falls to less than 30% of the velocity of
Antiskid-assisted braking will begin when ei- the other wheel, the control box will send a full
ther of the following conditions are met: dump command to the antiskid servo valve.
Since the servo valve regulates pressure to
• Either main gear squat switch indicat- both wheels simultaneously, a locked wheel
ing weight on wheels (WOW) for at least condition will result in a full dump of brake
3 seconds pressure to both wheels. The full dump will re-
• The average wheel speed of the left and main in effect until the velocity of the slow
right wheels together exceed 59 ±2 knots wheel increases above the 30% threshold.
The antiskid feature is fully functional when The locked wheel crossover feature is inactive
the average wheel speeds are between 10 and at wheel speeds below 25 knots to allow for
175 knots. low speed taxiing maneuvers.
SHUTTLE VALVE
(ONE IN EACH
BRAKE ASSEMBLY)
EMERGENCY
BRAKE VALVE
OVERBOARD
LEGEND
AIR PRESSURE
EMERGENCY
MECHANICAL AIR BOTTLE
QUESTIONS
1. On the ground, the LDG GEAR handle is 5. At retraction, if the nose gear does not
prevented from movement to the UP lock in the up position, the gear panel
position by: light indication will be:
A. Mechanical detents A. Red light on, green LH and RH lights
B. A spring-loaded locking solenoid on
C. Hydraulic pressure B. Red light out, green LH and RH lights
D. A manually applied handle locking on
device C. Red light on, all three green lights out
D. All four lights out
2. The landing gear uplocks are:
A. Mechanically held engaged by springs 6. T h e g e a r w a r n i n g h o r n c a n n o t b e
silenced when one or more gears are not
B. Hydraulically disengaged
down-and-locked and:
C. Pneumatically engaged
A. Flaps are extended beyond the 15°
D. Both A and B
position.
B. Airspeed is less than 130 KIAS.
3. Landing gear downlocks are disengaged: C. Either throttle is retarded below 85%
A. When hydraulic pressure is applied to N 2 rpm.
the retract side of the gear actuators D. Both throttles are retarded below 85%
B. By action of the gear squat switches N 2 rpm.
C. By removing the external down-lock
pins 7. W h e n t h e L D G G E A R h a n d l e i s
D. By mechanical linkage as the gear positioned either UP or DOWN:
begins to retract
A. T h e h y d r a u l i c b y p a s s va l v e i s
energized open.
4. Each main gear wheel incorporates a B. T h e h y d r a u l i c b y p a s s va l v e i s
fusible plug that: energized closed.
A. Blows out if the tire is overserviced C. The bypass valve is not affected.
with air D. The HYD PRESS ON annunciator
B. Melts, deflating the tire if an over- light goes out.
heated brake temperature occurs
C. Is thrown out by centrifugal force if
maximum wheel speed is exceeded
D. None of the above
8. Emergency extension of the landing gear 12. The DC motor-driven hydraulic pump in
is accomplished by actuation of: the brake system operates:
A. A s w i t c h f o r u p l o c k r e l e a s e a n d A. During the entire time the LDG GEAR
application of air pressure handle is in the DOWN position
B. One manual control to release the up- B. A s n e e d e d w i t h t h e L D G G E A R
locks and apply air pressure for exten- handle DOWN in order to maintain
sion system pressure
C. Two manual controls—one to me- C. Only when the PWR BRK PRESS LO
chanically release the uplocks and an- annunciator illuminates
other to apply air pressure for gear D. Even when the LDG GEAR handle is
extension and downlocking UP to keep air out of the system as the
D. None of the above aircraft climbs to altitude
CHAPTER 15
FLIGHT CONTROLS
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION................................................................................................................. 15-1
PRIMARY FLIGHT CONTROLS........................................................................................ 15-1
General........................................................................................................................... 15-1
Control Lock System..................................................................................................... 15-2
TRIM SYSTEMS.................................................................................................................. 15-3
General........................................................................................................................... 15-3
Rudder and Aileron Trim............................................................................................... 15-3
Elevator Trim ................................................................................................................. 15-4
SECONDARY FLIGHT CONTROLS.................................................................................. 15-5
General........................................................................................................................... 15-5
Flaps............................................................................................................................... 15-5
Speedbrakes ................................................................................................................... 15-6
Stall Warning ............................................................................................................... 15-11
RUDDER BIAS SYSTEM.................................................................................................. 15-11
General......................................................................................................................... 15-11
Description .................................................................................................................. 15-13
QUESTIONS ...................................................................................................................... 15-16
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
15-1 Flight Control Surfaces.......................................................................................... 15-2
15-2 Control Lock Handle ............................................................................................. 15-3
15-3 Rudder and Aileron Trim Systems ........................................................................ 15-3
15-4 Elevator Trim System ............................................................................................ 15-4
15-5 Flap Lever and Position Indicator.......................................................................... 15-5
15-6 Flap Operation ....................................................................................................... 15-7
15-7 Speedbrake System ................................................................................................ 15-9
15-8 Speedbrake Extension.......................................................................................... 15-10
15-9 Speedbrake Retraction ......................................................................................... 15-11
15-10 Speedbrake Blowdown—Electrical Failure......................................................... 15-12
15-11 Stall Strip ............................................................................................................. 15-12
15-12 Rudder Bias System—Normal Operation ........................................................... 15-13
15-13 Rudder Bias System—Left Engine Flameout ..................................................... 15-15
CHAPTER 15
FLIGHT CONTROLS
20 20
10 10
G
5 5 S
5 5
10
20
L
O
C
INTRODUCTION
The primary flight controls of the Citation CJ2 consist of ailerons, rudder, and eleva-
tors. They are manually actuated by rudder pedals and conventional control columns and
can be immobilized by control locks when on the ground. Trim is mechanical in all three
axes. Electrical elevator trim is also provided.
Secondary flight controls consist of electrically controlled and hydraulically actuated
flaps, speedbrakes, and a pneumatically actuated bleed-air rudder bias system.
PRIMARY FLIGHT
CONTROLS rudder pedal arrangement. Control inputs
are transmitted to the control surfaces
GENERAL through cables and bellcranks. The rudder
pedals can be adjusted to the forward, mid-
The ailerons, rudder, and elevators are man- dle, and aft detented positions for comfort by
ually operated by either the pilot or the copi- depressing a spring-loaded latch on the side
lot through a conventional control column and of each rudder pedal.
The rudder, both elevators, and the left aileron (Figure 15-2) 90° clockwise and pulling out
are each equipped with a trim tab mechanically until the handle returns to the horizontal po-
actuated from the cockpit. sition locks the flight controls in neutral and
the throttles in the OFF position.
The elevator tabs can also be electrically po-
sitioned by pitch trim switches on the control To unlock the flight controls and throttles, ro-
wheels. The pilot switch has priority. tate the handle 90° clockwise and push in until
it returns to the horizontal position.
All flight control surfaces, including pri-
mary, secondary, and trim tabs, are shown in
Figure 15-1.
NOTE
The nosewheel steering and the rud-
der are connected through the rudder
CONTROL LOCK SYSTEM pedal linkage. The aircraft must not
Control locks, when engaged, restrain the pri- be towed with the locks engaged. To
mary flight controls and lock both throttles off. do so can damage the steering system.
Prior to engaging the control lock, move both Do not fly the aircraft if the nose-
throttles to OFF and neutralize the flight con- wheel steering is inoperative. This
trols. Rotating the CONTROL LOCK handle condition cannot be detected until
steering is attempted during taxi.
ELEVATOR
TRIM TABS
TRIM TAB
FLAP
RUDDER
SPEEDBRAKE
TRIM TAB
AILERON
TRIM SYSTEMS
GENERAL
Rudder and aileron trim are mechanically op-
erated by cables from trim wheels in the cock-
pit. Mechanically and electrically operated
trim tabs are provided for the elevators and are
controlled by a manual trim wheel on the
pedestal or electrical elevator trim switches on
the outboard control wheel grips.
LEGEND
MECHANICAL
ELECTRICAL
MANUAL TRIM
ELECTRIC TRIM
Figure 15-4. Elevator Trim System
NOTE
Do not engage the autopilot with
electric trim inoperable.
Figure 15-5. Flap Lever and
Position Indicator
SECONDARY FLIGHT
CONTROLS The handle must be lifted at the landing stop
before it can be moved aft to the GROUND
GENERAL FLAPS (60°) position.
The secondary flight controls consist of wing The GROUND FLAPS (60°) flap position pro-
flaps and speedbrakes; both are electrically vides increased aerodynamic drag for landing
controlled and hydraulically actuated. rollout. Landing performance data is based
on touchdown, nose down, brakes on, then se-
A single flap section on each wing can be hy- lecting the GROUND FLAPS position. Se-
draulically positioned from 0° to 60°. Mechan- lecting the GROUND FLAPS position closes
ical interconnection of left and right wing flap the 60° flap position switch in the quadrant,
segments prevent asymmetrical flap operation extending the speedbrakes, and directs the
and permits flap operation with one hydraulic flaps from 35° to 60°. Selecting the FLAPS
actuator.
handle from 60° to 35° opens the 60° flap po- Operation
sition switch, retracting the speedbrakes, and
moving the flaps from 60° to 35°. Avoid cy- Moving the flap lever to any position causes
cling the throttles above and below 85% N 2 the hydraulic system bypass valve to close for
while in the ground flap position. pressure buildup as indicated by illumination
of the HYD PRESS ON annunciator. It also en-
e rg i z e s t h e f l a p s o l e n o i d va l ve , r o u t i n g
WARNING pressure for flap operation (Figure 15-6).
The ground flap position is not When the flaps reach the selected position, the
locked out in flight. Selection of bypass valve opens to relieve hydraulic pres-
GROUND FLAPS will significantly sure, and the flap solenoid valve deenergizes
increase drag and sink rate. Inten- and moves to the neutral position. In the neu-
tional selection of GROUND FLAPS tral position, the valve blocks all fluid lines
in flight is prohibited. to the actuators, hydraulically locking the
flaps in that position.
If an inflight malfunction results in 60° flaps In the event of electrical failure, the flap so-
and can not be corrected, consider carrying lenoid valve remains in the neutral position,
power to touchdown. Reducing power to idle and the flap position cannot be changed.
at 50 feet could result in high sink rate.
If hydraulic system failure occurs with the
Even though the ground flap position is pro- flaps retracted, they cannot be extended. With
hibited in flight, it has been demonstrated the flaps in an extended position, the flaps
that the aircraft can be safely flown at the will remain in the selected position unless the
60° position whether caused by malfunction handle is moved. Once the solenoid valve is
or inadvertent selection. Do not exceed 140 energized, the flaps may “blow upward” to a
KIAS. deflection proportionate to air loads.
The FLAPS >35° annunciator and MASTER
CAUTION lights illuminate immediately on SPEEDBRAKES
the ground if the flaps are beyond 35° and
both throttles are above 85% N2. On the ground General
with throttles below 85% N 2 , no annunciator Two speedbrake panels on each wing, one on
lights come on. top and one on the bottom surface of the wing,
are operated by hydraulic actuators. They pro-
In flight, with the throttles below 85% N 2 , vide increased descent rates and increased
the MASTER CAUTION and FLAPS >35° drag to aid braking during the landing rollout.
lights illuminate after an 8-second delay any- The speedbrakes have two positions: extended
time flaps are beyond 35°. The lights illumi- and retracted. The system includes two hy-
nate immediately if the throttles are above draulic actuators, a solenoid valve, four speed-
85% N 2 . brake panels, a safety valve, and a white
SPEED BRAKE EXTEND annunciator. The
Go-around should not be attempted once system control switch and extended speed-
GROUND FLAPS have been selected. brakes are shown in Figure 15-7.
RETRACTION
RETRACTING RETRACTING
FLAP ACTUATOR
RESTRICTED FITTINGS
UP 0
F
L
A
P
S
T.O. &
APPR 15
FLAP CONTROL SOLENOID
200 KIAS
LAND 35
161 KIAS
PRESSURE GROUND
60
HYD PRESS FLAPS
RETURN GROUND
ON USE ONLY
NOTE:
CABLE INTERCONNECT BETWEEN ACTUATORS NORMALLY
PREVENTS ASYMMETRIC FLAPS IF ONE ACTUATOR FAILS.
RETRACTED RETRACTED
FLAP ACTUATOR
RESTRICTED FITTINGS
UP 0
F
L
A
P
S
T.O. &
APPR 15
FLAP CONTROL SOLENOID
200 KIAS
LAND 35
161 KIAS
GROUND
60 PRESSURE
FLAPS
GROUND RETURN
USE ONLY
LEGEND
TRAPPED FLUID
PRESSURE
RETURN
EXTENSION
EXTENDING EXTENDING
FLAP ACTUATOR
RESTRICTED FITTINGS
UP 0
F
L
A
P
S
T.O. &
APPR 15
FLAP CONTROL SOLENOID
200 KIAS
LAND 35
161 KIAS
PRESSURE GROUND
60
HYD PRESS FLAPS
RETURN GROUND
ON USE ONLY
NOTE:
CABLE INTERCONNECT BETWEEN ACTUATORS NORMALLY
PREVENTS ASYMMETRIC FLAPS IF ONE ACTUATOR FAILS.
EXTENDED EXTENDED
FLAP ACTUATOR
RESTRICTED FITTINGS
UP 0
F
L
A
P
S
T.O. &
APPR 15
FLAP CONTROL SOLENOID
200 KIAS
LAND 35
161 KIAS
GROUND
60 PRESSURE
FLAPS
GROUND RETURN LEGEND
USE ONLY
TRAPPED FLUID
PRESSURE
RETURN
EXTENDING
L SPEEDBRAKE R SPEEDBRAKE
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
THERMAL
RELIEF
SPEEDBRAKE VALVE
SOLENOID
VALVE
SAFETY
VALVE
EXTENDED
L SPEEDBRAKE R SPEEDBRAKE
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
FAILS THERMAL
OPEN RELIEF
SPEEDBRAKE VALVE
SOLENOID
VALVE
SAFETY
VALVE
LEGEND
PRESSURE DRAIN LINE
L SPEEDBRAKE R SPEEDBRAKE
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
THERMAL
RELIEF
SPEEDBRAKE VALVE
SOLENOID
VALVE
SAFETY
VALVE
LEGEND
PRESSURE DRAIN LINE
SPEED BRAKE switch, or either throttle Stall strips (Figure 15-11) create turbulent
above 85% N 2 , or if FLAPS are selected to airflow at high angles of attack, causing a buf-
FLAPS 35°. fet to warn of approaching stall conditions.
L SPEEDBRAKE R SPEEDBRAKE
ACTUATOR ACTUATOR
THERMAL
RELIEF
SPEEDBRAKE VALVE
SOLENOID
VALVE
SAFETY
VALVE
LEGEND
PRESSURE DRAIN LINE
RUDDER COCKPIT
BIAS AREA
L R
+28 2A ENGINE ENGINE
VDC
OFF
ROTARY
TEST
KNOB (RB TEST
POSITION) CONTROL HP BLEED
VALVE
RUDDER (ENERGIZED)
BIAS
WARN
LTS NO. 1
RUDDER
BIAS RUDDER BIAS TEST BIAS
+28 AVAILABLE BIAS NOT
VDC AVAILABLE CONTROL VALVE
BIAS NOT (DEENERGIZED/
AVAILABLE BYPASS POSITION)
MASTER ANNUN
CAUTION
ACTUATOR
ORIFICE
LEGEND
BLEED-AIR PRESSURE RUDDER
AMBIENT
The bias system is pneumatically powered moving the primary rudder system, back drives
from engine bleed air, and when active, will the bias actuator. In the event of an engine
automatically assist the pilot in positioning the failure, the bias actuator back drives the pri-
rudder to compensate for asymmetric thrust. mary rudder system and autopilot servo.
The system consists of the following major
components:
DESCRIPTION
• Separate engine bleed-air plumbing for The major components of the Model 525A
left and right engine rudder bias system are as follows:
• Solenoid-operated control valve
• Control valve
• Balanced pneumatic actuator
• Actuator
• Annunciators
• Bleed-air plumbing
• Associated wiring
• RUDDER BIAS Annunciator
The bias system is installed parallel to the
primary rudder control system, with the only
common component being the rudder. With Control Valve
both engines operating (balanced bleed pres-
The rudder bias control valve is a solenoid-
sure across the bias actuator), both engines shut
operated pneumatic shutoff valve. The valve
down, or the bias valve in bypass position,
is normally spring-loaded to the bypass
(ambient) position. Supplying power to the so- to the other. With the valve in the bypass (deen-
lenoid moves the valve to the bias available ergized) position, both sides of the actuator are
position (right and left bleed air available). Re- ported to each other and to ambient pressure.
moving electrical power from the solenoid
lets the bias actuator solenoid spring-load to The actuator rod is connected to the rudder
ambient. Electrically powering the rudder torque tube via a roller-slot linkage. Extension
bias solenoid valve electrically moves the so- springs on the link provide a centering force
lenoid to the bias position porting to the re- at large rudder deflections.
spective side of the bias actuator.
der trailing edge right (right pedal forward), actuator is balanced and, aside from seal fric-
return the right engine to idle, and verify that tion, does not help or hinder motion of the pri-
the pedals are free to move. mary rudder system.
L R
ENGINE ENGINE
CONTROL VALVE
(DEENERGIZED TO
AMBIENT DURING
LOSS OF NORMAL
DC OR RUDDER
BIAS TEST)
QUESTIONS
1. The ailerons are operated by: 5. If hydraulic power is lost:
A. Hydraulic pressure A. The flaps will be inoperative.
B. Mechanical inputs from the con- B. The flaps will operate with the
trol wheels backup electrical system, but will
C. A fly-by-wire system extend and retract at a reduced rate.
D. An active control system that totally C. There is no effect on wing flap
eliminates adverse yaw operation.
D. A split flap condition could result if
the flaps are lowered.
2. The aileron trim tab is operated by:
A. An electrically operated trim tab
motor 6. The wing flaps:
B. A hydraulically operated trim tab A. Can be preselected to only four
motor positions (up, 15°, 35°, 60°)
C. A mechanical trim knob on the B. Depend on both actuators to func-
throttle control quadrant tion to prevent a split flap condition
D. Changing the angle of the aileron C. Can be lowered manually if electri-
“fence” cal power is lost, but only if all hy-
draulic fluid has not been lost
D. Can be selected to GROUND FLAP
3. Regarding the rudder: position on the ground or inflight; the
A. The pilot and copilot pedals are in- ground flap selection is prohibited in
terconnected. flight
B. The trim tab actuator is powered
only electrically.
7. Regarding the gust lock:
C. The servo is connected to the air
data computer to restrict rudder A. The engines may be started with it
pedal deflection at high airspeeds. engaged.
D. It is independent of the nose-wheel B. The aircraft should not be towed
steering on the ground. with it engaged.
C. It may be engaged for towing.
D. If the aircraft is towed past the 60°
4. The elevator: limit, nosewheel steering may be lost.
A. Trim tabs are controlled only It is still permissible to fly the aircraft
electrically. if the gear is left down.
B. Runaway trim condition can be alle-
viated by depressing the AP/TRIM
8. Moving the flap selector lever to any
DISC switch and pulling the PITCH
position:
TRIM circuit breaker.
C. Electric pitch trim has both high A. Energizes the hydraulic system by-
speed and low speed positions. pass valve closed
D. Tr i m t a b i s l o c a t e d o n t h e r i g h t B. Energizes the flap solenoid valve to
elevator only. the selected position
C. A and B
D. Energizes the electric hydraulic pump
for flap operation
9. If hydraulic failure occurs with the 13. Speedbrakes must not be extended
flaps extended and the FLAPS handle is within:
moved, the flaps: A. 50 feet on landing
A. May move upward depending on B. 110 feet on landing
air-load C. 40 meters
B. Cannot be fully retracted D. 50 meters
C. Can be retracted to the midrange
position
D. Can be completely retracted 14. The speedbrakes will fully retract if:
A. A complete electrical failure occurs
B. A hydraulic failure occurs
10. Extended speedbrakes are maintained
in that position by: C. Either throttle is advanced above
85% N 2 position with the electri-
A. Hydraulic pressure cal and hydraulic systems operat-
B. Trapped fluid in the lines from the ing normally
control and safety valves D. Hydraulic quantity drops below
C. Internal locks in the actuators 0.2 gallons
D. External locks on the actuators
15. If the RUDDER BIAS light illuminates:
11. The white HYD PRESS ON light on the A. Rudder BIAS (bleed air) is not
annunciator panel will illuminate dur- available from either engine to the
ing speedbrake operation: actuator
A. When the speedbrakes are fully B. Rudder BIAS (bleed air) is avail-
extended able to the actuator
B. While the speedbrakes are extend- C. The rotary test switch is OFF.
ing and retracting D. Both hydraulic pumps have failed.
C. Both A and B
D. Neither A nor B
CHAPTER 16
AVIONICS
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION ................................................................................................................. 16-1
FLIGHT INSTRUMENTATION (SNS 0001 AND SUBSEQUENT) .................................. 16-1
General........................................................................................................................... 16-1
Electronic Flight Instrument System (EFIS) ................................................................. 16-4
Pitot-Static ..................................................................................................................... 16-5
Airspeed and Altimeter Indications ............................................................................... 16-5
Vertical Speed Indicator................................................................................................. 16-7
Engine Instruments ........................................................................................................ 16-7
Magnetic Compass......................................................................................................... 16-7
Flight Hour Meter .......................................................................................................... 16-7
Standby Attitude Indicator............................................................................................. 16-8
Copilot (and Standby) Horizontal Situation Indicator................................................... 16-9
Standby Airspeed Altimeter Indicator......................................................................... 16-10
Angle-of-Attack System .............................................................................................. 16-10
Digital Clock................................................................................................................ 16-12
AVIONICS .......................................................................................................................... 16-13
VHF Communication Transceiver............................................................................... 16-13
VHF Navigation Receivers .......................................................................................... 16-16
KMR-675 Marker Beacon ........................................................................................... 16-17
KR-87 AutomaticDirection Finder.............................................................................. 16-18
HF KHF-950 with KFS-594 Control (Optional) ......................................................... 16-19
Heading........................................................................................................................ 16-72
Track ............................................................................................................................ 16-75
Lateral Navigation Course and Deviation ................................................................... 16-75
ILS Vertical Deviation ................................................................................................. 16-79
Marker Beacon ............................................................................................................ 16-80
Bearing Pointers .......................................................................................................... 16-80
Display Range.............................................................................................................. 16-83
Multifunction Display (MFD) ..................................................................................... 16-84
ENGINE INDICATION SYSTEM (EIS) ........................................................................... 16-88
N1 (Turbine Speed) ...................................................................................................... 16-89
N1 REF......................................................................................................................... 16-90
Interstate Turbine Temperature (ITT)—Engine Start .................................................. 16-91
ITT—Engine Run ........................................................................................................ 16-91
N2 ................................................................................................................................. 16-91
Oil Pressure.................................................................................................................. 16-92
Oil Temperature ........................................................................................................... 16-93
Fuel Flow ..................................................................................................................... 16-93
Fuel Quantity ............................................................................................................... 16-93
Fuel Temperature ......................................................................................................... 16-94
Ignition Operating........................................................................................................ 16-94
MFD Navigation Format ............................................................................................. 16-94
Full-Time Displays ...................................................................................................... 16-96
FLIGHT CONTROL SYSTEM (FCS) ............................................................................... 16-99
General......................................................................................................................... 16-99
FGC-3000 Flight Guidance Computer (FGC)........................................................... 16-100
Servos ........................................................................................................................ 16-100
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
16-1 Standard Instrument Panel—Single PFD............................................................... 16-3
16-2 Optional Instrument Panel—Dual PFDs ................................................................ 16-3
16-3 Primary Flight Display (PFD)................................................................................ 16-4
16-4 Multifunction Flight Display (MFD) ..................................................................... 16-5
16-5 Copilot Standard Airspeed Indicator...................................................................... 16-6
16-6 Altimeters............................................................................................................... 16-6
16-7 Magnetic Compass ................................................................................................. 16-8
16-8 Flight Hour Meter .................................................................................................. 16-8
16-9 Standby Attitude Indicator ..................................................................................... 16-8
16-10 Copilot Standard Attitude Indicator—Smith’s....................................................... 16-9
16-11 Standby or Copilot Standard HSI........................................................................... 16-9
16-12 Standby Airspeed Altimeter Indicator ................................................................. 16-10
16-13 Angle-of-Attack Indicator and Indexer ................................................................ 16-11
16-14 AOA Vane ............................................................................................................ 16-11
16-15 Davtron Digital Clock.......................................................................................... 16-12
16-16 AlliedSignal CNI-5000 Consolidated Control Panel ........................................... 16-14
16-17 HF COMM KFS-594 Control (Optional) ............................................................ 16-19
16-18 HF COMM KCU-951 Control (Optional) ........................................................... 16-20
16-19 AERO-M-TT-5621A Handset—TT-3000AERO-M System ............................... 16-22
16-20 Audio Control Panel ............................................................................................ 16-23
16-21 A-200S Cockpit Voice Recorder (Optional) ........................................................ 16-24
16-22 Airspeed Scale ..................................................................................................... 16-26
16-23 Low-Speed Cues with AOA Displays.................................................................. 16-27
TABLES
Table Title Page
16-1 Speed Reference................................................................................................... 16-51
16-2 FMS Messages ..................................................................................................... 16-85
16-3 PFD Lateral Modes............................................................................................ 16-106
16-4 PFD Flight Guidance Vertical Modes................................................................ 16-107
16-5 PFD Couple Arrows........................................................................................... 16-107
16-6 WXR-800 Color Display versus Rate of Rainfall ............................................. 16-135
16-7 PFD Flags .......................................................................................................... 16-144
16-8 TCAS Traffic Advisory Annunciations (TA) .................................................... 16-166
16-9 EGPWS Aural Warnings, Cautions, and Advisories ......................................... 16-175
16-10 Terrain Map Enhanced Modes........................................................................... 16-175
16-11 Basic GPWS Modes .......................................................................................... 16-177
16-12 Enhanced GPWS Modes.................................................................................... 16-177
CHAPTER 16
AVIONICS
INTRODUCTION
The Citation CJ2 avionics include flight instrumentation, flight guidance, communication/nav-
igation, pitot-static system, and the static discharge wicks. Specific avionics may vary with cus-
tomer preference and few optional avionics items are available. The user should consult the
applicable supplements in the AFM, Section III of the Airplane Operating Manual, and vendor
manuals for detailed information on avionics systems.
The Citation CJ2 is equipped with Collins Pro • Course knob panel (CKP)
Line 21 electronic flight instrument system
• Autopilot panel (APP)
(EFIS). The standard Collins installation
(Figure 16-1) has a single primary flight dis- • Only connects on the left to the pilot
play (PFD) with Collins digital air data com- flight guidance system (FGS)
puter (DADC) and a multifunction display
(MFD) on the pilot side. The copilot has round Copilot Side:
instruments, consisting of pneumatic airspeed,
altimeter and vertical speed, or the optional • Round instruments
RVSM altimeter is available with DADC. The
• Pneumatic airspeed
optional Collins installation (Figure 16-2) is
similar to the standard Collins installation on • Airspeed
the pilot side with PFD and MFD, but on the
• Altimeter
copilot side, the round gages are replaced with
PFD similar to the pilot PFD with associated • V/S
equipment and adds a second Collins air data
computer, good for RVSM operations. Only an • Optional RVSM digital altimeter
LOA, proving runs, and operating manual are with ADC (AM250)
needed for RVSM.
• Right AHS
The standard Collins installation (Figure 16-1) The standard system has switching for AHRS
includes the following: reversion right to left only and no ADC re-
version. If the PFD or MFD display fail, a re-
Pilot Side: version switch allows reverting all data to the
remaining good display in a compressed for-
• PFD or adaptive flight display (AFD) mat including the engine instrument display,
• Mode select panel (MSP) ADI, and HSI.
• Display control panel (DCP) The optional Collins installation (Figure 16-2)
• MFD or adaptive flight display (AFD) includes the following:
xoxo x oxoox
xoxoxx xoxoxx xoxoxx
.7
C
240 .6 H
80 8 1013
2
xoxo KNOTS
LNV1 AP ALTS 220 .5 100
300
17000 200 7
1000 FT
2992 3
.4
260 120 IO Mb HG
20 16000 4
4
180
160
140 6 5
2
240 OCWO
10 900
SE DEX
IN
T
1
20
220 15800
80
1
N1 % ITT °C 91.0 N2 % 91.5 FUEL QTY
10
200 700 2
1001 1000 LBS
I I 1500
G 900 G OIL PSI OIL °C
20 4 100
180 600 xoxo oxo N N
800
M.456 90 1000
3D
HDG 340 33 340 N 29.92 70
700
32 32 130 130 500
FMS1 50
DTK 350 30 600
30 FUEL FLOW
KCID 400
3
95.0 NN 93.2 94.9 200 1050 PPH 1100 690 650
3
95.0 NN
BRT
100
DIM < PRESET RDR
VDR1 VX
T-1.5
BRT
DIM
xoxo x oxoox
xoxo xoxo
LNV1 AP ALTS LNV1 AP ALTS
300
17000 300
17000
260 260
20 16000 4 20 16000 4
2 2
240 OCWO 240
10 900 10 900
1 1
20 20
220 15800
80
220 15800
80
1 1
N1 % ITT °C 91.0 N2 % 91.5 FUEL QTY
10 10
200 700 2
1001 1000 LBS 200 700 2
I I 1500
G 900 G OIL PSI OIL °C
20 4 100 20 4
180 600 xoxo oxo N N 180 600 xoxo oxo
800
M.456 90 1000 M.456
3D 3D
HDG 340 33 340 N 29.92 70 HDG 340 33 340 N 29.92
700
32 32 130 130 500
FMS1 50 FMS1
DTK 350 30 600 DTK 350 30
30 FUEL FLOW
KCID 400 KCID
3
95.0 NN 93.2 94.9 200 1050 PPH 1100 690 650 95.0 NN
95.0 NN
BRT
100 BRT
DIM < PRESET RDR DIM
VDR1 VX
T-1.5
BRT
DIM
3
95.0 NM
nected to the emergency bus. Should the pilot
and copilot instruments fail or the loss of nor- 200 FORMAT >
indicator, emergency-bus-powered left and Figure 16-3. Primary Flight Display (PFD)
right N 1 LCD rpm and emergency-bus-pow-
ered horizontal situation indicator (HSI). On the MFD (Figure 16-4), the upper portion
of the screen displays the engine indication
ELECTRONIC FLIGHT system. The lower portion displays a rose,
arc, FMS map, or FMS plan map format as se-
INSTRUMENT SYSTEM (EFIS) lected by the pilot. The area on either side of
The upper portion of the PFD (Figure 16-3) the rose, arc, or map format is used to display
displays the basic T flight instruments: an at- a lateral navigation data field, a weather radar
titude director indicator (ADI), altitude scale, mode field, and selected menu fields. A data
airspeed scale, and vertical speed scale. In line is displayed along the bottom of the MFD
addition, flight control system mode infor- display with groundspeed, true airspeed, and
mation is displayed in the area above the ADI, temperature readouts. Normal control, re-
and radio altitude data is shown on the attitude version, and warning annunciations also are
display. The lower portion of the PFD screen displayed. Like the PFD, the MFD can be
is used to display a rose, arc, or optional FMS pilot-configured as a combined PFD/MFD to
MAP navigation format as selected by the serve as a backup in the event of PFD failure.
pilot. Weather radar and lightning symbology
can be overlayed on the ARC or MAP format. Line-select keys on both the PFD and MFD
The area on either side of the rose, arc, or map provide the primary pilot interface. Control
format is used to display a lateral navigation of the basic display formats is via the bezel-
data field, a weather radar mode field, system mounted line-select keys located on each dis-
messages, and selected menu data. Normal play. Control of the radar, navigation sources,
control, reversion, and warning annuncia- bearing pointers, speed and altitude refer-
tions are also displayed. The PFD can be pilot- ences are via the line-select keys. Control of
configured as a combined PFD/MFD to serve the course, selected heading, and selected al-
as a backup in the event of multifunction dis- titude is via the course/heading panel (CHP).
play (MFD) failure. In the optional second-PFD configuration, an
autopilot transfer button is provided.
COLLINS
tem and the Mach airspeed warning are pro-
vided by the Pro Line 21 avionics system via
the air data computer.
N1 % ITT °C 91.0 N2 91.5 FUEL QTY
% LBS
1001 1000
2000
I I
G 900 G OIL PSI OIL °C
100
90
N 800 N 1500
1000
AIRSPEED AND ALTIMETER
INDICATIONS
70
700
50 500
600 12°C 12
30 FUEL
400
93.2 94.9 200 1050 PPH 1100 1220 1210
Altitude and airspeed data to the primary flight
displays (PFDs) is provided by information
30 HDG 340
generated through the Rockwell Collins ADC-
33 340 N
FMS1
3000 air data computer, which is transmitted
DTK 350
KCID
30
3
in digital form to the PFDs. This information
95.0 NM is then presented in color on the display in the
200 FORMAT >
PFDs. The ADC-3000 processes the follow-
100 ing air data: pressure altitude (uncorrected),
< PRESET
VOR1
RDR
WX
barometric corrected altitude, barometric pres-
T–1.5
sure, total pressure, static pressure, vertical
speed, airspeed (IAS/CAS), Mach, maximum
speed (VMO /M MO ), true airspeed, total air
GS 254 TAS 250 RAT–15°C SAT–12°C ISA–5°C
BRT
temperature, static air temperature, and ISA
DIM delta temperature.
Figure 16-4. Multifunction Flight The indicated airspeed display is to the left of
Display (MFD) the attitude display on the primary flight dis-
play. The display consists of a “rolling digit”
PITOT-STATIC window in the center of an airspeed vertical
tape. The resolution of the rolling digits is
The model 525A Citation CJ2 is equipped one knot. The moving vertical tape moves be-
with separate pilot-static systems, located on hind the window and displays digital airspeed
the left and right sides of the aircraft. For the at 20-knot intervals, with the larger numbers
two-display system, the left side pitot tube at the top of the scale. The range of the airspeed
supplies pressure to the air data computer that, scale is 40 to 450 knots, with tick marks at 10-
after converting the data into digital infor- knot intervals.
mation, forwards the data through the system
to the pilot primary flight display. The pitot
tube on the right side of the aircraft supplies Copilot Standard
pressure to the copilot airspeed indicator. In Airspeed Indicator
the optional three-display system, pitot pres-
sure from the tube of the right side of the air- The airspeed indicator (Figure 16-5) has a set
craft serves the copilot air data computer. The index knob with an airspeed bug that can be
copilot right pitot-static system is powered rotated 360° around the face of the indicator.
by emergency bus power. Maximum speed limit (VMO /M MO ) is indi-
cated by a red and white slashed barber pole,
Two static ports are located on each side of the and there is an overspeed switch.
aircraft, providing a static source for the pilot
air data computer. The other port on each side Four finger-adjustable plastic airspeed bugs
provides a static source for the copilot air- make handy references and may be moved
speed indicator, altimeter, instantaneous ver- around the instrument bezel to set V 1 (red), V 2
tical speed indicator, and the cabin differential (green), V 2 + 10 (yellow), and V ENR (white)
pressure gage. The gear warning airspeed sys- in the takeoff phase. Normal plastic bugs have
a point at the middle of the tip. Some aircraft
300 320
280
M
0
40
CODE
9 100
0 FT
1
260 A 60 OFF
ALT Mb
.7
C
240 .6 H
80 8 1013
2
KNOTS
220 .5 100
200 7
1000 FT
2992 3
.4
120 IO Mb HG
180 140 6 4
160 5
SE DEX
IN
T
indication when the aircraft is within 1,000 feet 20 seconds, and red for valid data (1) from
of the preselected altitude and extinguishes 104.5 to 105.3% for 20 seconds or more, or (2)
when the aircraft is within 250 feet of the pre- equal to or more than 105.4%. The N 2 dis-
selected altitude. After capture, the light will play consists of the N 2 legend and the N 2 dig-
illuminate if the aircraft departs more than ital readouts. The two N 2 readouts are green
250 feet from the selected altitude and a warn- for valid data less than or equal to 99.3% and
ing tone or the voice annunciator will an- red for valid data equal to or more than 99.4%
nounce ALTITUDE. (100% = 41,200 rpm).
ENGINE INSTRUMENTS The fuel flow display shows the fuel flow in
pounds per hour or kilograms per hour for each
The engine operating parameters of fan rpm, engine. The fuel quantity display shows the fuel
interturbine temperature (ITT), turbine rpm, quantity remaining for each engine in pounds
fuel flow, oil temperature, and oil pressure or kilograms. This consists of the fuel quan-
are monitored by the engine indicating system tity legend, the fuel quantity pointers, the fuel
(EIS) through a color display on the upper quantity scale, fuel quantity readouts, and fuel
screen segment of the center MFD. The EIS quantity units. The oil pressure display shows
consists of four identical data concentration the current oil pressure for each engine in
units. Of the four units, two are configured as pounds per square inch, while oil temperature
data concentrator units, receiving analog and is displayed on a scale from 0° to 140°C.
discrete data inputs from the engines and other
aircraft systems. The left and right data con-
centrator units output engine data to the re- MAGNETIC COMPASS
spective EFIS displays.
A standard liquid-filled magnetic compass
Engine data from the EIS is shown in either (Figure 16-7) is mounted above the glareshield.
normal or compressed format at the top of the
MFD. The fan (N 1 ) display consists of the N 1 FLIGHT HOUR METER
legend, N 1 pointers, N 1 scale and N 1 read-
outs. Two N 1 pointers (analog) are used with The meter (Figure 16-8), located on the copi-
the N 1 scale to show the current fan speeds for lot meter panel, displays the total flight time
the left and right engines. These pointers are on the aircraft in hours and tenths. The land-
white vertical bars that extend from the bot- ing gear squat switch activates the meter when
tom of the scale to the current N 1 value. The the weight is off the gear. A small indicator on
N 1 digital readouts show the current fan speeds the face of the instrument rotates when the
as numerical values (100% fan rpm = 17,245). hour meter is in operation. It is powered by the
The two N 1 readout values are green for valid FLT/HR circuit breaker on the left circuit-
data less than or equal to 104.4%, yellow for breaker panel by right-hand crossover power.
valid data from 104.5 to 105.3% for less than
30
20 20
10 10
O
F
F
10 10
20 20
PU
LL
TO
CA
GE
1.0
ANGLE OF .8
ATTACK
.6
.4
.2
When the aircraft is accelerating from the on- in 24-hour format, and local time is 12-hour
speed reference, the illumination of the circle format. Pressing the SEL button sequentially
will dim and illumination of the bottom chevron displays GMT, local time, flight time, and
will increase until the circle is extinguished and elapsed time. The displayed mode is annun-
only the bottom chevron is illuminated. ciated GMT, LT, FT, and ET, as applicable,
under the time display window.
The top chevron points down, indicating that
the angle of attack must be decreased to elim- To set GMT or local time, select the desired
inate the deviation. The bottom chevron points function by pressing the SEL button.
up to indicate that the angle of attack must be Simultaneously press both the SEL and the
increased to eliminate the deviation. CTL buttons to enter the set mode. The tenths
of hours digit will start flashing and may be
The optional indexer is active anytime the incremented by pressing the CTL button. The
nose gear is down and locked. next digit is then selected by pressing the SEL
button, and similarly set by means of the CTL
button. When the last digit has been set, press
DIGITAL CLOCK the SEL button to exit the set mode. At that
The Davtron model M877 clock (Figure 16- time the clock will start running and the lighted
15) can be made to display four time functions: annunciator will resume flashing. When no
local time, Greenwich Mean Time (GMT), aircraft power is applied to the clock, the SEL
flight time, and elapsed time. Two versions of and CTL buttons will not operate.
the elapsed time function may be selected:
count up or count down. To use the clock as a stopwatch to time ap-
proaches, etc., select ET with the SEL button
and press the CTL button to start the timing.
M877 The clock will start counting elapsed time in
minutes and seconds up to 59 minutes and 59
CHRONOMETER seconds. It will then switch to hours and min-
utes and continue up to 99 hours and 59 min-
utes. Pressing the CTL button will reset the
elapsed time to zero.
mode with the SEL button and holding down of a malfunction to the cooling fans. The FAN
the CTL button for three seconds. Flight time 1 annunciator monitors the top two fans and
is zeroed when the CTL button is released. A will illuminate if one or both of those fans
total of 99 hours and 59 minutes can be shown. fail. The FAN 2 annunciator will illuminate if
the lower cooling fan fails.
A flight time alarm mode is provided, which
will flash the clock display when the desired
flight time is reached. To set the alarm func- VHF COMMUNICATION
tion, select FT with the SEL button and enter TRANSCEIVER
the set mode by pressing both buttons simul-
taneously. Enter the desired alarm time in the Dual KY-196A transceivers and controls are
identical manner that GMT or local time is set. mounted at the top of the consolidated control
When flight time equals the alarm time, the dis- panel (Figure 16-16), located on the center
play will flash. If FT is not being displayed instrument panel. Each radio is a very-high-
when the alarm time is reached, the clock will frequency (VHF) unit with a frequency range
automatically select FT for display. Pressing from 118.000 to 136.975 megahertz (MHz)
either the SEL or CTL button will turn off the with 25-kHz spacing. The frequency displays
alarm and reset the alarm time to zero. Flight are self-dimming seven-segment gas discharge
time is unchanged and continues counting. digital readouts. During ground operation,
radio transmissions can be blocked by sur-
The clock display may be tested when power rounding terrain or structures. This may pos-
is on the aircraft by holding the SEL button sibly be overcome by using the other COMM
down for three seconds. The display will show because of aircraft antenna location. The
88:88 and activate all four annunciators. COMM 1 antenna is on the underside of the
fuselage and the COMM 2 antenna is on top
of the fuselage. When flying through dry pre-
cipitation, it is possible for static electricity
AVIONICS to build up and cause the VHF COMMs to au-
tomatically squelch to a point where reception
The standard avionics package includes dual range is greatly reduced. Disabling the auto-
audio control panels, dual VHF COMM matic squelch by pulling out the on/off/vol-
transceivers, dual NAVs, ADF, and DME, dual ume control (OFF PULL/TEST) knob will
t r a n s p o n d e r s , a u t o f l i g h t s y s t e m , a t wo - cause background static in the speaker or
display Rockwell Collins Pro Line 21 inte- headset, but normal reception range will be
grated avionics system, and a GPS long-range restored. Pushing the knob back in will restore
navigational system. Included as part of the the automatic squelch. If the headset micro-
autoflight system is altitude preselect, alti- phone fails to function properly, check the
tude alerting, and altitude reporting. An op- side console switch in MIC HEADSET, and
tional third flight display is available for the verify that the hand microphone is fully en-
Pro Line 21 system. gaged in its socket.
The two COMMs, two NAVs, two transpon-
ders, and single ADF receiver are mounted in KY-196A Controls
a stacked arrangement behind the consoli- The KY-196A control uses two digital read-
dated control panel, located in the center in- outs to display the controlling (USE) fre-
strument panel. Three fans cool the quency and a pilot selected preset (STBY)
communications rack; fans 1 and 2 (located in frequency. It has four modes of operation: fre-
the rack) cool the rack and fan 3 (located at quency mode, channel mode, channel pro-
floor level) cools the rack in the pedestal. The gramming mode, and direct tuning mode. The
FAN 1 and FAN 2 annunciators, located at the frequency mode of operation allows the pilot
top right of the panel, will illuminate to warn to tune a frequency in the standby frequency
K
25 LL
USE STBY CHAN PU
COMM 1 PULL
CHAN
OFF TEST
FAN 1
PULL
25K
USE STBY CHAN
COMM 2 PULL
CHAN
OFF TEST
FAN 2
USE STBY
NAV 1 PULL
OFF ID
USE STBY
NAV 2 PULL
OFF ID
ANT
ET
USE STBY/TIMER
ADF VOL
FRQ FLT SET
ADF BFO ET RST
OFF
GND
TST ON
IDT SBY ALT
FL GND
OFF
XPDR 1 VFR
PUSH
GND
TST ON
IDT SBY ALT
FL GND
OFF
XPDR 2 VFR
PUSH
display and then “flip-flop” the standby and changes the kHz portion. This smaller knob is
active frequencies by pressing the frequency designed to change the indicated frequency in
transfer (double arrow) button. The channel steps of 50-kHz when it is pushed in and in 25-
mode allows up to nine frequencies and the cor- kHz steps when it is pulled out. At either band
responding channel numbers to be recalled edge, the frequency will wraparound; thus it
from memory. During channel mode of oper- is not required to move completely across the
ation, the channel number is displayed in the frequency display in order to select a much
CHAN window, and rotation of either the small lower or higher frequency. In the frequency
or large knob will increase or decrease the mode of operation, the tuning knobs control
channel number and the corresponding fre- the frequency in the STBY window, which
quency in the STBY window, one channel at may then be transferred to the active (USE)
a time. The channel display will roll over at window by pressing the frequency transfer
either end of the corresponding channel se- (double arrow) button.
lection. The channel programming mode al-
lows the pilot to program desired frequencies The channel mode of operation is entered by
for use in the channel mode of operation. The momentarily pressing the CHAN button while
direct tuning mode is a backup mode that al- in the frequency mode. (Channel program-
lows frequency changes to be made directly ming mode is discussed below.) If there is no
into the active frequency display. The use activity for approximately five seconds, the
(USE) display is the left window and the radio will return to the frequency mode of op-
standby (STBY) display is the right window. eration. In this case, the channel frequency will
Dimming of the digital readouts is automatic be placed in the STBY window. The system
and is controlled by the background lighting. may also be returned to the frequency mode
Refer to Figure 16-16 for a depiction of the by pressing the CHAN button again before
COMM controls. five seconds have elapsed, and the status of the
frequency mode will remain the same as it
The KY-196’s “flip-flop” preselect feature was prior to entering the channel mode. When
enables the pilot to store one frequency in the CHAN is selected, the last active frequency
standby display while operating on another and will remain tuned and displayed in the USE
then interchange them instantly with the touch window. The last used channel number (1 to
of a button. Both the active (USE) and the 9) will be displayed in the CHAN window un-
standby (STBY) frequencies are stored in a cir- less no channels have been programmed; in
cuit component called EAROM (electrical al- which case the system defaults to channel 1 and
terable read-only memory) that provides a dashes are displayed in the STBY window.
nonvolatile storage of frequencies and pro- When either end of the display is reached, the
grammed channels, so that when the radio is display will roll over and start again at the re-
turned off and then back on, channel infor- spective end of the display.
mation is retained.
The CHAN button is pressed and held for three
When the transmitter is in operation, an illu- seconds to enter the channel programming
minated T will appear in the center of the dig- mode. The last used channel number will flash
ital display. in the CHAN window, and the last used active
frequency will remain displayed in the USE
window. Channel numbers from 1 through 9 can
Mode/Frequency/Channel then be selected by rotating either the small or
Selector large knob. Pressing the frequency transfer
In the frequency mode of operation the outer, button (double arrow) will cause the frequency
larger, selector knob of the two concentric associated with that channel to flash; the fre-
knobs located to the right of the display is quency select knobs will then change the fre-
used to change the MHz portion of the fre- quency as described in the frequency mode of
quency display; the smaller knob (PULL 25K) operation, above, with the exception that be-
tween the rollover points dashes are displayed.
To exit the channel programming mode, press frequency and a pilot-selected preset (STBY)
the CHAN button, or after twenty seconds of frequency. The displays are dimmed auto-
no programming activity, the system will au- matically by means of automatic photo sens-
tomatically exit the mode. ing. Dual concentric frequency select knobs
control the display. The larger (outer con-
To enter the direct tuning mode of operation, centric) knob increments or decrements the
the frequency transfer (double arrow) button MHz portion of the display in one-MHz steps.
must be depressed for more than two seconds. The small tuning knob (inner concentric) in-
The standby window frequency will disap- crements or decrements in 50-kHz steps. The
pear, and the window will remain blank; the frequency will roll over or under, as applica-
tuning knobs will then tune the active (USE) ble, at the end of the tuning band so that tun-
frequency directly. Increments, and decre- ing completely across the band to a much
ments of the tuning knobs will be as explained higher or lower frequency is not required.
in the frequency mode of operation, above.
Tuning of the NAV frequencies in normal
The KY-196 is also equipped with a stuck- mode of operation is done in the STBY win-
microphone indicator. If the mic switch re- dow and then “flip-flopped” into the USE win-
mains keyed for two minutes, the display will dow by pressing the frequency transfer (double
begin flashing and the transmitter will shut arrow) button. This allows the pilot to pretune
down, preventing jamming of the frequency. the desired frequency and then interchange
the old and new frequencies with a touch of a
button. The STBY window is then available for
VHF NAVIGATION RECEIVERS a new pretuned frequency.
Dual KN-53 navigation receivers provide
VOR, localizer, and glide-slope capability. The OFF PULL/ID knob operates as an
The receivers are mounted with other avion- on/off/volume control as well as a control for
ics navigation and communication (NAV/ selecting voice/code identification (ID), or
COM) equipment in the center of the consol- only code ID signals of VOR stations. Pulling
idated control panel, which is located on the the knob out allows the station identification
left side of the center instrument panel. The tone signals to be heard, as well as the station
controls/receivers of both NAV radios are one- voice announcements. Pushing it in will allow
piece units. only NAV voice signals to be heard. Rotation
of the knob allows volume control of the audio
Each system has 200 VOR/LOC operating fre- signals; complete counterclockwise rotation
quencies and 40 glide-slope frequencies. VOR turns off power to the NAV receiver.
and localizer (VOR/LOC) frequencies are
from 108.00 to 117.95 MHz. Glide-slope fre- Interface of the NAV receivers with other equip-
quencies are from 329.15 to 335.00 MHz. The ment that use and display NAV signals is also
localizer/glide-slope frequencies are paired discussed in the various parts of this section.
and are automatically tuned together. When the Controls and displays of the distance measur-
published localizer frequency is tuned, the ing equipment (DME), the copilot horizontal
glide-slope frequency is also tuned. Multiple situation indicator (HSI), and the pilot pri-
outputs drive the flight director, HSIs, RMI, mary flight display are discussed separately.
and autopilot. All the basic functions have a
built-in self-test. The pilot can select NAV 1 or NAV 2 on the
primary flight display by utilizing the line-se-
lect keys on the NAV SOURCE and BRG
KN-53 Controls SOURCE menus on the PFD. The NAV/BRG
button on the display control panel is used to
The KN-53 controls use two seven-digit gas
s e l e c t a n d d e s e l e c t t h e NAV a n d B R G
discharge displays for the controlling (USE)
SOURCE menus on the on-side PFD. The
available NAV sources are FMS1/FMS2 and and glide-slope pointer are removed from view
VOR1/VOR2 or LOC1/LOC2. The active NAV when a LOC is no longer the active NAV source.
source selection is displayed on the PFD in
color-coded text as on-side (magenta) or cross- Refer to Figure 16-16 for a depiction of the
side (yellow). Inactive source legends are dis- KN-53 NAV controls.
played in smaller white text.
The PFD displays the active lateral navigation KMR-675 MARKER BEACON
course and deviation information on the com- The KMR-675 marker beacon receiver system
pass rose and arc. Lateral navigation course is remotely mounted in the lower forward part
and deviation information is made up of a of the nose avionics compartment. The marker
course pointer, to/from arrow, lateral deviation beacon receiver provides marker beacon sig-
bar, and scale. The course pointer is a single- nals to the pilots through the marker beacon
bar arrow that points to the selected course. presentations on the pilot primary flight
display (copilot PFD optional) and the copi-
To change the NAV source, if the desired lot panel lights (STD). The marker beacon re-
source is the partner of a currently selected ceiver is in operation whenever the avionics
source, a single press of the adjacent line- power switches are on and power is available.
select key on the PFD will toggle the source They operate on a frequency of 75.00 MHz.
selection. If the desired source is an on-side
sensor located against a currently not active The annunciators in the pilots primary flight
sensor pair, a single press of the adjacent line- displays are part-time displays. A white box,
select key will select the desired source. A located in the left side of the ADI, identifies
second press of the same line-select key will the location of the marker beacon annuncia-
toggle to the cross-side source, if installed. The tor when a localizer frequency is tuned. The
NAV SOURCE menu is removed either by marker beacon is annunciated by the appro-
pressing the NAV/BRG pushbutton, or by priately colored letters: a blue 0 for outer
pressing LSK-R4 RETURN. marker, an amber M for middle marker, and a
white I for inner marker. The letters appear in
Selecting the active NAV source on the PFD the white box when the marker beacon re-
also automatically selects the distance mea- ceiver is activated. A marker beacon tone is
suring equipment (DME) display to that of transmitted to the audio control panel and will
the NAV selected. Since the AlliedSignal DME be heard in the speaker/headset, if selected. A
does not provide station identification, no 400-Hz tone is heard at the outer marker, a
identification is available when VOR or LOC 1,300-Hz tone at the middle marker, and a
is the active NAV source. The distance display 3,000-Hz tone for the inner marker.
provides distance information in nautical miles
to the station. Distance is associated with the The audio muting system (MKR MUTE) pro-
active NAV source, thus providing distance to vides the pilots with a method of temporarily
the next waypoint for FMS, distance to the cutting out the marker beacon audio. When
VOR/DME (or VORTAC) station for VOR, pressed, the marker beacon signal is muted for
and distance to the runway for LOC. Lateral approximately 30 seconds. The MKR MUTE
navigation information normally is color- switches (pushbuttons) are located on the
coded as on-side (green) or cross-side (yellow). audio control panels.
The vertical deviation scale on the PFD comes The marker beacon antenna is mounted under
into view between the attitude ball and the al- the fuselage abeam the main cabin entry door.
titude scale when a LOC is the active NAV System protection is from the MKR BCN cir-
source. The glide-slope deviation pointer is cuit breaker on the right circuit-breaker panel.
diamond shaped, and color follows the active
NAV source color. The vertical deviation scale
elapsed time (ET) modes are being displayed, increments, with 19 channel preset capability
the standby frequency is kept in memory. It in the HF band (2.0000 to 29.9999.9 MHz). It
may be called back by pressing the FRQ but- operates in AM and single sideband. Upper
ton, and then transferred to the active fre- sideband (USB) is normally used for sideband
quency by pressing the FRQ button again. operation, but lower sideband (LSB) is avail-
able where that mode may be used.
While FLT or ET is displayed, the in-use fre-
quency on the left side of the display may be In TEL (A3J) mode, any of the ITU telephone
directly changed by using the frequency select channels (401 through 2241) may be selected.
knobs, without any effect on the stored standby
frequency or the other modes. This feature is
useful when tuning for stations the exact fre- Control and Indicators
quency of which the operator may not know. All controls and indicators are located on the
radio set control, which is normally mounted
A second KR-87 ADF may be installed, in low and to the left on the copilot instrument
which case the first system is duplicated with panel. The smaller left-most knob controls
a second complete system, and operation of the power to the receiver/transmitter and con-
second ADF is identical to the first. If a sec- t r o l s t h e vo l u m e o f t h e r e c e ive d a u d i o .
ond ADF is installed, its bearing information Clockwise rotation turns the unit on and in-
may be displayed on the bearing needle on creases the volume.
the pilot or copilot HSI.
The larger left-most knob controls the thresh-
old of the received signal above which the
HF KHF-950 WITH KFS-594 audio is enable (squelch). Turning the knob
CONTROL (OPTIONAL) clockwise reduces the signal threshold (de-
The KHF-950 with KFS-594 control (Figure creases squelch).
16-17) is a 150-watt transceiver system that
provides 280,000 frequencies at 100-Hz The larger right-most knob selects the emis-
sion modes: LSB, lower sideband; USB, upper
sideband; AM, amplitude modulation; and
TEL (A3J, or ITU mode). When LSB, USB,
or AM is selected, the radio is set to the cor-
CH responding mode and a frequency is displayed
in the control head, which may be directly se-
M lected on one of the 19 user-programmable
H
Z channels. When TEL (A3J) is selected, the
radio is set to the corresponding mode and an
K ITU channel is displayed in the control head.
H S
Z T
O The smaller right-most knob, when pushed
in, moves the cursor (represented by a flash-
HF USB ing digit) from left to right. One push incre-
AM
VOL ments the cursor one digit to enable that digit
LSB TEL to be selected as required. When the small
OFF (A3J)
SQ knob is turned, it increments or decrements the
digit selected by the cursor.
HF The STO button is used to perform three sep-
arate functions: (1) When in the channel mode
(not in program mode—program mode is an-
Figure 16-17. HF COMM KFS-594 nunciated by the flashing dash adjacent to
Control (Optional)
the channel number), pressing and holding If the user desires to operate the radio in the
the STO button causes the control to display directly tuned mode without a channel num-
the letters TX and the tuned transmit fre- ber annunciated or a flashing dash, he may
quency while the receiver monitors the trans- tune the channel selector to zero and then
mit frequency. This enables the pilot to listen tune a frequency. The zero will disappear and
for signals on the transmit frequency of du- the annunciated frequency will be relocated.
plex channels; (2) If STO is pushed while the Other frequencies may not be selected in like
microphone is keyed, a 1,000-Hz tone is manner as long as a channel other than zero
broadcast, which may be used to break the is not selected.
squelch of some stations; (3) In the program
mode, selected by incrementing the cursor A photocell-activated dimming circuit adjusts
until the dash appears in flashing mode, the the brightness of the display to compensate for
selected frequency may be entered into the changes in the ambient light level.
channel appearing under the CH designation
on the display.
HF KHF-950 WITH KCU-951
In order to program any one of the 19 user- CONTROL (OPTIONAL)
programmable channels, proceed as follows:
(1) Select the channel to be programmed; (2) The KHF-950 with KCU-951 control (Figure
Step the cursor to the frequency digits, as de- 16-18) is a 150-watt transceiver that provides
scribed above, and set in the desired fre- 280,000 frequencies at 100-Hz increments,
quency. Changing the displayed frequency of with 99 channel preset capability in the HF
a programmable channel will automatically band (2.0000 to 29.9999 MHz). It operates in
place the control head in program mode, as in- AM and single sideband. Upper sideband
dicated by the flashing dash adjacent to the (USB) is normally used for sideband operation,
channel number; (3) Press STO to transfer but lower sideband (LSB) is available where
the frequency into the T/R unit receiver. The that mode is used.
flashing TX will appear in the upper right of
the display and the cursor will move to the Controls and Indicators
10/1-MHz digits; (4) Change the display to the
desired transmit frequency (if different from All controls and indicators are located on the
the receive frequency); (5) Press STO again. radio set control. A two-position FREQ/CHAN
When the transmit frequency is accepted, the switch in the upper right corner determines
letters TX and the cursor will disappear. the form of operation. The depressed position
establishes the channelized form of operation.
The flush positions provides direct frequency
USB
MODE FREQ CHAN
FREQ KHZ CHANNEL
PULL
ON
OFF
CLARIFIER SQUELCH VOLUME
STO PGM
Exit OK
The following are the five dialing formats that
can be used to initiate a telephone call:
A
CIns Edit B
C
Del
2nd Mute
• Standard telephone numbers—Dialing a
telephone number by entering call pre-
1
Menu Lock
2abc
Area
3 def fixes, area codes, and number.
4 ghi
Fax R
5 jkl
Print
6m n o • Short codes (speed dialing)—Short
Data
codes are two-digit codes that corre-
7 pqrs 8 tuv 9wxyz spond to number addresses in the system
0 # phonebook.
*
• Handset to handset—If an auxiliary
handset is connected to the AUX/FAX
port, it is possible to call handset to
handset.
UNIVERSAL AVIONICS
Thrane & Thrane • Last number redial—The handset keeps
a list of the last 20 numbers dialed.
• Call handoff—Call handoff is like call
transfer on a standard telephone. If an
Figure 16-19. AERO-M-TT-5621A auxiliary handset is used, it is possible
Handset—TT-3000 to receive a call on either the number 1
AERO-M System or number 2 (AUX) handset and trans-
fer the call to the other handset.
(LCD) for operational and diagnostic readout,
four indicator LEDs, and a volume control. NOTE
The handset allows the user to utilize a menu
of operations that include placing and receiv- SATCOM reception may be inter-
ing calls, forwarding calls, saving and recall- rupted briefly during turns, due to
ing phonebook entries, viewing a phone log, and shadowing of the antenna by aircraft
monitoring system operations. structure. Continuing the turn or re-
ducing bank angle should restore
The Aero-M SATCOM system may require communication. A limitation re-
an INMARSAT SIM card inserted into the quires that the AERO-M SATCOM
satellite data unit before it will operate cor- telephone switch, located adjacent to
rectly. The SIM card contains system IDs and the ADF, must be selected to the
additional stored information (phonebooks). OFF position to remove power from
To insert the SIM card into the satellite data the AERO-M SATCOM system (in-
unit: (1) loosen the thumbscrew on the SIM cluding the antenna) during any ADF
card door (located on the front panel of the navigation (see Supplement 12 for
unit; (2) open the door and insert the SIM card further information).
into the slot with the gold contact pointing
toward the right; and (3) ensure that the SIM
PASS
SPKR
SEL 1 2 HF 1 2
HF
C DME NAV SPKR
O
M 2
M OFF
1
VOLUME 1 2 1 2
HDPH
IDENT MKR
PS H S
S AP D
P
P
T SK H K
SR R
VOICE 1 2 MUTE
muted. The EMER/COMM 1 bypasses the The copilot audio panel is powered by the
audio amplifier, necessitating the use of a emergency bus, causing battery power to al-
headset to receive, and volume control is avail- ways be available to that panel when the BATT
able only at the radio. Transmitting remains switch is in any position except OFF. In the
normal from all microphone sources. An op- EMER position of the battery (BATT) switch,
tional audio control panel has a fifth position the audio normal/emergency relay relaxes and
to be used for the HF system, if installed. connects the pilot audio panel to the emer-
gency bus; thus, in case of loss of both gen-
A side tone control knob, which is concentric erators, both audio panels will continue to
to the passenger speaker volume control knob, operate with the battery switch in the EMER
is located on the lower left side of the audio position. COMM 1 transmit and audio will be
control panel. The side tone control allows operative and NAV 1 audio may be received.
the pilot and copilot to select individual side
tone volumes within certain limits. The side
tone cannot be completely removed; some A-200S COCKPIT VOICE
side tone will always remain. When the oper- RECORDER (OPTIONAL)
ator positions the control knob, side tone vol-
ume for all of the transmitters being operated An A-200S cockpit voice recorder system pro-
from the respective audio control panel, and vides a continuous 120-minute record of all
the interphone side tone, will be set. voice communications originating from the
cockpit as well as sounds from warning horns
A t h r e e - p o s i t i o n AU T O S E L s w i t c h and bells. The system is protected by a 5-
(SPKR–OFF–HDPH) automatically selects ampere circuit breaker located in the tail cone
the proper speaker or headphone to match the electrical junction box.
position of the rotary microphone selector
switch. All audio sources can be monitored at The sensitive microphone is located to the left
any time by use of the appropriate side of the fire tray. The system is energized
SPKR–OFF–HDPH switch, regardless of the when the battery switch is in the BATT posi-
microphone selector switch or the AUTO SEL tion. The control panel (Figure 16-21), nor-
switch positions. A MKR MUTE button, when mally located on the right instrument panel,
pressed, silences the marker beacon audio for contains a TEST button and an ERASE button.
approximately 30 seconds. System operation is checked by pressing the
TEST button. When the TEST button is held
A two-position switch on the control wheel has down for five seconds, illumination of the
a MIC position for keying the transmitters green light on the control panel indicates cor-
and INPH for interphone communication when rect functioning of the voice recorder system.
using the lip microphone or oxygen mask mi- Pressing the ERASE button for approximately
crophone. If a hand-held microphone is used, two seconds will cause the entire record to be
transmission is determined by the position of erased. Erasure can only be accomplished on
the microphone selector switch. the ground with the main entry door opened.
COCKPIT VOICE
RECORDER
HOLD
5 SEC
The air data computer receives pitot tube and AIRSPEED, MACH, AND
static port pneumatic data, Collins air tem-
perature data, and IAPS inputs to compute the
AIRSPEED TREND VECTOR
air data parameters. The ADC is programmed The air data computer(s) provide displays of
with static source error correction (SSEC), as airspeed, Mach, overspeed, airspeed trend,
well as the aircraft’s maximum operating four pilot-selectable airspeed references for
speeds (V MO /M MO ), which it then uses to takeoff, and three references for landing
compensate for deficiencies in the aircraft (Figure 16-22).
static system when sending data outputs.
150
T
140
60
120
11 5
4 1R
2
100
80
M .456
AIRSPEED SCALE AIRSPEED SCALE
AT POWER UP > M .45
Figure 16-22. Airspeed Scale
Airspeed information is displayed in red when The impending stall speed (ISS) range marker
the airspeed is less than or equal to impend- is a thick red vertical line displayed against
ing stall greater than or equal to V MO /M MO . the airspeed scale. The top of the ISS range
marker indicates the calculated impending stall
speed. Impending stall speed variable is cal-
culated using 1.1V S , airspeed, and AOA. The
IAS readout changes to yellow when ap-
proaching ISS.
OVERSPEED
CUE (RED)
140
AIRSPEED
INDICATOR
220 RAS
1.3VS1
120
AIRSPEED
TREND VECTOR 240
120
(MAGENTA)
AP AP
AIRSPEED
220
4 RF 1.1VS 8
100 RF
DIGITAL
READOUT
200
103
100 97
M .458
2 6
LOW-SPEED HDG
20
CUE 80
(YELLOW) FMS1
30
DTK 350
KCID
80
95.0NM
IMPENDING
STALL SPEED 200 60
(RED)
< PRESET
VOR1 LOW AIRSPEED LOW AIRSPEED
MACH WITH AOA NO AOA
DISPLAY VOR1
The ISS caution is displayed if the airspeed The ISS and RAS markers are removed when
trend vector is below ISS for five seconds or on the ground and their display is inhibited
more or when airspeed is 2 knots below ISS. until the aircraft has been airborne at least
For the warning, the ISS range marker changes three seconds.
to an alternating red and dark blue segmented
line. In addition, the airspeed digital readout
turns yellow and flashes for five seconds, Overspeed Cue
then is steady. If the Mach readout is dis- The overspeed cue is displayed (Figure 16-24)
played, the readout changes to red and flashes on the airspeed scale when VMO/MMO is within
for five seconds. display range. The overspeed cue is a vertical,
variable-length, solid red bar. The bottom of the
overspeed cue is positioned at V MO until the
Low-Speed Cues (without AOA) M MO becomes more restrictive, then the bot-
When AOA data is invalid, the ISS range tom is positioned at the airspeed that corre-
marker is replaced by a fixed low-speed range sponds with the M MO for the current altitude.
marker and a fixed ISS range marker warning. V MO /M MO is calculated by the ADC as a func-
tion of aircraft type, airspeed, and altitude.
The fixed low-speed range marker is a verti-
cal yellow line displayed against the airspeed
scale. Range is fixed from 97 to 72 knots. The Overspeed Mode
bottom of the fixed low-speed range marker Characteristics of overspeed mode are
abuts the top of the fixed ISS range marker as follows:
warning. The top of the fixed ISS range marker
warning indicates 72 knots. • Overspeed mode is automatically selected
when a significant overspeed occurs from
220 240
220
IMPENDING ACTUAL
OVERSPEED OVERSPEED
Figure 16-24. Overspeed Cue Displays
all vertical modes, except altitude select The low-speed cues are removed when the
capture or track and altitude hold. IAS flag is in view. If V MO/M MO data is failed,
• A significant overspeed is defined as the overspeed cue is removed and the IAS
.015 Mach above M MO or five knots flag is displayed.
above V MO .
• Overspeed generates commands to cap- Airspeed Trend Vector
ture the reference airspeed. The airspeed trend vector is a vertical, variable-
• At selection, if above the transition length, magenta line that extends up or down
altitude, the reference airspeed is au- on the airspeed scale. The end of the airspeed
tomatically set to M MO . If below the trend vector provides an approximation of what
transition altitude, the reference the airspeed will be in 10 seconds at the pre-
airspeed is automatically set to V MO . sent rate of acceleration. The trend vector is cut
The IAS, or Mach reference will never off at ±40 knots. The calculation of trend is
increase but may decrease to maintain based on airspeed, airspeed rate, longitudinal
V MO /M MO (as V MO /M MO changes with acceleration, and pitch angle. The airspeed
altitude). The IAS, or Mach reference, trend vector is not displayed until the aircraft
cannot be adjusted by the pitch wheel has been airborne for three seconds, and it is
while in overspeed. removed at all times on the ground. The air-
• A speed reference bug is displayed next speed trend vector is also removed if any data
to the airspeed scale on the PFD when needed to calculate it is failed.
the speed reference is IAS. When the
speed reference is Mach, a Mach refer- The overspeed caution annunciation is trig-
ence bug is displayed next to the IAS gered by airspeed trend vector greater than
scale. V MO /M MO +2 knots for two seconds or more.
It shows yellow IAS digits and the solid red
• Overspeed mode inhibits the selection line changes to an alternating red and dark
or activation of any other vertical mode, blue segmented line.
except altitude hold and altitude select
capture.
• Overspeed automatically transitions to Overspeed Alert
flight level change when the IAS/Mach The overspeed warning is triggered when the
has dropped below V MO /M MO . actual airspeed exceeds V MO /M MO by more
• The flight guidance system (FGS) will than two knots. When the overspeed alert is
pitch the aircraft up to slow down but not active, the V MO /M MO cue is changed to an al-
above the horizon. ternating red and dark blue segmented line.
The airspeed readout changes to red and
flashes for five seconds, then steady. If the
IAS Flag Mach readout is displayed, the readout
changes to red and flashes for five seconds,
Air data information then steady, and the cockpit aural warning
comes from the air data horn sounds. OVERSPEED TEST is activated
computer (ADC). In the on the ground with the rotary test switch to
IAS optional second PFD in-
stallation, the on-side or
trigger the overspeed aural.
cross-side ADC can be
selected as the on-side
source. The airspeed flag
IAS is displayed in red on the airspeed scale,
and all airspeed information is removed when
IAS data from the selected ADC is failed.
200
BAROMETRIC ALTITUDE
The pilot reads current barometric altitude in
MODE SELECT PANEL
M .458 the fine window in the middle of the vertical
(MSP) “FILCH” MODE HDG
20 moving altitude scale (Figure 16-26). The
FMS1 moving altitude scale displays 450 feet total
DTK 350 30 or 225 feet above and below the fine window
DN KCID
95.0NM in thousands of feet, with tick marks every
hundred feet. The fine window displays alti-
200
tude every 20 feet from –1,000 to 55,000 feet
(–300 to 16,765 meters).
UP < PRESET
VOR1
The ten thousands, thousands, and hundreds
AUTO PILOT PANEL (APP) VOR1 digits are larger digits than the tens and ones
SPD/VS PITCH WHEEL units. This presents the altitude in a flight level
PFD DISPLAY predominant manner. Negative altitudes are in-
Figure 16-25. Autopilot Speed Bug dicated by a small, white, vertically positioned
Display and Controls NEG in the thousands digit place.
ALTITUDE
50 00 PRESELECT
30
6 00 ALTITUDE
SCALE
20
5 00 BARO
40
10 #14 20 FINE
WINDOW
PU S H
00 (BARO SCALE)
STD
BROWN
3 00 ALTITUDE
SCALE
100 10 2 00 DISPLAY CONTROL
30.12 KNOB (DCP)
BARO SET KNOB
ADI AND RADIO ALTITUDE 100 FT AND PUSH STD BUTTON
ALTIMETER SETTING (BARO)
Figure 16-26. Altitude Display and BARO Control
Altitude Flag
Barometric altitude information comes from
the ADS (air data system). In the optional
second PFD installations, the on-side or cross-
1000 FEE side ADS can be selected as the on-side
9 1
T
source. Barometric altitude information is
1000 2 displayed in green when the on-side ADS is
selected and when cross-side ADC is selected,
7 3 a yellow ADC 1 (or ADC 2) indication is dis-
MB IN HG
9 ALT played on the right side of the PFD. The pilot
101 4 2993
5 or copilot DADC REV switch is used to se-
lect and deselect the on-side source. A boxed,
0 60 red ALT flag replaces the barometric altitude
60 8 pointer when barometric altitude information
is failed (Figure 16-28), or there is no avail-
IAS KNOTS
BARO able barometric pressure for correction. The
barometric altitude scales, digital thousands
readout, metric altitude readout, selected al-
titude readout, and selected altitude refer-
Figure 16-27. Standby Altimeter ence (bug) are removed when barometric
altitude data is failed.
------
4 4
5 00
2 2
4 00 1 1 DRAGS A
VERTICAL LINE
#13 VS POINTER
1 1
2 00 2 2 DIGITAL READOUT
IF OVER 300 FPM
4 4 DESCENDING
1 00 800
29.92
Figure 16-30. Vertical Speed Display
1500 HAS
VS BUG BEEN SET CLIMBING
VERTICAL SPEED
VS VALUE DIGITAL DN
SELECTED VS 1500 READOUT OVER
ALTS 300 FPM UP
50 00 1500
AUTOPILOT
FCS MODE UP
FIELD 30 4 VERTICAL SPEED
BUG AT 1,500 FPM
2
3 00
20 MANUAL PITCH WHEEL
1 VERTICAL SPEED SET TO CLIMB
00 POINTER AT 1,500 FPM
10 #4 80
60
1
1 00 VERTICAL SPEED
INDICATOR
2 VS
10 0 00 4
VS SELECTED
30.12 ON MSP
play range is 0 to 8,000 feet per minute in • LDS (lightning detection system) (as an
100-feet-per-minute increments. option)
• FMS (flight management system)
The selected VS readout in the FCS mode field
is followed by an up or down arrow. Arrow di- The left and right attitude heading computers
rection is upward for a selected climb or down- (AHC) are in the forward nose baggage com-
ward for a selected descent. The digital display partment on the left side under the floor. The
is boxed while the wheel is in motion. AHC utilizes inertial sensors to generate an-
gular rate and linear acceleration about the
body of the aircraft and digitally processes
VS Flag this data to obtain three-axis angle, rate, and
Vertical speed source is direct from each in- acceleration information. The AHC receives
stalled ADC. On a second PFD magnetic flux inputs from the flux detector
installation, the flight-deck- unit, compass compensation from the external
VS mounted ADC reversion switch compensation unit, and strut switch logic from
controls which ADC is the on- the integrated avionics processor system. In
side source. If VS information turn, the AHC supplies attitude, stabilized
from the selected ADC is failed, the vertical magnetic (or free gyro) heading, and linear ac-
speed digital readout, scale, and pointer are re- celeration outputs.
moved, and a red, boxed VS flag is displayed.
The flux detector unit (FDU) uses a pendulous
sensing element to detect the direction of the
magnetic field of the earth. FDU data is sup-
ATTITUDE HEADING plied to the AHC, where it is used for com-
SYSTEM (AHS) puting stabilized magnetic heading.
where these phenomena occur are usually well Heading Flag in View Prior to
known, and entry and exit of these areas can
be anticipated.
Departure at Specific Airports
Airports that are located just inside low flux
The appearance of a heading flag when oper- areas may have sufficient flux during approach
ating in areas of known low magnetic flux can and departure, but not on the field. The sug-
be dealt with by prudent use of the directional gested corrective action is as follows:
gyro (DG) mode. In DG mode, the long-term
input from the flux detector is not used. 1. Perform a MANUAL (DG mode) initial-
ization.
NOTE
2. Slew compass to known heading reference
DG mode is only for brief operation (i.e., runway).
near magnetic anomalies. DG mode
is not intended for use as a long-term
heading reference. 3. After departure, return to AUTO (slaved
mode) periodically (while in straight,
level, and not accelerating or decelerat-
Heading Flag in View ing flight) to check for absence of the
While Enroute heading flag.
If the heading flag cycles in and out of view 4. If the heading flag does not show, remain
erratically during transit of a low flux area, the in AUTO (slaved mode) operation.
suggested corrective action is as follows:
1. Switch to MANUAL (DG mode); verify 5. If the heading flag does show, and if
that heading flag (HDG) is removed. MANUAL (DG mode) is selected for an
extended period of time (based on the
24°/hour drift rate of the free-gyro mode);
2. Return to AUTO (slaved mode) periodi- then another means to verify the heading
cally while in straight, level, and not ac- must be used, as required.
celerating or decelerating flight, to check
for the absence of the heading flag.
Absence of the heading flag in AUTO Heading Flag in View during
(slaved mode) indicates that required lev- Takeoff Roll at Specific Airports
els of magnetic flux are available to the
computer for normal operation. Some airports are located in fringe areas that
have insufficient flux levels only during some
3. If the heading flag does not show, remain dynamic conditions. The acceleration during
in the AUTO (slaved mode) operation. a takeoff roll on southerly runways in the
northern hemisphere may cause a heading flag
to show because of the pendulum movement
4. If the heading flag does show and MAN- of the flux detector coils. The heading flag goes
UAL (DG mode) is selected for an ex- out of view when the acceleration is reduced.
tended period of time (based on the The suggested corrective action is as follows:
24°/hour drift rate of the free-gyro mode),
then another means to verify the heading 1. While at the terminal, perform a normal
must be used, as required. initialization.
2. Just prior to starting the takeoff roll,
switch to MANUAL (DG mode).
3. After departure, and while in straight, location, and therefore may become known
level, and not accelerating or decelerating to the pilot.
flight, switch from MANUAL (DG mode)
back to AUTO (slaved mode) operation. The suggested corrective action is as follows:
the magnetic field of the earth is then sensed Either of the following is the suggested cor-
by the flux detector, thus becoming an error. rective action:
At bank angles less than about 7°, the compass
system will be pulled by the error from the ac- • When the aircraft is in turbulence, do not
tual heading at a 3°-per-minute rate. manually fast slave the compass sys-
tem. Let the slaving action remove the
When bank angles are greater than about 7°, heading error.
the compass system goes into slaving cutout. • When the aircraft is free of the turbu-
In this state, the errors induced into the flux lence and is in level, nonaccelerating
detector have no effect on the displayed head- flight, go to MANUAL and fast slave the
ing because the compass system will ignore the compass system to return it to the actual
flux detector data while in slaving cutout. heading, then return to AUTO.
Either of the following is the suggested cor-
rective action: ATTITUDE
• When a shallow turn has induced a head- General
ing error and the aircraft has returned to
level, nonaccelerating flight, go to The attitude display used in the EFIS system
MANUAL and fast slave the compass provides the traditional attitude ball with a
system to return it to the actual heading, blue sky and brown earth separated by a white
then return to AUTO. horizon line. A V-shaped single cue aircraft
symbol is located in the center of the attitude
• Prior to entering a shallow turn that is display. The attitude ball displays pitch, roll,
likely to induce heading error, switch the and slip-skid information.
compass system into MANUAL (DG
mode). When the turn has been com-
pleted and the aircraft has returned to Pitch
level, nonaccelerating flight, return the
system to the slaved mode of operation. The horizon line is part of the pitch scale, and
it pivots in roll around the aircraft symbol.
Pitch marks are in 2.5° increments up to ±30°.
Operation in Turbulence Expanded markings are displayed from ±30°
up to ±90°. When the pitch attitude exceeds
The forces encountered in turbulence will +30° or –20°, excessive pitch attitude warn-
move the flux detector coils away from their ing chevrons are displayed on the pitch scale,
horizontal position. When this happens, errors and the PFD is decluttered. Downward point-
will result because of the influence of the ver- ing chevrons appear at +30° and slide out at
tical field. However, errors due to turbulence +25°. Upward pointing chevrons appear at
tend to cancel out, so this type of induced –20° and slide out at –15°.
heading error is not as common as others.
20
GENERAL
ONE HALF
The integrated avionics processor system
(IAPS) is a physical collection of several func-
10 BALL OUT
tional modules combined into an efficient me-
chanical package to minimize size, weight,
cost, and aircraft wiring. It consists of the
ONE BALL OUT following:
10 • One integrated card cage (ICC), in-
cluding lightning/HIRF protection
DISPLAY–STBY SWITCHES
The MAINT ENABLE switch is located near BARO
floor level, on the right side of the pedestal, PUSH
TILT RANGE
STBY
Figure 16-35. MAINT ENABLE and OIL
TEMP DISPLAY–STBY
Switches
Collins
Select GCS by pressing the GCS button. A and a multifunction display (MFD) to the left
cyan GCS annunciation replaces the active side of the center instrument panel. Both PFD
radar mode legend for 10 seconds. GCS may and MFD are exactly the same units. The func-
be selected ON or OFF when the RDR mode tion of each is controlled by the IAPS card
menu is active or anytime the radar is dis- cage strapping units located in the right nose
played on the on-side PFD or MFD. baggage compartment. The PFDs and MFDs
each weigh 12.9 pounds. The symbol genera-
tors are built into each unit. The PFD and MFD
TILT Knob can be reverted, should a display failure occur.
The DCP TILT knob is used to adjust the Either display can be formatted in the com-
weather radar antenna tilt. Clockwise rota- pressed mode, displaying all three of the fol-
tion adjusts the antenna above the horizon, lowing:
counterclockwise rotation adjusts the antenna
below the horizon. Range is ±15°. Tilt may be 1. The engine indicating system (EIS) at
adjusted when the RADAR menu is active or the top
anytime the radar is being displayed on the on-
side PFD or MFD. 2. The ADI for altitude in the middle
3. The HSI for heading and navigation at
Display Range the bottom
The DCP RANGE knob controls the range For this reason, they are also called adaptive
displayed on the on-side PFD and MFD. flight displays (AFDs), able to perform more
Clockwise rotation increases display range, than one function.
counterclockwise decreases it. Map displays
radar displays, and optional lightning displays The PFD and MFD generate little internal
require range to be shown. Range is 300 nm heat. Warm ambient temperatures do require
anytime the weather radar is on. cooling fans and very cold ambient tempera-
tures require internal heaters in each PFD and
MFD. The AFM “Limitations” section de-
DCP Flag scribes hot and cold requirements and limits.
PFD and MFD use a liquid-crystal display,
The DCP fail flag DCP is displayed in red on which has clarity when viewed at wide an-
the PFD when data from the DCP is failed. The gles. The upper half of the PFD displays the
display formats, NAV source, and bearing basic pilot T displays of the attitude director
source remain unchanged when the DCP flag indicator (ADI), with airspeed vertical scale
is in view. at the left, and altitude vertical scale and ver-
tical speed (VS) to the right.
FLIGHT GUIDANCE Above the ADI is a dark blue field that displays
the flight control system (FCS) lateral modes
SYSTEM to the left of the sky pointer and vertical modes
to the right, which are programmed into the
PRIMARY FLIGHT DISPLAY mode select panel (MSP). The lower half of
the PFD displays heading and navigation data
(PFD) in several formats. The upper right line-select
The standard Rockwell Collins Pro Line 21 key (LSK) next to format> (blue), when
EFIS installation consists of two 8" x 10", pressed successively, gives the rose, ARC,
color, liquid-crystal displays (Figure 16-38). and FMS MAP (if an FMS flight plan has been
The pilot primary flight display (PFD) is selected), as selected by the pilot. Weather
located in the pilot instrument panel, with a radar and optional lightning symbology can be
display control panel (DCP) at the right side overlaid on the ARC or FMS MAP formats.
Collins
BARO
GA PUSH
GA
ALTS
50 00 STD
30 4
6 00
1 2
140
20
5 00 1
40 REFS
11 8 2 10 #14 20
7 1R 00
1
100
3 00 2 MENU SET
80
100 10 4 PU S H
2 00 MENU
23 HDG 30.12
013 013 ADV
NAV / BRG
VOR1 N 3
CRS 009
9.1 NM 33
6
RADAR
30
FORMAT >
GCS
W
12
15
VOR1
21 S
Collins
Figure 16-38. Primary Flight Display (PFD) or Adaptive Flight Display (AFD)
The ARC and FMS MAP displays 125° of PFD (MFD failure) or REV TO MFD (PFD
ARC. The space at the right or left of the HSI failure). The reverted selection formats the
displays LSK data, lateral navigation data selected PFD or MFD, and the optional copi-
field (upper left of HSI), weather radar mode lot MFD (if installed) to the compressed for-
field (at right), PRESET (at left), system mes- mat displaying the following:
sages, and selected menus. Normal warning
and control annunciations are also displayed. 1. Engine data (top)
2. ADI (middle)
If the MFD or PFD goes blank, a switch (Figure
16-39) on the lower pilot instrument panel 3. HSI (bottom)
may be selected out of NORM to REV TO
Radar Menu
The RADAR button on the DCP is used to
select the RADAR menu on the PFD. When the
radar menu is active, PFD line-select keys are
used to set the active radar mode. In the
optional second PFD configuration, each pilot
display is controlled by the on-side DCP/PFD.
When V T , which has a variable minimum (i.e., To set the takeoff speed data on the pilot TOLD
ISS LSC), is set to the current minimum value, card, first, press the REFS button to display
it will be increased automatically if the asso- REFS 1/2 page (Figure 16-41, Sheet 1).
ciated variable increases.
Collins
BARO
PUSH
------ STD
80 20 4
5 00
2
60
10
4 00 1
40 REFS
--- #13 20
00
1
10
2 00 2 MENU SET
4 PU S H
0 20 1 00 MENU
29.92
HDG 193 S 193 21
ADV
NAV / BRG
VOR1
CRS 177 15 24
9.1 NM
RADAR
REFS 1/2 REFS 1/2
50
< VT
149 GCS
25
< V2
110
TILT RANGE
< VR N1 REF >
108 95.9
VOR1
< V1 ADF2 RETURN >
108
Collins
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 1 of 14)
To set V 1 (Figure 16-41, Sheet 2), either push is set in larger blue numbers and confirm
the LSK or press the PUSH MENU ADV but- above that V 1 115 appears in the bottom of the
ton and cursor over V 1 , then spin the MENU airspeed scale.
SET knob and set the speed. Check the speed
Collins
BARO
PUSH
------ STD
80 20 4
5 00
2
60
10
4 00 1
60 REFS
40
--- #13 20
00
1
10
2 00 2 MENU SET
V1 115 4 PU S H
0 20 1 00 MENU
29.92
HDG 193 S 193 21
ADV
NAV / BRG
VOR1
CRS 177 15 24
9.1 NM
RADAR
REFS 1/2 REFS 1/2
50
< VT
149 GCS
25
< V2
115
TILT RANGE
< VR N1 REF <
115 95.9
VOR1
< V1 ADF2 RETURN <
115
Collins
SET V1
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 2 of 14)
To set VR (Figure 16-41, Sheet 3), there are two speed. Confirm that the tick mark is activated
ways to advance the cursor to V R : (1) PUSH by the larger, blue numbers under V R and that
MENU ADV (2) Press LSK (L3); then spin V R appears in the lower airspeed scale.
the MENU SET knob, setting and verifying the
Collins
BARO
PUSH
------ STD
80 20 4
5 00
2
60
10
4 00 1
60 REFS
40
--- #13 20
00
1
10
2 00 2 MENU SET
VR 115
V1 115 4 PU S H
0 20 1 00 MENU
29.92
HDG 193 S 193 21
ADV
NAV / BRG
VOR1
CRS 177 15 24
9.1 NM
RADAR
REFS 1/2 REFS 1/2
50
< VT
149 GCS
25
< V2
115
TILT RANGE
< VR N1 REF >
115 95.9
VOR1
< V1 ADF2 RETURN >
115
Collins
SET VR
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 3 of 14)
Collins
BARO
PUSH
------ STD
80 20 4
5 00
2
60
10
4 00 1
60 REFS
40
--- #13 20
00
1
V2 118 10
2 00 2 MENU SET
VR 115
V1 115 4 PU S H
0 20 1 00 MENU
29.92
HDG 193 S 193 21
ADV
NAV / BRG
VOR1
CRS 177 15 24
9.1 NM
RADAR
REFS 1/2 REFS 1/2
50
< VT
149 GCS
25
< V2
118
TILT RANGE
< VR N1 REF >
115 95.9
VOR1
< V1 ADF2 RETURN >
115
Collins
SET V2
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 4 of 14)
Collins
BARO
PUSH
------ STD
80 20 4
5 00
2
60
10
4 00 1
60 REFS
40
--- #13 20
00
VT 149 1
V2 118 10
2 00 2 MENU SET
VR 115
V1 115 4 PU S H
0 20 1 00 MENU
29.92
HDG 193 S 193 21
ADV
NAV / BRG
VOR1
CRS 177 15 24
9.1 NM
RADAR
REFS 1/2 REFS 1/2
50
< VT
149 GCS
25
< V2
115
TILT RANGE
< VR N1 REF >
118 95.9
VOR1
< V1 ADF2 RETURN >
115
Collins
SET VT
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 5 of 14)
Collins
BARO
PUSH
------ STD
80 20 4
5 00
2
60
10
4 00 1
60 REFS
40
--- #13 20
00
VT 149 1
V2 118 10
2 00 2 MENU SET
VR 115
V1 115 4 PU S H
0 20 1 00 MENU
29.92
HDG 193 S 193 21
ADV
NAV / BRG
VOR1
CRS 177 15 24
9.1 NM
RADAR
REFS 1/2 REFS 1/2
50
< VT
149 GCS
25
< V2
118
TILT RANGE
< VR N1 REF >
115 95.9
VOR1
< V1 ADF2 RETURN >
115
Collins
SET N1
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 6 of 14)
Verify that the N 1 blue bugs appear at 95.9%, V-speeds must be cursored over and deacti-
with blue 95.9 in a white box (Figure 16-41, vated to small white numbers to unclutter the
Sheet 7). If the takeoff and departure are nor- vertical airspeed scale. The landing speeds, if
mal, this data will unclutter above 200 KIAS. preset (small white letters), must be cursored
If a circuit and landing must be made, N 1 REF over the large blue numbers to get the tick
is ready for the landing phase. However, the marks on the moving airspeed scale.
N1 %
95.9
100
90
70
50
30
20.5 21.8
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 7 of 14)
Collins
BARO
PUSH
HDG ALT
50 00 STD
2 00 4
280
20 2
1 00
260 1 REFS
10 20
250 #50 00
80
240 1
MENU SET
49 00
10 2
220 PU S H
GS
8 00 4 MENU
ADV
29.92
HDG 060 060 NAV / BRG
MIN 200 RA
LOC1 6
CRS 013 3 E
RADAR
10.2 NM
12
N
15
151 200
1700
S
119
21
V RF W N1 REF
24
112 95.9
LOC1
ADF 2 RETURN
Collins
BRT
DIM
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 8 of 14)
To set V RF , press the LSK (L3) to box V RF 16-41, Sheet 9). The tick marks are off scale
speed and turn the MENU SET knob to set the here, until the aircraft slows sufficiently to
desired speed in big blue numbers. To ensure see them.
that the tick marks will be displayed (Figure
Collins
BARO
PUSH
HDG ALT
50 00 STD
2 00 4
280
20 2
1 00
260 1
10 20
REFS
250 #50 00
80
240 1
49 00 MENU SET
10 2
220 GS PU S H
8 00 4 MENU
ADV
29.92
HDG 060 060 NAV / BRG
MIN 200 RA
LOC1 6
CRS 013 3 E
RADAR
10.2 NM
12
N
VT RA GCS
33
15
151 200
1700
S
119
21
V RF W N1 REF
24
108 95.9
LOC1
ADF 2 RETURN
Collins
BRT
DIM
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 9 of 14)
Collins
BARO
PUSH
HDG ALT
50 00 STD
2 00 4
280
20 2
1 00
260 1 REFS
10 20
250 50 00
80
240 1
MENU SET
49 00
10 2
220 PU S H
GS
8 00 4 MENU
ADV
29.92
HDG 060 060 NAV / BRG
MIN 200 RA
LOC1 6
CRS 013 3 E
RADAR
10.2 NM
12
N
15
151 200
1700
S
115
21
V RF W N1 REF
24
108 95.9
LOC1
ADF 2 RETURN
Collins
BRT
DIM
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 10 of 14)
Collins
BARO
PUSH
HDG ALT
50 00 STD
2 00 4
280
20 2
1 00
260 1 REFS
10 20
250 #50 00
80
240 1
MENU SET
49 00
10 2
220 PU S H
GS
8 00 4 MENU
ADV
29.92
HDG 060 060 NAV / BRG
MIN 200 RA
LOC1 6
CRS 013 3 E
RADAR
10.2 NM
12
N
15
147 200
1700
S
115
21
V RF W N1 REF
24
108 95.9
LOC1
ADF 2 RETURN
Collins
BRT
DIM
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 11 of 14)
Set minimums using BARO (recommended blue pointer that comes into view on the right
for all approaches, both precision and non- side of the altitude scale. This is BARO ref-
precision) (Figure 16-41, Sheet 12). Press erenced to the MSL based on a minimum al-
LSK (R2) and cursor over BARO altitude. titude of 1,700 feet. It is not radar-altitude
Enter the MSL altitude using the MENU SET based. Notice at minimums (on the left), the
knob (1,700 feet in this case). Confirm the al- blue pointer turns yellow and the yellow MIN
titude by looking under the altimeter setting box appears. BARO minimums can be set in
and observing MIN 1,700 BARO. As the air- 10-foot increments through 15,000 feet.
craft descends toward minimums, observe the
BLUE POINTER TURNS YELLOW
HERE AND MIN BOX APPEARS
Collins Collins
BARO
PUSH
1 AP ALT
17 00 17 00 STD
20 9 00 4
20 00 4
2 2
10 8 00 9 00
1 1
MIN REFS
20 40
#17 00 #18 20
00
1 1
MENU SET
6 00 2
7 00 2
PU S H
1630 4 4 MENU
ADV
12
RA RA GCS
15
15
200 200
1700 1700
21 21
N1 REF N1 REF
24
95.9 95.9
RETURN RETURN
Collins
BRT BRT
DIM DIM
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 12 of 14)
Another way to set minimums for a precision approaches. To the left, observe the different
approach is to press the RA LSK (R1) and appearance of minimums when using RA to set
cursor over RA altitude and set the altitude minimums. A blue box at the left of the alti-
with the MENU SET knob (Figure 16-41, tude scale appears. As the aircraft passes below
Sheet 13). Confirm that minimums are cor- minimums, the blue box turns yellow and the
rectly set by observing under the altimeter MIN box appears yellow. Brown ground ref-
setting MIN 200 RA. This is a radar altimeter erence appears below 225 AGL. RA mini-
based on minimum altitude. Because all ap- mums can be set in one-foot increments
proaches use baro for minimums, our counsel through 999 feet.
i s t o u s e t h e BA RO m e t h o d f o r a l l
Collins Collins
BARO
PUSH
1 GS
3000 50 00 STD
20 2 00 4
9 00 4
2 2
10 1 00
8 00 1 1
MIN 20 REFS
40
15 20 50 00
00 80
1 1
10 49 00
4 00 2 2
MENU SET
4 PU S H
200 20 4 8 00 MENU
800 ADV
29.92 29.92
013
MIN 200 RA MIN 200 RA NAV / BRG
N 3 E
RADAR
6
12
REFS 2/2
E
FORMAT RA GCS
15
200
12
LX/RDR BARO
TILT RANGE
S
1700
15
21
2 S N1 REF
95.9
RETURN
Collins
BRT BRT
DIM DIM
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 13 of 14)
BARO
PUSH
HDG ALT
50 00 STD
2 00 4
280
20 2
1 00
260 1 REFS
10 20
250 50 00
80
240 1
MENU SET
49 00
10 2
220 PU S H
GS
8 00 4 MENU
ADV
29.92
HDG 060 060 NAV / BRG
MIN 200 RA
LOC1 6
CRS 013 3 E
RADAR
10.2 NM
12
N
15
147 200
1700
S
115
21
V RF W N1 REF
24
108 95.9
LOC1
ADF 2 RETURN
Collins
BRT
DIM
Figure 16-41. REFS Menu—Setting Takeoff and Landing V-Speeds (Sheet 14 of 14)
increments from 1,000 to 2,500 feet. The dig- The radio altimeter system is made up of one
ital readout is green, unless a DH alert is in view, ALT-55B receiver/transmitter (RT) and one
then the radio altitude readout is yellow. Radio RAC-870 radio altitude converter. The RT
altitude is used by the EFIS and FGS. provides analog radio altitude and FCS warn-
ing discrete to the RAC. The RAC converts the
The analog radio altitude display is a brown analog DC altitude and FCS warning discrete
scale that replaces the normal background color from the RT to digital data for use by the
of the barometric altitude scale. The brown flight control system and the electronic flight
scale comes into view at the bottom of the baro- instrument system.
metric altitude scale when the radio altitude is
approximately 225 feet. At the same time, a 0
feet tick mark is displayed in the center of the DECISION HEIGHT AND
altitude scale. As the aircraft descends, the MINIMUM DESCENT ALTITUDE
brown scale moves up to meet the 0 FT tick mark
when the radio altitude is 0 feet. Radio altitude-based decision height (DH, re-
ferred to as RADIO) alerts the pilot that the
Turn the rotary test switch to ANNUNCIATOR aircraft has descended to the selected RADIO
TEST to test the radio altimeter. When acti- decision height. RADIO DH is a function of
vated, the test provides a radio altitude read- radio altimeter altitude and all references to
out of 50 feet. A yellow RA TEST is displayed RADIO DH altitude are above ground level
adjacent to the digital radio altimeter readout, (AGL). Barometric altitude based minimum
over the normal position for the RA flag, when descent altitude (MDA, referred to as BARO)
the radio altimeter is in test. Selection of FCS alerts the pilot that the aircraft has descended
APPR mode prevents the activation of the to the selected minimum descent altitude.
radio altitude test switch. MDA is a function of barometric altitude; all
references to MDA altitude are with respect
to the pilot altimeter display. Either RADIO
Radio Altitude Flag or BARO is active on a given approach; there-
fore, the selection of one precludes the other.
A red boxed RA flag appears to the left of the
RA digital readout when radio altitude data is MIN (minimum) is displayed to the pilot if the
failed. Annunciation and box flash for five currently active height is reached. The MIN
seconds, then are steady. setting is displayed digitally below the baro-
metric altitude display. Individual RA and
GA GA
ALTS
50 00
6 00
20 5 00
40 GROUND
10 14 20 REFERENCE
100 FT (ANALOG)
3 00 225 FT
00
125 FT
100
8 00
30.12
BARO set fields on the PFD display RA (de- RA and BARO MlN are mutually exclusive.
cision height) or BARO (minimum descent Selecting either one while the other is selected
altitude) value, depending on which is active. will cause the one in view to be deselected, and
These separate analog indications are used to the MIN value to be replaced by the newly
cue the pilots that the aircraft is approaching selected reference’s value. When the box is
the RA or BARO minimum setting. When at around an RA or BARO menu readout value,
the point radio altitude is equal to, or below, pressing the adjacent line-select key will de-
the MIN readout, yellow MIN, to the right of select the associated function.
the pitch scale, is displayed, which first flashes
for five seconds, then on steady. The yellow
MIN is removed if the following occurs: BARO
When active, the BARO analog MDA is shown
• RA MlN altitude becomes greater than on the fine altitude scale. The BARO reference
50 feet above the MIN value. is a cyan triangle with a protruding extension
• Radio altitude is less then five feet AGL. line, placed on the fine altitude scale at the
BARO (MDA) altitude. At BARO MIN alert,
• MIN readout is removed. the analog BARO (MDA) reference changes
• RA MIN value is changed to a value to yellow, flashes for five seconds, then steady.
more than 50 feet lower than the current
radio altitude value. (E.g., if radio alti- RA
tude is more than 50 feet below the RA
MIN value, the yellow MIN annuncia- When active, the RA analog reference is shown
tion is never displayed.) on the left side of the barometric altitude scale.
MIN is inhibited below five feet. The RA reference is a cyan rectangle with a
dark blue background that extends up from
There are two pages of REFS menus. The RA the analog radio altitude display. The RA ref-
MIN and BARO set values are located on the erence rises toward the radio altitude’s 0-feet
REFS MENU, page 2. This page is accessed tick mark as a function of radio altitude. At RA
by one press of the DCP REFS button while MIN alert, the RA analog reference color turns
airborne, or two presses while on the ground. from cyan to yellow, flashes for five seconds,
then steady. The analog DH reference con-
A movable cyan box is shown around one of tinues to rise up the left side of the baromet-
the values on the REFS menu. The movable box ric altitude scale until radio altitude is zero.
surrounds the value that can be changed with
the MENU SET knob on the DCP. The box is MIN Readout
brought to the BARO or RA MIN value by
pressing the respective adjacent LSK. The ini- The MIN readout is the same value selected
tial value displayed is the last value set by the as active in the REFS menu. The cyan, MIN
pilot. When the box is around an inactive RA readout and MIN nomenclature are displayed
MIN or BARO value, rotating the DCP MENU part-time below the barometric altitude scale.
SET knob adjusts the selected value and selects The MIN readout is displayed when either the
the value if the value was deselected. Settable RA or BARO has a value set, and the follow-
values are initially displayed in smaller white ings constraints are met:
characters and are considered inactive. They
become larger cyan characters when they are • When at or below 2,500 feet AGL and
made the active values. RA MIN range is 0 to an RA value of other than OFF has been
999 feet in 1-foot increments. BARO MIN set, unless RA readout is off.
range is 0 to 15,000 feet in 10-foot increments. • When within 2,500 feet of the selected
MDA and a BARO value of other than
OFF has been set.
VOR1 24
CRS 190 21
W
3.4 NM S
30
15
FORMAT
33
12
PRESET LX/RDR
FMS1 STBY
T+2.0
N
E
6 3
BRT
DIM
TRAFFIC 29.92
HDG
S 193 21
VOR1
CRS 252 FORMAT
15
24
9.0NM
PRESET LX/RDR
FMS1 25 +01
–01 WX
T +O.5
12.5 TFC
–05 SAT 0 °C
ISA 0 °C
RAT 50 °C
29.92
10 HDG 013 143 5
MIN 420 RA
12
FMS1 S
DTK 142
ICNB
E
2.9NM
PT
10
FORMAT
ICNB
5
PRESET RW01R LX/RDR
1332
LOC1
VOR2
DATA
Weather radar and optional lightning displays The FORMAT line-select key (R1) on the PFD
are available for display on the FMS map will select rose, arc, rose, arc, etc. If an FMS
format. Line-select key R2 is used to select flight plan is first selected, successive dashes
weather radar and/or lightning displays. select rose, arc, FMS map, rose, arc, FMS
Normal control and warning annunciations are map, etc. If the FMS is on the FMS map, and
also displayed. the TCAS is available, successive pushes se-
lect rose, arc, FMS map, TCAS I, rose, arc,
Navigation Symbology FMS map, TCAS I, etc.
The DATA line-select key is used to select the The first three pages available on the PFD are
DATA menu. The DATA menu is used to con- also available on the MFD. The FORMAT line-
trol the selection of background navigation select key (R1) when pressed a fourth time on
symbology when the FMS map display is ac- the MFD (only) selects the FMS PLAN map
tive. The DATA menu only controls the sym- (true north up) (Figure 16-47) for planning
bols not associated with the active flight plan purposes. The PREV or NEXT line-select keys
(map symbols associated with the active flight move the flight plan waypoints (WPT) for-
plan (if any) are always displayed when the ward or backward. The NEXT LSK advances
map is displayed). The potential map menu se- the WPTs, one by one, to the end of the flight
lections, depending upon the installed FMS, plan. PREV backs each WPT through the cen-
are as follows: ter to the first WPT. The DATA LSK on this
• NAVAIDS (L3) page and the FMS map page selects the DATA
menu with NAVAIDS (L3), AIRPORTS (L4),
• AIRPORTS (L4) INTERS (R4), and ALTS (R3).
• INTERS (R4)
The FORMAT line-select key (R1) when
• ALTS (R3) ON–OFF pressed a fifth time selects the optional TAS 1
Turning on the ALTS (R3) displays the top of page if TAS 1 is turned on.
climb (TOC) or level-off point and the top of
descent (TOD) point. TOC and TOD are un- The FORMAT line-select key (R1) when
marked, white circles that appear on the FMS pressed a sixth time on the MFD (only) can dis-
great circle track show the computed climb play the FCS diagnostics format pages (Figure
level-off point or start descent point based on 16-48). The diagnostics page will only display
current climb or cruise data. Turning off ALTS if the maintenance diagnostics lever-lock
removes the circles from view. The DATA LSK switch is in the UP position. Normally, the
does not appear on the arc format page. switch is down and that prevents the diag-
nostics page from displaying. The switch is on
Pressing the adjacent line-select key alter- the lower right, forward pedestal above the
nately selects or deselects the associated menu copilot inboard rudder pedal. Though the crew
selections. Navigation symbology may be ac- has access to the switch, it is normally left in
companied by identifier data. Different FMSs its DOWN–OFF position and is only used for
provide different map symbol capabilities. maintenance purposes.
Refer to the appropriate vendor documenta-
tion for the specific symbol types that each
FMS supports.
HEADING
The PFD displays heading information imme-
diately beneath the attitude display for all nav-
TCAS I Format—Optional igation formats. Either a full compass rose or
If TCAS I is installed and tuned on, the FOR- a partial compass arc is displayed (Figure 16-
MAT line-select key on the AFD is used to se- 49), depending on the active navigation format.
lect a dedicated TCAS I page (Figure 16-46).
093
ABOVE
25
FORMAT
RDR
STBY
T +1.0
TFC
BRT
DIM
FMS1
N
DTK 204
KICT
TTG – – : – –
2.8NM
KCID
864
IOW
200
FMS1 FORMAT
FMS2 STJ
NEXT LX/R D R
PREV DIRECT
DATA
GS TAS O RAT 7 ° C SAT 7 ° C ISA –7 ° C
BRT
DIM
FCS DIAGNOSTICS
©1998 ROCKWELL COLLINS, INC.
REPORT MODE
LEFT RIGHT
R E PA I R CODE = 000000 000000
AP D I S CODE = 000000 000000
A P ENG CODE = 020400 020400
YD D I S CODE = 000000 000000
Y D ENG CODE = 020000 020000
MOVE FORMAT
CURSOR
A R R O W I N D I C AT E S F C S S O U R C E
SCROLL CHANNEL (PUSH & HOLD MOVE– NEXT
UP C U R S O R K E Y T O S WA P C H A N N E L ) MODE
SCROLL
DOWN
BRT
DIM
SELECTED
on the compass rose or compass arc. Tick HEADING
marks are provided every 5°. Heading numbers LNV1 AP ALT
170 00 TRACK
are located at 30° marks with letters at the 260
20 160 00
2
4
POINTER
cardinal points. Compass reference marks 240 10 900 1 HEADING
(compass rose only) are triangular pointers 220
20
158 00
80 BUG (BLUE)
located outside the rose, apex pointing to the 200 10 700
1
2 ACTIVE
rose, at ±45° and ±135° from the lubber line. 180
M.458
20 600 4
COURSE
White tick marks are located at 90°, 180°, and 30
HDG 340 340
29.92
TO/FROM
270° from the lubber line. FMS1
DTK 350
33 N INDICATOR
KCID 30
LATERAL
3
95.ONM
FORMAT
DEVIATION
6
PRESET RDR
E
Heading Flag The on-side FMS will be the source for the
track pointer unless the cross-side FMS is the
active navigation source. If only a single FMS
For a heading input failure, the compass rose is installed, it shall be the data source for the
or arc is rotated to north up, the lubber line and track pointer for displays on both sides. The
digital heading readouts are removed, and a track pointer is normally green. However, if
red, boxed HDG flag is displayed. the cross-side FMS is the source, the track
pointer will be yellow. Different FMSs have
Heading Bug varying requirements on when they will out-
put a valid track for display. Refer to appro-
A dual filled rectangular cyan bug is posi- priate FMS documentation.
tioned on the compass rose, arc, or FMS map.
When the bug is off scale in arc or map mode,
a heading vector (dashed line) is displayed LATERAL NAVIGATION
that originates at the compass center and ex- COURSE AND DEVIATION
tends toward the selected heading. At system
power up, selected heading value is that which The PFD displays the active lateral navigation
was previously selected. The heading bug is (NAV) course and deviation information on the
controlled by the HDG knob on the CHP. The compass rose and arc. Lateral navigation
center SYNC button on the end of the HDG course and deviation information is made up
knob causes the heading bug to be set to the of a course pointer, to/from arrow, lateral de-
current heading. viation bar, and scale.
A digital readout of the selected heading is dis- The course pointer is a single bar arrow that
played to the left of the lubber line. The read- points to the selected course. The selected
out is preceded by a HDG legend. The selected course at powerup will be the last valid value
heading readout shares a location with the before powerdown. The CRS knob on the CHP
heading comparator flag. When active, the is used to set the pilot side VOR course pointer
heading comparator flag is the priority display. (Figure 16-50). In the optional second PFD
configuration, the CRS knob on the CKP is
In the optional second PFD configuration, the used to set the copilot side VOR course pointer
APP and AP XFR (autopilot transfer) button (Figure 16-50). The associated CRS knob is
selects which heading all heading bugs move inactive for FMS as the active NAV source. The
to. The transfer status is displayed on the PFDs center DIRECT button on the CHP selects a
in the FCS mode field by the direction of the course directly to the on-side PFDs valid VOR
XFR arrow. If transferred to the pilot, the pilot station, if VOR is the active NAV source. When
heading is used. If transferred to the copilot, enabled by CDU selection and FMS is the ac-
then the copilot heading is used. tive NAV source, the CRS button is used to se-
lect a course direct to the active waypoint
(applicable only to FMSs with an OBS func-
TRACK tion). To/from indicator rotates as part of the
course pointer and is displayed when the ac-
The track pointer is positioned on the compass tive NAV source is valid VOR or valid FMS.
rose or arc at the current aircraft track over the The course pointer and to/from arrow is dis-
earth. The track pointer is an open circle. The played green for on-side source and yellow for
difference between the position of the track a cross-side source. The display is removed if
pointer and the lubber line is the drift angle. the map display is active.
Thus, the track pointer has been referred to as
a drift pointer. The lateral deviation bar moves left or right
of the course pointer on the lateral deviation
scale to indicate relative position of the course
CRS PU S H PU S H PU S H
PUSH
DIR CA SYNC
SETS COURSE ECT NCEL
DIRECT
ON COPILOT’S
PFD (IF INSTALLED)
Collins SETS PILOT PFD SETS ALTITUDE SETS HEADING BUG
AND MFD COURSE PRESELECT IN THE PFD(s) ON THE PFD AND MFD
AND COPILOT PFD
COURSE KNOB PANEL (CKP) (IF INSTALLED)
NEAR COPILOT’S PFD
COURSE HEADING PANEL (CHP)
ON LOWER PEDESTAL
NAV
2 BLUE SINGLE LINE
SOURCE
240 10 900 1
BEARING POINTER
DISPLAY (NO. 1 NAV-ADF or FMS)
20
220 158 00
80
1
COURSE/
200 10 700 WHITE SINGLE LINE
2
BEARING POINTER
DESIRED 20
TRACK
600 4 (NO. 2 NAV, ADF, or FMS)
M.458
DISPLAY 29.92
20
HDG 340 340
33 N
FMS1
OTK 350 30
KCID TO/FROM
3
BRT
DIM
Collins
BARO
USH
ROLL PITCH
P
ALTS
30 00 STD
7 00 4
220
2
10 6 00
200 1 REFS
20
189 35 00
80
180 1 MENU SET
10 4 00
2 USH
P
160 MENU
2200 3 00 4 ADV
29.92 NAV/BRG
HDG 037 193
MIN 1700 BARO
VOR1 S 21
CRS 013 RADAR
NM 15
24
BRG NAV
SOURCE SOURCE GCS
12
FMS1
VOR1 FMS2
TILT RANGE
E
30
VOR1
OFF LOC2
33
6
3 N
VOR1
Collins
RETURN
active NAV source legend is FMS. The active lection. If the desired source is an on-side
NAV source selection is displayed in medium sensor located against a currently not active
size text, color coded as on-side (magenta) or sensor pair, a single press of the adjacent line-
cross-side (yellow). Inactive source legends are select key will select the desired source. A
displayed in smaller white text. second press of the same line-select key will
toggle to the cross-side source, if installed. The
To change the active NAV source, if the desired NAV SOURCE menu is removed either by
source is the partner of a currently selected pressing the NAV/BRG pushbutton or by press-
source, a single press of the adjacent line-se- ing R-LSK4 RETURN.
lect key on the PFD will toggle the source se-
APPR LOC1 GS
LNV1 AP ALT
140
200
10 20
120 MM
AP 10
110 RF 175
100
10 150
80
140 10
300 1850
HDG 060 013 10 HDG 013 143 5
12
LOC1 N 3 FMS1 S
CRS 013 DTK 142
1.9 NM 33 ICNB
6
2.9NM
PT
30
10
E
ICNB
5
W
12
15
ADF 1
21 S
VOR2
DATA
NAV source, is displayed. Annunciation and Information displayed in the lateral navigation
box flash for five seconds, and then steady. data field is normally color coded as on-side
The scale is displayed for active NAV sources (green) or cross-side (yellow).
of LOC and FMS. When the FMS map is the
active NAV format, the scale is displayed if
the difference between aircraft heading and Distance Flag
FMS desired track is less than 105°. The distance display is four dashes, and NM
nomenclature is shown, it is the same color as
the active NAV source if the distance infor-
Lateral Navigation Data Field mation is not received.
The lateral navigation data field is located to
the left of the selected navigation format on
the PFD. The lateral navigation data field dis- LNAV Alert
plays the following information: If the active NAV source is FMS and a lateral
navigation alert occurs, the waypoint identi-
• Active NAV source (e.g., VOR1) fication field and the distance display flash.
• Course/desired track readout (e.g., CRS
351)
FMS MAG VAR Fail
• FMS waypoint identification (e.g., CID)
The active NAV source flashes for 15 sec-
• Distance (e.g., 5.9 nm) onds, then returns to normal, if MAG or DG
The identifying nomenclature in front of the heading is selected when the active NAV
course/desired track readout is as follows: source is FMS, and the magnetic variation
normally supplied by the FMS is unavailable
• CRS for VOR due to a failure.
• DTK for FMS desired track
NAV Flag
• HDG for FMS with heading leg active
(only with compatible FMS) The active NAV source legend VOR1, VOR2,
LOC1, LOC2, FMS1, or FMS2 is displayed in
• OBS for FMS with OBS mode active red and surrounded by a red box if the asso-
(only with compatible FMS) ciated data is failed. For VOR, the NAV source
The FMS provides the waypoint ID when FMS legend does not change, but the lateral devi-
is the active NAV source. Standard CJ2s come ation bar and to/from indicators are removed.
equipped with AlliedSignal DME. Allied-
Signal DME does not provide station ID; there-
fore, no station ID is available when VOR or
ILS VERTICAL DEVIATION
LOC is the active NAV source. The vertical deviation scale is displayed be-
tween the attitude ball and the altitude scale
The distance display provides distance infor- on the AFD. The scale comes into view when
mation in nautical miles (nm) to the pilot. a LOC is the active NAV source. The GS (glide
Distance is associated with the active NAV slope) deviation pointer is diamond shaped,
source, thus providing distance to the next and the color follows the active NAV source
waypoint for FMS, distance to the VOR/DME color. The vertical deviation scale and GS
(or VORTAC) station for VOR, and distance pointer are removed from view when a LOC
to the runway for LOC. Distance readout is dis- is no longer the active NAV source.
played followed by NM nomenclature. Range
is 0 to 4,999 nm for FMS. If the distance is
greater than 9,999 nm when FMS sourced, the
readout is replaced with four dashes.
29.92
HDG 037 193
MIN 1700 BARO
VOR1 S 21
CRS 013
NM 15
24
BRG NAV
SOURCE SOURCE
12
W
FMS1
VOR1 FMS2
30
VOR1
OFF LOC2
33
6
3 N
VOR1
RETURN
VOR1
CRS 177
15
9.1 NM 24
V2
110
VR N1 REF
108 95.9
VOR1
V1 RETURN
ADF 2
108
29.92
HDG 037 037
FMS1 3 6
DTK 037
KCID N
361 NM
E
33
FORMAT
12
PRESET 30
15
LX/RDR
VOR1 W
S
FMS1 24 21
29.92
HDG 193 193
MIN 1700 BARO
VOR2 S 21
CRS 013
15
24
12
FORMAT
E
30
PRESET LX/RDR
VOR1
33
6
3 N
VOR2
The bezel-mounted line-select keys on the MFD, Line-select keys on the MFD are used to se-
in conjunction with the DCP and CHP, provide lect the MFD navigation format, the weather
the primary pilot interface with the MFD. radar and optional lightning overlays, the FMS
map source, the FMS map background sym-
The FORMAT line-select key is used to select bology, and the FMS plan map center. Active
the current MFD format. A right-facing carat line-select keys are indicated by a side-facing
points at R1 to indicate that the line-select carat (< or >).
key can change the current format. Repeated
presses of the FORMAT LSK will cycle AFD line-select keys have been arbitrarily num-
through the available formats in the order bered to facilitate explanation. L1 (top left)
shown as follows: through L4 (bottom left) are on the left side of
the display, and R1 (top right) through R4 (bot-
tom right) are on the right side of the display.
Note 1: Top left field priority, from highest to lowest, is DR, INT, and APP
Note 2: Bottom left field priority, from highest to lowest, is DEV CHG and SX
Note 3: The bottom right field priority, from highest to lowest, is HDG and OBS.
If the bottom left field is DEV CHG, the bottom right field is blanked.
Note 4: All messages that blink do so for 5 seconds, then remain steady
Collins
KTVK
I-D
50 KOXV
FMS1 FORMAT
FMS2
25 KPEA
KTNU
KDTM LX/RDR
OTM KOBA
WX
T+2.0
KGGI
KFFL
DATA
GS 400 TAS 360 RAT –34 °C SAT –39 °C ISA 0 °C
BRT
DIM
FMS1 FORMAT
FMS2
2.5
KICT
LX/RDR
STBY
USTB
VOR1
DATA
GS O TAS O RAT 7 ° C SAT 7 ° C ISA –6 ° C
BRT
DIM
PREV/NEXT LSK (L2 and L3) If the waypoint currently used as plan map
center is modified/deleted, the plan map cen-
The PREV and NEXT legends are displayed ter defaults back to the TO waypoint. When the
adjacent to L2 and L3 respectively when the plan map is selected, if there is no valid TO
FMS plan map is the active MFD format waypoint, PREV/NEXT are not displayed.
(Figure 16-57). In the FMS plan map format,
the active FMS flight plan is displayed cen-
tered about a position or waypoint.
ENGINE INDICATION
The TO waypoint is initially used as the plan
map center. If there is no valid TO waypoint,
SYSTEM (EIS)
the present position is used for plan map cen- The EIS (engine indication system) serves as
ter. Repeatedly pressing L2 when NEXT is an interface between the Collins avionic sys-
displayed will advance through each way- tem and the Williams engine. The primary
point, one at a time, until the end of the cur- function is acquisition, concentration, data
rent flight plan is reached. Repeatedly pressing transmittal, and display on the upper half of
L3 when PREV is displayed will descend the MFD. The MFD presents full-time dis-
through each waypoint until the first waypoint plays of N 1 and N 1 reference (bug), ITT (in-
being transmitted by the FMS is displayed. terstage turbine temperature), N 2, oil pressure,
FMS1
N
DTK 204
KICT
TTG – – : – –
2.8NM
KCID
864
IOW
200
FMS1 FORMAT
FMS2 STJ
NEXT LX/RDR
PREV DIRECT
DATA
GS TAS O RAT 7 ° C SAT 7 ° C ISA –7 ° C
BRT
DIM
and oil temperature (Figure 16-58 and 16-59). quired in the Citation CJ2. The left DCU and
Fuel quantity analog data is changed to digi- EDC are grouped together and located on the
tal data in the fuel signal conditioner and sent left side of the fuselage, below and to the rear
to the MFD. Abnormal alerts and warnings of the left engine.
are also provided.
The DCUs crosstalk to each other and do not
The MFD first looks for left engine data from allow propagation of an electrical fault from
the left DCU (on-side data concentrator unit). one channel to the other.
If the left engine data is not available from the
on-side DCU, the MFD looks to the cross- Each DCU adds 9 pph to the fuel flow input
side DCU. The DCUs read all data from both for each engine to account for the unmetered
engines. The EDC (engine data concentrator) start nozzle fuel flow.
provides a third path for N 1 , ITT, and N 2 dis-
play to the MFD, if the on-side and cross-side
DCUs fail. A DCU and EDC are the same unit N1 (TURBINE SPEED)
but perform a different function in the re- The turbine speed (N 1 ) gage indicates engine
spective positions by IAPS strapping. The fan rpm. N 1 is measured against a fixed 100%
DCUs also provide other miscellaneous in- value (expressed in percent). The N 1 displays
terfaces with the aircraft. Four DCUs are re- consist of an analog and digital display for
OIL OIL
ITT PRESSURE TEMPERATURE
START POINTERS POINTERS
UNIT BUGS
N2 OIL
IGNITORS ITT READOUTS N2 TEMPERATURE
N1 LEGEND LEGEND DIGITAL LEGEND LEGEND
N1 REF FUEL
DIGITAL OIL QUANTITY
PRESSURE LEGEND
N1 SCALE LEGEND
FUEL
N1 REF QUANTITY
BUGS
N1 % ITT °C 91.0 N2 91.5 FUEL QTY UNITS
100.1 1000 % LBS
I I 2000
900 OIL °C
100 G G OIL PSI
1500
N 800 N FUEL
90 QUANTITY
70 1000 SCALE
700
50
32 32 130 130
500 FUEL
600 °C
–2 –2 QUANTITY
30
N1 400 FUEL POINTERS
POINTERS 93.2 94.9 200 1050 PPH 1050 840 800
OIL
TEMPERATURE FUEL
FUEL DIGITAL QUANTITY
ITT FLOW DIGITAL
N1 FUEL
SCALE LEGEND FUEL
DIGITAL OIL FLOW
ITT FUEL TEMPERATURE
PRESSURE DIGITAL
POINTERS FLOW UNITS
DIGITAL UNITS
each engine. Scale range is 0 to 120% with tial powerup value for N 1 on the ground is
tick marks at 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 95, 100, 95.9. After initial powerup, the N 1 value is the
and 105%. There is a larger red N 1 redline last set value. When powered up in the air, the
mark with leading edge at 105.3%. Scaling is N 1 REF value is the last selected value.
linear between 20% and 90% and between 90%
and 110%. A scale change occurs at 90%. The The N 1 REF value is set by the pilot using the
N1 digital display is a boxed readout with a dec- REFS menu. When the REFS menu is selected,
imal point between the third and fourth digits. if the box is not around the N 1 REFS value,
pressing the line-select key adjacent to the N 1
The normal limit for N 1 is 105.2%. The N 1 REF legend (R3) will bring the box around the
pointer is white and the digital readout is green N 1 REF value. The N 1 REFS value is initially
when N 1 is equal to or less than 105.2%. The displayed in smaller white characters and is
N 1 scale pointer and the digital readout both considered inactive. It becomes larger cyan
remain white if N 1 reads equal to or less than characters when it is made the active value.
105.2% for less than 20 seconds. If N 1 be- When the box is around the N 1 REF value, that
comes equal to or greater than 106.5%, or if N 1 value is set using the DCP MENU SET rotary
remains 105.3 for 20 seconds, it becomes red. knob. N 1 REF readout range is 70.0% to N 1
The N 1 pointer and digital readout flashes for normal limit % value. The N 1 value is syn-
five seconds, then steady, when N 1 first turns chronized so that when either pilot changes his
red. The N 1 pointer and digital readout stops on-side controls, the N 1 REF value on all dis-
flashing when N 1 is no longer red. plays is set to the same value. N 1 REF is au-
tomatically removed from the display when
airspeed first goes above 200 knots.
N1 REF
The N 1 REF consists of a single digital N 1 REF N1 Flag
readout (blue)and individual N 1 REF bug
(blue) on each N 1 scale. Initially, no N 1 REF The N 1 pointer is removed if no EDC and DCU
value is displayed. The N 1 displays appear on N 1 data is available. Four yellow dashes and
the MFD when either pilot selects any N 1 REF a decimal point are displayed for the digital
value other than the powerup value. The ini- readout if all sources of N1 are failed.
Automatic source selection between data The ITT transient limit is 806°C to 820°C (cau-
sources is provided. L DCU is priority source tion range) for less than five minutes. A five-
for the left engine. R DCU is the priority minute timer is started when ITT reaches 806°C.
source for the right engine. Cross-side DCU If ITT is within the caution range for less than
is the secondary source. EDC is the third pri- five minutes, the ITT pointer is yellow. If ITT
ority source. N 1 REF is automatically removed remains between 806°C and 820°C for five
from the display when either engine N 1 mis- minutes or longer, or exceeds 822°C, the ITT
compare is present. pointer becomes red. The timer is reset each
time ITT returns to the normal limit of 806°C.
INTERSTATE TURBINE The ITT pointer flashes for five seconds, then
TEMPERATURE (ITT)— remains steady, when it first turns yellow or
ENGINE START red. The ITT pointer stops flashing when ITT
is no longer yellow or red.
During engine starts, advancing the throttle to
idle turns on the 1,002°C red ITT start limit
triangle. The ITT pointer is white when equal ITT Flag
to or less than 1,000°C, and red when greater The ITT pointer is removed and a yellow FAIL
than or equal to 1,002°C and 1,050°C. legend is written vertically outside of the as-
sociated ITT scale if ITT from all sources is
NOTE failed. Automatic source selection between
data sources is provided. L DCU is priority
ITT normal limit and transient limit source for the left engine. R DCU is priority
do not apply while ITT start limit source for the right engine. Cross-side DCU
mark is in view but become active is the secondary source. EDC is the third pri-
when ITT start limit mark is removed. ority source.
The start limit mark is removed when
the throttle is selected to OFF or
when out of the starting sequence. N2
N 2 is a standardized digital display of engine
ITT—ENGINE RUN turbine rpm measured against a fixed 100%
value. The N 2 displays consist of digital read-
The display of ITT consists of an analog scale outs for each engine. Display range is 0 to
and pointer for each engine. The ITT pointer 120%. The normal limit for N 2 is 98.8%. N 2
only shows when ITT is above 100°C. is always green when equal to or less than
98.8%, and red when equal to or greater than
Scale range is 100° to 1,050°C, with tick marks 98.9%. Readout flashes for five seconds, then
at 200, 400, 600, 650, 700, 750, 800, 850, 900, steady, when N 2 first turns red. The N 2 read-
950, 1,000, and 1,050°C. Four linear scale por- out stops flashing, if applicable, when N 2 is
tions exist, with scaling change above 600°C, no longer red. Four yellow dashes and a dec-
800°C, and changing again above 900°C. imal point are displayed if all sources of N 2
are failed. L DCU is the priority source for the
ITT normal limit is 804°C. The ITT pointer is left engine. R DCU is the priority source for
white when ITT is less than or equal to 804°C. the right engine. Cross-side DCU is the sec-
ITT caution yellow range is 806° to 820°C. ITT ondary source. EDC is the third priority source.
takeoff red line limit is 822°C. Automatic source selection between data
sources is provided.
will change to yellow but digits will selection between data sources is provided. L
not be displayed until 4 minutes have DCU is the priority source for the left engine.
elapsed, at which time both yellow R DCU is the priority source for the right en-
digits and pointer will flash for 5 gine. Cross-side DCU is the secondary source.
seconds, then remain steady. Three yellow dashes are displayed if oil tem-
perature from all sources is failed.
Digital readout is displayed only
when pressure is outside normal FUEL FLOW
operating limits.
Fuel flow is normally in pounds per hour (pph).
Optional kilograms per hour (kph) may be dis-
OIL TEMPERATURE played. The fuel flow displays consist of dig-
ital readouts for each engine. A white fuel flow
The oil temperature display consists of an legend is displayed between the left and right
analog and part-time digital display for each digital readouts. The CJ2 legend is FUEL PPH,
engine. The oil temperature scale is a simple display range is 0 to 1,050 pph (0 to 1,000
wide line with linear scaling from 0°C to kph). Fuel flow values are displayed in green.
140°C. The scale is yellow below 9°C, green
from 9°C to 135°C, and red equal to or greater The displayed fuel flow values include 9
than 136°C. pounds/hour for unmetered start nozzle fuel
flow. The fuel flow signal must be valid. Four
Digital readout oil temperature is only dis- yellow dashes are displayed if fuel flow from
played when the oil temperature pointer is yel- all sources is failed. Automatic source selec-
low or red and is the same color as the pointer. tion between DCUs is provided. L DCU is the
Readout flashes for five seconds, then steady, priority source for the left engine. R DCU is
when yellow or red is first displayed. The oil the priority source for the right engine. Cross-
temperature readout is removed when oil tem- side DCU is the secondary source.
perature is no longer yellow or red. A minus
sign (–) is displayed for negative values.
FUEL QUANTITY
The oil temperature normal upper limit is
135°C and the oil temperature normal lower The fuel quantity display (FUEL QTY LBS)
limit is 10°C. The oil temperature pointer is consists of an analog and digital display for
green and the digital readout is not displayed the fuel in each wing tank. Fuel quantity is nor-
when equal to or less than 135°C and greater mally in pounds (lbs). The scale range is from
than 9°C. The oil temperature pointer turns red 0 to 2,200 pounds, with large tick marks at 500,
and the digital readout is displayed when 1,000, 1,500, and 2,000 pounds. Smaller tick
greater than or equal to 136°C. The oil tem- marks indicate 100-pound increments up to
perature pointer turns yellow and the digital 2,000 pounds. The fuel quantity scale pointer
readout is displayed when less than or equal is always white.
to 9°C.
The fuel quantity digital readout is displayed
below the associated analog scale. The fuel
Oil Temperature Flag quantity digital readout has the same source
of data as the fuel quantity analog pointer.
The oil temperature pointer flashes for five sec-
The CJ2 readout range is from 0 to a maximum
onds, then remains steady, when oil tempera-
of 2,200 pounds. The boxed fuel quantity read-
ture first turns yellow or red. The oil
out is green.
temperature pointer stops flashing if applica-
ble when oil temperature is no longer yellow
Fuel quantity pointer is removed if no DCU
or red. Oil temperature pointer is removed if
data is available. Four yellow dashes are dis-
no DCU data is available. Automatic source
played for the fuel quantity digital readout if
AlliedSignal KLN-900, Universal UNS1K, PREV is displayed will back the center of the
AlliedSignal GNS-X LS , AlliedSignal KLN- map through each waypoint to the first way-
90B, and Garmin equipment are available for point. If the waypoint currently used as plan
FMS installation of single or dual FMS. The map center is modified/deleted, the plan map
appropriate manual must be consulted to center defaults back to the TO waypoint.
determine how FMS functions are controlled
and/or accessed. The FMS symbols allowed are identical to
those allowed on the FMS present position
If there is no valid TO waypoint, the present map. The operation of the DATA line-select
position is used for plan map center (Figure 16- key (L4) is the same as on the FMS present po-
61). When the plan map is selected, L2 is the sition map.
map center advance key, and L3 is the previ-
ous map center key, except if there is no valid If the aircraft present position is within dis-
TO waypoint, the NEXT/PREV legends are play range, an aircraft symbol is displayed
not displayed. Repeatedly pressing L2 when the on the FMS plan map in correct relationship
NEXT is displayed will advance the center of to the flight plan and oriented according to
the map through each waypoint, to the end of its heading.
the flight plan. Repeatedly pressing L3 when
FMS1
N
DTK 204
KICT
TTG – – : – –
2.8NM
KCID
864
IOW
200
FMS1
FMS2 STJ
NEXT
PREV DIRECT
DATA
GS TAS O RAT 7 ° C SAT 7 ° C
The selection of the FMS plan map back- At system powerup, the MFD format and map
ground symbology is identical to that de- source selections that were last selected prior
scribed for the FMS present position map. to powerdown will be recalled.
MAP
Collins
220 2 PU S H
MENU
3 00
2200 20 4 ADV
VOR1 S 21
CRS 013 RADAR
– – – – NM 15
24
BRG NAV
SOURCE SOURCE GCS
12
<
FMS1 >
VOR1
FMS2
TILT RANGE
E
30
<
OFF
VOR1 >
6
LOC2
33
3 N NAV / BRG
VOR1
Collins
RETURN >
Figure 16-65. PFD NAV/BRG Source Selection using DCP and PFD LSKs
Collins
FCS MODE
MESSAGES
LNV1 AP ALT
170 00
COMMAND 20 160 00 4
BARS 2
240
10 9 00
1
20
1
220 158 00
9 80
1
200 10 7 00
2
20 6 00 4
M.458
340 29.92
20
HDG 33 340 N
FMS1
DTK 350 30
KCID 3
95.0NM
200
FORMAT >
100
< PRESET RDR >
VOR1 WX G+3
T+10.7A
VOR1
FMS1
LATERAL MODES
NOTE:
# May be 1 or 2 (1 = Pilot side and 2 = Copilot side).
NOTE:
For VS mode, NNNN is the VS value (e.g., 3000), the arrow indicates direction. For LVL CHG mode, NNNN
is the airspeed value (e.g., 250 or M.70).
COLOR DESCRIPTION
Collins
causes the new mode to latch if all conditions the APP roll knob is rotated (except after lat-
for the mode are satisfied. An integral yellow eral APPR capture has occurred). When active,
lamp in the mode select button illuminates if roll hold generates commands to hold the roll
the selected FGC mode has latched. The FCS reference, unless the roll reference is 5° or less,
defaults to the basic lateral and vertical flight in which case, roll hold generates commands
guidance modes when no modes are selected to hold the heading reference.
by the MSP.
The roll reference may be set to any roll angle
The optional second PFD configuration in- up to 32°. The roll knob on the APP is used to
cludes a copilot side MSP. In dual-MSP in- adjust the roll reference. The roll reference is
stallations, pilot-side and copilot-side modes set to the current roll angle upon the occurrence
are synched. Selecting a lateral or vertical of any of the following:
mode on the copilot MSP selects that mode on
the pilot-side MSP. • Selection of roll mode
• Selection of the SYNC button
NOTE • Autopilot engagement
Except for overspeed mode, turning
off the flight directors and disen- Roll hold is cleared upon selection of another
gaging the autopilot cancels the ac- lateral mode.
tive mode.
Pitch Mode
Roll Hold Mode Pitch mode is the basic vertical operating
mode. Pitch mode is active when no other ver-
Roll hold is the basic lateral operating mode tical mode is active. Pitch mode generates
(Figure 16-70). Roll hold is active when no commands to hold the pitch reference.
other lateral mode is active. Roll hold has no
mode select button. Roll hold is automatically The pitch reference is manually adjusted by ro-
selected when the autopilot is engaged and tating the pitch wheel on the APP. The pitch ref-
erence is synchronized to the current pitch angle
PITCH upon the occurrence of any of the following:
ROLL
ALTS
• Selection of pitch mode
• SYNC button selection (manually fly
20 the aircraft to establish a new pitch at-
titude and then push the SYNC button)
Figure 16-70. Roll Hold Mode
• Autopilot engagement
Pitch mode is automatically deselected upon Navigation mode is armed upon selection if a
manual selection or automatic capture of an- valid NAV source is selected. The NAV source
other vertical mode. is determined by the NAV/BRG menu on the
PFD. The course knob on the CHP is used to
select the course, or CKP for the optional
Altitude Select Mode (ALTS) copilot PFD. Prior to capture, the navigation
Altitude select mode is armed whenever a mode operates in the active lateral mode that
flight director is active or the autopilot is en- existed at the time of NAV mode selection.
gaged. Selection of any vertical mode other NAV indicator lights illuminate if the NAV
than glide-slope track or altitude hold mode mode is active. At capture, the navigation
also arms altitude select mode. When armed, mode generates commands to capture and
altitude select mode monitors aircraft clo- track the selected course.
sure rate toward the selected altitude and de-
termines the optimum capture point. During Dead-reckoning operation is provided during
capture, altitude select mode generates com- VOR station passage. Selecting a new navi-
mands to capture the selected altitude. gation source clears navigation capture and au-
Selection of a new preselect altitude or op- tomatically selects heading hold.
eration of the APP pitch wheel during altitude
select capture clears altitude select capture,
selects pitch hold, and rearms altitude select
Approach Mode
mode. After capture, altitude hold mode gen- (Lateral And Vertical)
erates commands to hold the selected alti- The APPR button on the MSP
tudes. It preselects altitudes of 0 to 55,000 feet is used to select approach
from vertical rates of ±12,000 feet/minute. APPR
m o d e ( p u s h o n / p u s h o ff ) .
Lateral approach mode arms
Heading Select Mode upon selection if a valid NAV source is se-
lected. The NAV source is determined by the
The HDG button on the MSP is NAV/BRG menu on the PFD. The CRS knob
used to select heading select on the CHP is used to select the course.
HDG
mode (push-on/push-off).
Heading select mode generates Approach mode is capable of performing
commands to capture and track the heading ref- course captures from intercepts, which differ
erence. The heading reference is adjusted with from the selected course by up to 90°. When
the HDG knob on the CHP. armed, lateral approach mode monitors aircraft
closure rate toward the selected course and cal-
The roll limit is 27° in heading select mode. culates the optimum capture point while con-
Heading select mode is cleared upon capture tinuing to operate in the currently active lateral
of another lateral mode. The HDG indicator mode. Lateral capture occurs when the course
light illuminates if HDG mode is active. deviation is less than .6 dot (LOC) or less than
.1 dot (VOR). After lateral capture, approach
mode generates commands to track the se-
Navigation Mode lected course.
The NAV button on the MSP
is used to select navigation
NAV
mode (push-on/push-off).
Navigation mode generates
commands to capture and track guidance for
enroute navigation and nonprecision ap-
proaches. Enroute guidance may be from a
VOR or FMS. Approach guidance may be from
a VOR or localizer.
The FCS speed bug is displayed on the air- ROLL and PTCH Basic
speed scale, the speed bug icon and a digital
readout are displayed above the airspeed scale, If there is no current mode selected on the
a miniature speed bug icon, and the current MSP, ROLL, and PTCH basic automatically ap-
value (IAS or Mach) are also displayed in the pears in the MSP window above the ADI when
FCS mode field when commanded by the the AP is engaged or if the FD MSP button is
flight control system. The speed bug auto- pressed (Figure 16-72). The roll knob is only
matically changes from IAS to Mach when active when the AP is engaged. The APP pitch
climbing through 30,810 feet of altitude, and wheel is active with or without the AP coupled
changes from Mach to IAS when descending in the basic PTCH mode to set desired pitch at-
through 30,410 feet of altitude. The SPD CHG titude. The pitch wheel snaps back to neutral.
pushbutton on the mode select panel alterna- The roll knob stays where it is released and does
tively selects either IAS or Mach. The SPD not snap back to neutral.
CHG button on the MSP is only functional
when the speed bug is in view and overspeed
mode is not active. When IAS is active, the ROLL PTCH
icon and up to three-digit display is shown,
with leading zeroes suppressed. When Mach
is active, then the icon, letter M, and a two- 20
digit display of the Mach value, with leading
decimal point and leading tenths and hun-
dredths zeroes, if required, is shown. There 10
is no indicator light in this button.
20
HDG HDG
10
HDG 037 037
3
6
10 N
Figure 16-75. After Takeoff, HDG
Control and Display
0 20
Flight Level Change (FLC)
HDG 013 013 Airspeed Mode
Figure 16-73. Takeoff Modes 1. Preselect the new higher altitude to
climb (Figure 16-76).
fails at or just prior to lift-off, the rudder must 2. Press FLC.
be controlled in order to maintain runway az- 3. Set required power.
imuth throughout lift-off.
4. ALTS preselect at capture mode to
level-off.
The right GA mode is a vertical mode that
sets the FD bars at +10° pitch, wings level. The 5. ALTS preselect track.
ALTS with the up arrow reflects the first climb M AC H a p p e a r s a b o v e
to altitude after takeoff and appears automat- M.450. The SPD CHG but-
ically when the altitude preselector is used to SPD CHG ton toggles between Mach
set the first level-off altitude. Press the GA but- and IAS. Mach goes off scale
ton (Figure 16-74) on the throttle knob to set below M.400.
GA for takeoff.
IAS/MACH transition altitude:
CLIMBING: DESCENDING:
MACH MACH
30,810 FT 30,410 FT
IAS IAS
PU S H
FLC
AN
C
CEL
10
1650
UP DG 060 040 H
Flying an ILS
Approach Technique APPR
Flying an FMS
B/C Approach Technique
Refer to Figure 16-83 for steps to accomplish
an FMS approach:
20 APPR
10
5a LNV1 AP ALT
APPR LNV1
10
5b APPR LNV1 AP ALT
1850
HDG 013 211
Figure 16-82. Localizer Back-
20
Course Approach
10
5. At the capture point, observe that the
white APPR B/C 1 replaces the HDG
mode and turns green.
At capture, the aircraft is turned on to final ap-
proach at 27° bank. The final approach can be 10
intercepted up to 90°, but the pilot must arm
the approach early so the FGC can properly 1850
compute the capture and turn-on points.
HDG 013 211
Figure 16-83. FMS Approach Display
4. The aircraft is now flying the long- The glide-slope approach (arm or track) is au-
range FMS flight plan on the FMS map tomatically deselected when go-around mode
page of the pilot PFD. is selected, a lateral mode other than lateral
5. Press APPROACH TO ARM FMS approach is selected, the NAV source or fre-
APPR. quency is changed or becomes invalid.
a. Observe APPR LNV1 armed for After capture, vertical approach mode inhibits
FMS approach mode. the activation of any other vertical mode ex-
b. At capture point, observe APPR cept go-around and overspeed mode.
LNV1 white light replace LNV1
green to APPR LNV1 green FMS
approach mode. Overspeed Mode
With RAIM (receiver autonomous integrity Overspeed mode is automatically selected
monitoring) and the proper horizontal position when a significant overspeed occurs from all
error quality factors, the indications of going vertical modes except altitude select capture
into FMS approach mode occur within the final or track and altitude hold.
two miles to the FAF. These may be the
APPROACH ACTV light coming on with
KLN-900 to the blue APPR that appears above
REMOTE SWITCHES
the NAV data box in the PFD. Different Several switches and buttons with avionics
indications with different FMSs. functions are located throughout the flight
deck and on the control wheels. The controls
Slip-Skid Indicator located on the control wheels are the A/P SYNC
button (2), AP and TRIM DISC button (2), and
The slip-skid indicator, under the sky pointer electric trim controls. The GA button is lo-
is about 1/8-inch scale to the right, is the same cated in the throttle handle. Other controls lo-
as a ball in a turn-and-slip race. Step on the cated on the flight deck are the AHRS
ball, recenter, then slowly trim out the forces. AUTO–MANUAL L–R SLEW controls, ADC
reversion switches (dual PFD only), display re-
Approach Mode (Vertical) version switches, attitude heading reversion
Vertical approach mode is automatically armed switches, rotary test switch AOA test and over-
after lateral approach mode capture when a speed warning test, and display dimming knobs.
valid glide-slope signal is being received.
A/P SYNC Switch
Vertical approach mode generates commands
to capture and track vertical guidance from the SYNC switches are provided as part of the
precision approach source (ILS). aircraft system and mounted on each control
wheel. The A/P SYNC button is used to syn-
When armed, vertical approach mode moni- chronize the roll, pitch, altitude, vertical speed,
tors aircraft closure rate toward the approach and FLC reference to the current conditions.
path and calculates the optimum capture point
while continuing to operate in the currently ac-
tive vertical mode.
AP and TRIM DISC Button
AP and TRIM DISC red buttons are provided
At capture, vertical approach mode generates as part of the aircraft system and mounted on
commands to capture the flight path. each control wheel. Pushing either control
wheel AP and TRIM DISC button disengages
After capture, it generates commands to track the autopilot and activates the aural warning.
vertical guidance from the precision approach
source (ILS).
ENGAGE
L R
YD AP
DN
UP TURB
Collins DISENGAGE
ENGAGE
L R
YD AP
DN
AP XFR
UP TURB
Collins DISENGAGE
To operate, push the button once to switch engage position. If the left flight guidance
control from the pilot to copilot side. Push computer magnetic clutch and the right flight
the button again to switch control of the au- guidance computer magnetic clutch preengage
topilot back from the copilot flight director to criteria is met, the levers are magnetically
the pilot flight director. The AP XFER indi- held in the ENGAGE position (Figure 16-86).
cator is illuminated if the autopilot is being
controlled by the copilot flight director sys- The autopilot may be engaged anywhere in
tem. If the indicator is not illuminated, the the flight envelope from normal pitch and roll
autopilot is being controlled by the pilot flight attitudes. The autopilot cannot be engaged
director system. without prior or simultaneous engagement of
the yaw damper.
Autopilot Lever
The autopilot lever interlocks with the yaw
damper. Both guarded levers move forward
when only the autopilot lever is moved to the
10
DISENGAGE
AP AND YD ENGAGED
10 L R
DN
22000 Collins
ENGAGE
L R
YD AP
DN
AP XFR
UP TURB
DISENGAGE
AUTOPILOT PANEL (APP-85)
FLC
ALT
VS
C o llin s
KT-70 CONTROL PANEL
Figure 16-90. Course Knob The KT-70 uses a digital readout to display the
Panel (CKP) pilot selected transponder code. The four-digit
code is set into the display by four knobs, one
for each digit. A photocell on the face of the
control automatically dims the display ac-
PULSE EQUIPMENT cording to ambient cabin light. Power and
mode of operation are controlled by the power
KT-70 TRANSPONDERS and mode switch, which has OFF, SBY, TST,
GND, ON, and ALT positions. OFF removes
The KT-70 mode S transponder system consists power from the system. SBY applies power to
of two panel-mounted units, two external an- the system for warmup and allows momentary
tennas mounted on the bottom of the aircraft power interruptions that may be desired with-
nose section, and a control wheel mounted out having to turn the system off. When a
XPDR IDNT switch for each pilot. Transponder transponder is in standby, either because of
No. 1 receives its altitude encoding informa- the SBY position being selected on the power
tion from the air data computer and transmits and mode switch or because of the selection on
the XPDR 1/XPDR 2 switch, SBY will be an- When the transponder is turned from OFF to
nunciated in the center of the digital display. any other selection, the unit will display the in-
In ON, the transmitter is enabled for normal op- staller programmed aircraft address and max-
eration, except the altitude information of the imum airspeed, in three two-second segments,
mode C reply and the altitude fields of the according to a preprogrammed sequence.
mode S are suppressed. ALT position causes
transmission of uncorrected barometric altitude The function selector has a PUSH VFR func-
(based on a barometric pressure of 29.92, which tion that may be preprogrammed. Momentarily
is supplied by the encoding altimeter in mode depressing the function selector knob causes
C and mode S interrogations. ON or ALT will the preprogrammed VFR code to supersede
be annunciated respectively when either of whatever code was previously entered. The
those selections are made. ID code will immediately be accepted for in-
terrogation reply sequence. The VFR code is
The TST position initiates a system self-test. programmed by the following sequence:
To test the system, select the desired transpon-
der and turn the selector to TST position. The 1. Place the unit in standby mode (SBY).
TST position causes the selected transponder
to respond to internal interrogation, verifying 2. Select the desired code (VFR, 1200, for
memory data and making hardware squitter instance).
checks. The transmitter is disabled. All dis-
play segments will illuminate. Should a squit-
ter error occur, the transmitter is considered 3. Depress the VFR pushbutton (function
inoperative and the message FO 1 will appear select knob) while holding the IDT but-
in the altitude display. Should a memory error ton depressed.
occur, the message FO 2 (internal) or FO 3 (ex- If the VFR pushbutton (function select knob)
ternal) will appear. Should a failure occur, is inadvertently pressed, the previous nonpro-
normal operation is prohibited and FO 4 will grammed 4096 code may be retrieved by press-
appear. If no errors are detected, the unit will ing the VFR pushbutton again for three seconds.
remain in the test mode.
The KT-70 transponder has an altitude (FL)
GND mode is designed to be used only when display in the left side of the digital readout.
the aircraft is on the ground. GND position It is in hundreds of feet and FL is annunciated
turns the set on and enables the transponder to indicate that the display is of a flight level,
to transmit mode S reply pulses. The ID 4096 which is an altitude that corresponds to an al-
code is shown on the right side of the display titude above sea level (above the standard
with altitude shown on the left side. GND is datum plane) with the altimeter set at 29.92
annunciated in the display in this mode. Mode inches of mercury. It corresponds to the alti-
A and C interrogations are inhibited. tude that is being transmitted to the air traf-
fic control, and will seldom agree exactly to
An IDT switch (button) is located on the front the indicated altitude on the altimeter. The al-
of each transponder control. These switches titude display will only be active when altitude
perform the same function as the XPDR IDNT reporting is enabled in ALT and GND modes.
switches on the pilots’ control wheels. Pressing
either button (control wheel or IDT button on An R reply indicator is also on the digital dis-
active transponder) will cause a distinctive play. The R will illuminate when the transpon-
return to appear on a ground controller’s radar der is replying to a valid interrogation by a
screen for approximately 30 seconds after the ground station, and will illuminate for ap-
IDENT button is pressed and released. It proximately 18 seconds after the initiation of
should not be depressed unless requested by an “ident.”
a ground controller.
DISTANCE MEASURING
EQUIPMENT
I00 NM
2
00 99
KT MIN
KN-63 with KDI-574
Indicators KING
The standard DME installation consists of one
KN-63 receiver-transmitter, one KN-574 in-
dicator, and an antenna mounted on the bot- Figure 16-91. KN-574 DME Indicator
tom of the fuselage below the cockpit. The
KN-574 is installed on the right side of the cen- alternately selects NAV 1 and NAV 2 for dis-
ter instrument panel. The DME is turned on and play. If the pilot selects NAV 2 on the EFIS
off by the illuminated DME ON/DME/OFF controller, the NAV annunciation (VOR 2)
(green/white, push-on/push-off) switch on the will be in amber, to indicate selection of the
center instrument panel. Dual DMEs and dual off-side NAV. The selected DME will always
indicators may be installed as an option. be the same as the NAV source (VOR).
The KN-63 transmits interrogating pulse pairs If dual DMEs are installed, dual KN-574 DME
on 200 channels between 1041 MHz and 1150 indicators will be installed, usually one on the
MHz; it receives associated ground-to-air pilot instrument panel and one on the copilot
replies between 978 MHz and 1213 MHz. The instrument panel. The pilot KN-574 will be
KN-574 digitally displays distances in nauti- permanently connected to the No. 1 NAV and
cal miles, groundspeed in knots, and time-to- the copilot KN-574 will be permanently con-
station in minutes. All displays are in nected to the No. 2 NAV. Only No. 2 NAV can
self-dimming gas-discharge numerics. be displayed on the copilot HSI. A separate
switch is required for a single-DME installa-
The VOR/DME tuning is controlled by the tion to determine which NAV is channeling
KN-53 NAV receiver on the consolidated con- the DME.
trol panel. When a VOR station is tuned, the
DME frequency is automatically tuned. The Distance measuring equipment (DME) ground-
DME ident can be verified by selecting the ap- speed or time-to-station readouts are only ac-
propriate DME on the DME selector switch on curate when the aircraft is proceeding directly
the audio control panel. The NAV (1 or 2) se- to or from the selected station. Since it is slant
lected is displayed in the KDI-574 indicator range that is computed, groundspeed or time-
to the right of the nautical mile (nm) display. to-station accuracy increases with distance
Channel 1 always refers to NAV 1 and chan- from the station. The readouts can be consid-
nel 2 always refers to NAV 2. The DME ered reasonably close to actual speed or time
ON/DME OFF switch below the indicator when distance from the station in miles is
turns the DME on and off. equal to or greater than the aircraft altitude in
thousands of feet. The distance display on the
DME information is also displayed on the DME indicator is in 0.1-nm increments up to
pilot EHSI by pressing the NAV button on the 99.9 nm, then in increments of one nm to a
display controller. If the pilot selects NAV 1 maximum of 389 nm. The groundspeed display
on the display controller, the DME informa- can indicate a maximum range of 999 knots,
tion displayed on the EHSI and the KN-574 and the time-to-station indication has a max-
DME indicator (Figure 16-91) will be from imum indication of 99 minutes.
NAV 1, and so annunciated on the EFIS dis-
play. If NAV 2 is selected, the DME will be If the pilot desires to retune the KN-53 NAV
tuned to NAV 2, and NAV 2 will be displayed control but to retain the DME readout of the
and annunciated on the EFIS and the KN-574 present station, HOLD is selected by pressing
DME indicator. Pressing the NAV button the DME HOLD/SELECTED illuminated
switch, located just below the DME indicator, The decision height warning tone is controlled
before the set is retuned. The switch will il- only by the DH setting in the pilot PFD. The
luminate in amber and the DME will hold on copilot attitude sphere decision height selec-
the previously tuned frequency. H1 or H2 (as tion has no effect on the sounding of the DH
applicable) will be annunciated in the KN- warning horn.
574 display to warn the pilot that the DME is
in the hold mode. It will also be annunciated When the aircraft descends below an altitude
in amber to the left of the distance display on of 100 feet above the selected radio altitude
the PFD to indicate the DME frequency and decision height, a black box with a white
that information is being held. background appears in the upper left side of
the ADI. When the decision height is reached,
If optional dual KN-63 DMEs are installed, the an amber MIN appears inside the box. The dis-
respective DMEs will interfere with each other play flashes for 10 seconds and then goes
when the NAV frequencies differ by 5.3 MHz steady.
(for example, 108.00 MHz and 113.3 MHz).
This interference results in premature flags or A low-altitude awareness display, which is a
loss of “lock-on.” Should this occur, one of the brown strip along the right side of the DU-870
KN-63s should be either turned off or tuned primary flight display, is used as a visual an-
to a different NAV frequency so that the 5.3- nunciation of the aircraft’s nearness to the
MHz difference is eliminated. ground. The low-altitude awareness display is
inside the bottom part of the altitude display
and begins to appear when a radio altitude of
less than 550 feet is reached. At touchdown,
RADIO ALTIMETER the low-altitude awareness display reaches
the horizon line. The yellow line, which divides
COLLINS ALT-55B the brown area from the rest of the display, will
disappear at a radio altitude below 60 feet.
The Collins ALT-55B radio altimeter displays
altitude at all times up to an absolute altitude If radio altimeter information is invalid, the
of 2,500 feet. The system becomes operational radio altitude display will be amber dashes,
when the aircraft electrical system is pow- and the low-altitude awareness display will
ered up and it remains operational throughout not appear.
the flight. Radio altitude is displayed in green
digits located in the bottom center of the al- Functional testing of the radio altimeter sys-
titude sphere in the ADI displays. tem and the ADI display digital readout is ac-
complished on the ground by depressing the
The altitude display in the ADIs operates from TEST button on the ALT-55B display con-
–20 to 2,500 feet. Between 200 and 2,500 feet, troller. The following displays will occur:
the display is in 10-foot increments. Below 200
feet, it is in 5-foot increments. Above 2,500 • A radio altitude of 50, ±5 feet will be in-
feet, the display will disappear. dicated until the bottom is released, at
which time the actual altitude will be dis-
Radio altitude, radio altitude-based decision played
height (DH, referred to as RADIO), and a de-
cision height alert are displayed on the PFD. • The radio altitude decision height dis-
The RADIO value is set via the REFS (refer- play shows dashes when the TEST but-
ence) menu on the PFD. The REFS menu is se- ton is held down, and then displays the
lected with the REFS button on the DCP. Turn current set altitude for the remainder of
the test.
the ROTARY TEST switch to ANNUNCIA-
TOR TEST to test the radio altimeter. No other • The radio altimeter TEST cannot be ac-
pilot control operation is required. complished when APR CAP function of
the flight director is selected. the aircraft facing away from build-
ings or large metal structures that
• The radio altitude decision height tone
check will depend on the radio altitude are likely to reflect radar energy back
selection (RA) set on the pilot ADI dis- to the aircraft.
play.
Testing the radio altimeter system with the The Collins Pro Line 21 weather radar system,
TEST button on the display controller will also or the RTA-800, is a fully integrated radar
test the EFIS failure flags and annunciators system that utilizes the aircraft electronic
(lamps) in the flight director mode selector. flight instrument systems (EFIS) equipment to
provide the pilot and/or copilot with a video
display of radar indications relative to outside
NOTE moisture precipitation (Figure 16-92).
The test function activated by the
TEST button is disabled after the Weather radar targets and mode information
glide slope has been captured during are available for display on both pilot-side
an ILS approach using the autopilot MFD and PFD as well as the optional copilot-
or flight director. side PFD. Radar overlay and menu are se-
lected for display with the RADAR button on
the DCP. The radar is then turned on by press-
While taxiing over ice or snow, the radio al- ing LSK R2 and turning white WX> to blue
timeter may fluctuate as much as 50 feet. WX>. The radar is not transmitting. There is
Outputs from the radio altimeter system are no forced standby in this radar. The RTA-800
used to desensitize the flight director and au- operates on X-band frequency and is capable
topilot as the aircraft passes 1,100 feet AGL of detecting wet precipitation along the flight
with the glide slope engaged during an ILS ap- path and in front of the aircraft within an arc
proach. If the radio altitude is invalid, gain pro- of the heading angle ±60°, at a selectable dis-
gramming becomes a function of glide-slope play range of up to 300 nautical miles.
capture, time, and airspeed.
An optional installation configuration, the
RTA-852, is physically and functionally
WEATHER RADAR identical to the RTA-800 except for featuring
autotilt operation and the additional capa-
bility of detecting moisture-based turbulence.
WXR-800 WEATHER RADAR The RTA-800 and RTA-852 accept radar con-
OVERLAY trol data from the left PFD/MFD. The RTA-
800 can also accept radar control data from
the right PFD. The weather radar system may
WARNING be operated in a split mode, where the radar
functions like two independent radars, each
updating on alternate sweeps of the antenna.
The radar will transmit on the ground
if selected to the ON position. The
area within the scan area and within WARNING
15 feet of an operating weather radar
system constitutes a hazardous area.
Do not operate the radar system The system performs only the func-
within 15 feet of personnel or tions of weather detection and ground
flammable or explosive material or mapping. It should not be used or re-
during fueling operations. For ground lied upon for proximity warning, an-
operation of a radar system, position ticollision, or terrain avoidance.
NAV/BRG
HDG 037 S 193 21
VOR1
CRS 013 RADAR
15
24
- - - -NM
RADAR RADAR
GCS
GAIN NORM
STBY
2.5
TILT RANGE
STAB WX
ON OFF
MAP
TEST RETURN
Collins
BRT
DIM
2. M O D E S e l e c t – W X — A d j u s t OPERATIONAL NOTES
range to 10 or 25 and make sure
GCS is not selected. The controls and special features of the WXR-
800 control panel are defined on Table 16-6.
3. T I LT k n o b — A d j u s t s o t h a t
ground return is shown at or near
max distance. Note display of CAUTION
ground return.
VIP
RATE OF (VIDEO RATE OF
PDF OR MDF STORM
RAIN FALL INTEGRATED RAIN FALL REMARKS
DISPLAY CATEGORY
(IN/HR) PROCESSOR) (IN/HR)
LEVEL
Greater
Severe turbulence,
than 5.0
Extreme 6 large hail, lightning,
Greater than inches per
extensive wind gusts
2.0 inches hour (81.93 ml)
MAGENTA
per hour
2.0 to 5.0
(32.77 ml) Severe turbulence,
Intense 5 inches per
lightning, wind gusts,
hour (32.77
hail likely
to 81.93 ml)
1.02 to 1.97
Very inches per Severe turbulence
4 likely, lightning
0.47 to 2.0 Strong hour (16.71
inches per to 32.28 ml)
RED hour (7.70 0.48 to 0.98
to 32.77 ml) inches per Severe turbulence,
Strong 3 hour (7.86 possible lightning
to 16.06 ml)
0.16 to 0.47 0.10 to 0.48
inches per inches per
YELLOW Moderate 2
hour (2.62 hour (1.64
to 7.70 ml) to 7.86 ml) Light to moderate
turbulence possible,
0.01 to 0.10 lightning
0.04 to 0.16
Weak 1 inches per
GREEN inches per
hour (0.164
hour
to 1.64 ml)
Mode Control Knob The radar display, radar transmitter, and an-
tenna scan drive are inhibited whenever STBY
The mode control knob selects choice of is selected.
operating modes of the WXR-800 system
as follows:
CAUTION
OFF—Primary power is removed from the
system. The word OFF is displayed on the
PFD/MFD. The WXR should be in the STBY
mode when on the ground to ensure
STBY (standby)—Applies power to RTA-800. the safety of people and equipment
The letters STBY display on the PFD/MFD from possible radar radiation.
within 20 seconds. At system powerup on the
ground, the radar will be in STBY mode. A
powerup in flight will result in the radar being TEST
in its previously selected mode. STBY is au- Test mode runs a self-test for radar. The word
tomatically selected 60 seconds after air/ground TEST displays on the PFD/MFD. If TEST is
transition to ground. STBY is manually se- deselected with LSK L4, the previously active
lected by pressing line-select key R1 when the radar mode becomes active.
RADAR menu is active (Figure 16-93). The
RADAR menu is selected with the RADAR
FORMAT >
RDR >
WX
BRT
DIM
Collins
FMS1
DTK 350 30
KCID
3
95.0NM
100
< PRESET LX/RDR >
VOR1 WX G+3
T+10.7A
VOR1
FMS1
BRT
DIM
If any of the above or similar conditions exist, legend associated with each parameter is re-
modify operation to correct the problem or moved and replaced with a N 1 , N 2 , or ITT as
use emergency procedures as required. appropriate, and a direction arrow pointing
to the side with the engine that is causing the
comparator warn. If both engines have a mis-
MISCOMPARE WARNINGS comparing parameter, the direction arrows
Miscompare warnings are used to alert the pi- show on both sides.
lots that redundant data from dual independent
systems does not agree within limits (Figure Pitch
16-95). Comparator monitoring is performed
full time for attitude and heading data when The pitch comparator is enabled when both
dual attitude heading reference systems are in- sides are not using a common attitude source
stalled (baseline). Comparator monitoring is and both sides are not failed (no ATT flags).
performed full time for airspeed and altitude When the pitch comparator is enabled, and
data when dual air data systems are installed the pilot and copilot pitch difference is greater
(optional second PFD configuration). than 4°, not G/S capture, or greater than 3°,
Comparator monitoring is performed full time G/S capture; the pitch miscompare warning
for N 1 , N 2 , and ITT. PIT is displayed in yellow in the center of the
attitude ball.
The miscompare warning annunciations are
displayed in yellow, flash for five seconds
when a miscompare condition first exists, then
Roll
are steady. They are removed when the mis- The roll comparator is enabled when both sides
compare condition is removed. For the N 1 , are not using a common attitude source and
N 2 , and ITT comparator warns, the respective both sides are not failed (no ATT flags). When
the roll comparator is enabled, and the pilot and
C o llin s copilot roll difference is greater than 4°, not
G/S capture, or greater than 3°, G/S capture;
YD
the roll miscompare warning ROL is displayed
E A R
17000 in yellow on the attitude ball.
FD1 ATT
260
AHS2
20 ALT000 4
ADC2 240 FD 2
10 900
20
1 Pitch and Roll
220 15800
80
XTLK
WINDSHEAR
10
1
The pitch and roll comparators are enabled
200 700 2 when both sides are not using a common at-
20 4
180
RA TEST RA
200 LOC GS
600 titude source and both sides are not failed (no
M.456
3D
HDG 33 340 N 29.92 CAT2
ATT flags). When the pitch and roll com-
LOC1
CRS 340 30 parators are enabled, and both the pitch and
95.0 NN roll comparator limits are exceeded (de-
3
100
FORMAT >
warning ATT is displayed in yellow on the at-
< PRESET RDR >
titude ball.
FMS1 FOR FAULT
TCAS FAIL
BRT
DIM
NOTE
Common source AHS data to the FCS C o llin s
FD1 ATT V
strictly as a function of reverting the ADC2
RA2
IAS FD N ALT
V
ENG2 RA LOC GS
DCP
HDG
ADC Reversion HDG
N
CAT2
33 3
If only a single ADC is installed, no ADC re-
30
LOC1
FLAG flashes for five seconds when first in view, then steady.
# Indicates 1 or 2
AFD Cross-Talk Flag PFD or MFD. The XTLK flag flashes for five
seconds, then is steady. It is removed when
A yellow, boxed, XTLK flag is displayed in communication is restored. PFDs or MFDs
the PFD message window, and beneath the N 1 that have been deselected by pilot reversion
readouts on the MFD, when applicable, when will not cause the message.
any AFD loses cross-talk input from any other
Collins
TNU RDR
< PRESET
KCID WX
VOR1 200
CO T–1.5A
100 IA
IOW
RETURN >
< DATA
OTM
RAT–15°C
BRT
DIM
Collins
------
50 3 00 4
AOA1
10 2
60 2 00
1
20
–– 51 00
80
10 1
VT150
V2112 0 00
20 2
VR109 GS
V1109 LOC 09 00 4
0
29.92
HDG 015 039
LOC1
CRS 013 3 6
------- NM N FORMAT
E
33
12
PRESET LX/RDR
FMS
30
15
ADF
W
S SAT 17°C
ADF ISA+4°C
24 21
RAT 17°C
BRT
DIM
DISPLAY
NORM
REV TO
PFD REV TO
MFD
LONG-RANGE NAVIGATION—
KLN-900 WITH GPS FAULT
DETECTION AND EXCLUSION
(FDE) (STANDARD)
The AlliedSignal KLN-900 (P/N057-02203-
0004) with GPS fault detection and exclusion
(FDE) is a single-unit panel or pedestal-
mounted, long-range, global positioning sys-
tem (GPS)-based airborne navigation system
with a database (Figure 16-102). Besides the
panel or pedestal-mounted GPS receiver, the
system is comprised of a KLN-900 configu-
ration module and a KA-91 antenna mounted
on top of the forward fuselage. All output data
is read from the unit front panel display, and
Figure 16-101. Static Wicks—Rudder all input to the unit is via the front panel con-
trols. The primary purpose of the equipment
is to provide the pilot with present position
FMS INTERFACES information and to display guidance infor-
mation with respect to a flight plan defined
The Collins system provides interfaces to by the pilot.
the following navigation/flight management
systems: Flight plan information is entered by the pilot
• KLN-900 (standard) via various knobs and buttons on the front
panel. The screen display normally is divided
• UNS-1K (optional) into five segments defined by vertical and
• GNS-X LS (optional) horizontal lines on the screen. The larger top
left segment is called the left page and the
• KLN-90B (optional) larger top right segment is called the right
page. The lower left segment displays the
The KLN-900 is the standard, with any of the name of the left page being displayed while
above being provided as an alternative. the smaller lower-right segment displays the
name of the right page being displayed. The
NOTE lower middle segment displays the mode of
operation, for example ENG-LEG is enroute-
In this installation, the FMS is a non- leg mode, which is the normal mode for en-
Collins external navigator. The ca- route operations. There are eight types of
pabilities of the installed FMS is pages that may be displayed on the left side
manufacturer dependent. Refer to the of the screen and 10 types of pages that may
appropriate approved FMS operator’s be displayed on the right side. The abbrevi-
manual for information on how FMS ations for these page types are displayed
functions are controlled/accessed. around the outside of the left and right outer
knobs. Some types of pages, such as NAV,
have more than one page. Once the type of
page is selected using the outer knob, the
inner knob is used to select the specific page.
GPS
KHUT 2 KHUT A
4 1 GPS 31
DI S 2 8 6 NM 2 NDB 13
GS 10 KT 3 VOR 03 BRT
PUSH
ETE : 4 VORD 21 ON
BRG 314°
NAV 1 ENR 314 MSG ACT 8
CRSR CRSR
D CLR ENT
NAV APT
NAV CALC
D/T VOR
FPL STAT
ACTV NDB
MODE SETUP
REF INT
TRIP OTHER
CTR SUPL
OBS ALT NRST
PULL SCAN
MSG SAVE
Instrument Panel Annunciators will nominate the first waypoint of the pub-
lished missed approach procedure when
The approach switch/light annunciator indi- DIRECT TO is pressed, and the active waypoint
cates the KLN-900 mode of operation while is the MAP, and the MAP has been passed.
in the approach environment and allows for the
manual selection of the APPROACH ARM
mode of operation. The APPROACH ARM NOTE
mode will automatically engage when the air- The KLN-900 does not provide guid-
craft is within 30 nm of the destination airport ance in accordance with the pub-
and an approach has been loaded into the ac- lished missed approach procedure.
tive flight plan. When the APPROACH ARM When executing a missed approach,
mode is engaged, the FMS switches from the use the autopilot HDG mode or man-
enroute mode of operation to the terminal ually fly the aircraft to ensure the
mode of operation. The CDI sensitivity will missed approach procedure is exe-
change from ±5.0 nm to ±1.0 nm for full-scale cuted as published.
deflection. The APPROACH ARM mode can
be manually activated by pressing the ap-
proach annunciator in any phase of flight. Fuel flow information is supplied directly to
the KLN-900 from the fuel signal conditioner
The APPROACH ACTV mode cannot be man- unit. Air data and temperature are provided to
ually selected outside of 2 nm from the final the KLN-900 via an air data computer inter-
approach fix (FAF). The APPROACH ACTV face. Absence of these inputs or improper in-
mode will engage only when the following puts will not affect the navigational accuracy
criteria are satisfied: of the system. Otherwise, data must be man-
ually entered for the KLN-900 functions using
1. The aircraft is 2 nm from the FAF this information, e.g., TAS, wind computa-
tion, range, etc.
2. The leg mode is selected
NOTE
3. RAIM is available Start nozzle fuel is supplied continu-
ously at a flow rate of approximately
4. The aircraft is heading toward the FAF 9 pounds per hour while the engine is
operating and is not accounted for in
the fuel flow indication on the KLN-
5. The FAF is the active waypoint 900. The fuel flow on the MFD does
account for the 9-pounds-per-hour
When the APPROACH ACTV mode is en- start nozzle fuel.
gaged, the FMS switches from the terminal
mode of operation to the approach mode of op-
KLN-900 calculations using temperature input
eration. CDI sensitivity will change respec-
are based on ram-air temperature (RAT).
tively from ±1.0 nm to ±0.3 nm for full-scale
deflection. APPR will display in the upper
left quadrant of the PFD.
Operator’s Manual 3. E n r o u t e a n d t e r m i n a l — I n c l u d i n g
BRNAV/RNP5, in accordance with AC20-
For detailed operating information, consult 138A, AC90-96, and JAA AMJ 20X2.
the KLN-900 GPS Pilot’s Guide, P/N 006- For two crew operations, BRNAV/RNP5
08796-0000 dated July 1996, or later revision. requires that FMS CDI data must be dis-
The Pilot’s Guide, as applicable to the spe- played on the copilot instrument panel.
cific software modification status and sensor (Dual-PFD installations or single-PFD
installation, must be immediately available installations with a separate dedicated
to the flight crew whenever navigation is CDI displaying FMS aircraft position rel-
predicated on the use of the system. The ative to track on the copilot side).
Bendix/King Operator’s Manual is generic to
many aircraft installations. The “Operational
Revision Status” (ORS) of the Pilot’s Guide 4. Nonprecision approach—In accordance
must match the ORS level annunciated on with AC20-138A and AC90-94
the self-test page. All functions discussed in NOTE
t h e m a n u a l m a y n o t b e ava i l a b l e i n t h e
Citation CJ2 installation. Some oceanic/remote NAT routes
may require two FMSs with inde-
pendent long-range navigation sen-
Navigation Operation sors (GPS or IRS).
Approvals
The KLN-900 flight management system KLN-900 Operating Limitations
(FMS) with FDE is approved under TSO
C129A1 and has been demonstrated capable
of meeting the requirements for the following 1. The KLN-900 Pilot’s Guide, P/N 006-
VFR/IFR operations (provided it is receiving 08796-0000, Revision 2, dated January
usable navigation data from the GPS sensor): 1999, or later revision, as applicable to the
specific software modification status and
1. O c e a n i c / r e m o t e ( p e r FA A N o t i c e sensor installation, must be immediately
8110.60)—Two FMSs are required to be available to the flight crew whenever nav-
installed, operating, and receiving usable igation is predicated on the use of the
signals from independent GPS sensors KLN-900. The “Operational Revision
(or one FMS and one GPS sensor for those Status” (ORS) of the Pilot’s Guide must
routes requiring only one long range nav- match the ORS level annunciated on the
igation (LRN) sensor). self-test page.
NOTE
2. North Atlantic Track (NAT) Minimum
Navigational Performance Specification The KLN-900 Operator’s Manual is
(MNPS) airspace (as defined in AC91-49 generic to many aircraft installations.
and AC91-70)—Provided that the proper All equipment, options, and features
documentation and approval is obtained. in the KLN-900 Operator’s Manual
Two FMSs are required to be installed, op- may not be available in the Citation
erating, and receiving usable signals from CJ2 installation.
independent GPS sensors.
2. With the exception of oceanic/remote,
other navigation equipment appropriate
to the ground facilities along the intended
route must be installed and operable as re-
quired by the operating rules applicable
to the specific type of operation (i.e.,
VOR, DME, etc.).
3. IFR navigation is prohibited unless the 8. When using FMS guidance for conduct-
pilot verifies the currency of the database ing instrument approach procedures that
or verifies each selected waypoint for do not include “or GPS” in the title of the
accuracy by reference to current approved published procedure, the flight crew must
data. verify that the procedure specified navaid
and associated avionics are operational.
4. The internal database (IDB) must be up-
dated to the latest revision every 28 days; 9. IFR nonprecision approach approval is
updating to be accomplished with the limited to published approaches within
update disk or equivalent. Update disks the U.S. National Airspace System.
will be delivered by mail (to subscribers) Approaches to airports in other airspace
or obtained from authorized installation are not approved unless authorized by
centers or update centers. the appropriate governing authority.
5. The use of manually inserted runway co- 10. ILS, LOC, LOC-BC, LDA, SDF, and MLS
ordinates for FMS approaches is limited approaches using the KLN-900 for final
to VFR operations only. approach guidance are not approved.
6. Instrument approaches must be accom- 11. When the approach at the destination is
plished in accordance with approved in- based on GPS and an alternate airport is
strument approach procedures that are required by the applicable operating rules,
r e t r i eve d f r o m t h e F M S n av i g a t i o n it must be served by an approach not based
database. The database must incorporate on GPS, the aircraft must have opera-
the current update cycle. tional equipment capable of using that
navigation aid, and the required naviga-
NOTE tion aid must be operational.
• Not all published approaches are in
the FMS database. The flight crew 12. The KLN-900 does not provide guidance
must ensure that the planned ap- in accordance with the published missed
proach is in the database. approach procedure. The aircraft must
be flown manually to ensure that certain
portions of the missed approach procedure
• When an instrument approach pro- are flown properly.
cedure missed approach point is
not identified in the database as a
runway (i.e., RW02, etc.), VNAV 13. Operation above 74°00.0 north latitude
guidance may not be appropriate and below 60°00.0 south latitude is pro-
for straight-in approach operations. hibited due to unreliable magnetic head-
ing, unless manual magnetic variation is
entered into the FMS.
7. At the final approach fix, the KLN-900 14. The fuel management mode is for advi-
APPROACH ACTV and ARM switch- sory purposes only and does not replace
lights must be illuminated and RAIM the aircraft primary fuel flow and fuel
must be available. quantity.
UNIVERSAL
NAV APPR 1 / 3 M
K I C T GPS 19L
MSG F R KONYA 2900 F T HDG NAV
194 ° 3 . 8 NM – 2 . 9 °
DATA T O RW 1 9 L * 1369 F T MNVR DTO
M I S S D
FUEL NX * EOA * APPR FPL
NEXT MENU
A B C D E F G 1 2 3
PWR
DIM H I J K L M N 4 5 6 PERF
O P Q R S T U 7 8 9
V W X Y Z ENTER BACK 0 +
–
Figure 16-103. UNS-1K Display
sensors (or one FMS and one GPS sensor 2. The UNS-1K must be used in conjunction
for those routes requiring only one long- with the Universal off-line RAIM pre-
range navigation [LRN] sensor). diction program, P/N 10751, with SCN 21
or later FAA-approved versions, when
2. North Atlantic Track (NAT) Minimum used as the primary means of navigation
Navigational Performance Specification in oceanic and remote airspace.
(MNPS) airspace (as defined in AC 91-49
and AC-91-70)—Provided that the proper 3. Navigation within the national airspace
documentation and approval is obtained. system shall not be predicated upon the
Two FMSs are required to be installed, UNS-1K during periods of dead reckon-
operating and receiving usable signals ing (DR).
from independent GPS sensors.
4. The internal database (IDB) must be up-
3. E n r o u t e a n d t e r m i n a l — I n c l u d i n g dated to the latest revision every 28 days;
BRNAV/RNP5 in accordance with AC20- updating to be accomplished with the
138A, AC90-96, and JAA AMJ 20X2. Universal Avionics update disk or equiv-
For two crew operations, BRNAV/RNP5 alent. When latitude/longitude transferred
requires that FMS CDI data must be dis- from the IDB is displayed on the CDU,
played on the copilot instrument panel. the pilot will ensure that it is a reasonable
(Dual-PFD installations or single-PFD position for the requested identifier.
installations with a separate dedicated
CDI displaying FMS aircraft position rel- 5. The fuel management mode is for advi-
ative to track on the copilot side.) sory purposes only and it does not re-
place the aircraft primary fuel flow and
4. Nonprecision approach—In accordance fuel quantity systems.
with AC20-138A and AC90-94.
6. GPS manually entered altitude may be
UNS-1K Operating used only after failure of the automatic
inputs and must be updated every five
Limitations minutes.
General
7. When operating outside the magnetic
variation model area (north of 72°45
1. The UNS-1K Flight Management System
minutes north latitude or south of 59°45
Pilot’s Operating Manual, Universal
minutes south latitude), the pilot must
Systems report number 2423sv604 dated
manually insert magnetic variation.
October 8, 1999 (or later applicable re-
vision), must be immediately available to
the flight crew whenever navigation is 8. The UNS-1K displayed VNAV infor-
predicated on the use of the FMS. The mation is advisory only. Vertical cou-
software status stated in the Pilot’s pling to the flight director or autopilot
Manual must match that displayed on the is not available.
FMS control display unit (CDU).
9. The A/P TURB mode must be selected
OFF to conduct LNAV GPS approaches.
10. Instrument approaches must be accom- 14. The GPS INTEG light/annunciator must
plished in accordance with approved in- be extinguished prior to beginning the
strument approach procedures that are approach.
r e t r i eve d f r o m t h e F M S n av i g a t i o n
database. The FMS database must incor- 15. Instrument approaches must be conducted
porate the current update cycle. with the FMS in the approach mode of op-
eration, the FMS approach annunciator
must be illuminated (cyan APP on EHSI)
NOTE prior to the final approach fix, and RAIM
• When an instrument approach pro- must be available at the final approach fix.
cedure missed approach point is
not identified in the database as a 16. ILS, LOC, LOC-BC, LDA, SDF, and MLS
runway (e.g., RW02, etc.), VNAV approaches using the UNS-1K for final
guidance may not be appropriate approach guidance are not approved.
for straight-in approach opera-
tions.
17. With the exception of oceanic/remote,
other navigation equipment appropriate
• Not all published approaches are to the ground facilities along the intended
in the FMS database. The flight route must be installed and operable, as
crew must ensure that the planned required by the operating rules applica-
approach is in the database. ble to the specific type of operation (i.e.,
VOR, DME, etc.).
11. IFR nonprecision approach approval is 18. The FMS is approved for FMS VFR ap-
limited to published approaches within proaches as a VFR pilot aid only.
the U. S. National Airspace System.
Approaches to airports in other airspace 19. The use of manually inserted runway co-
are not approved unless authorized by ordinates is limited to VFR operations
the appropriate governing authority. only.
• Internal, 12-channel GPS receiver At the missed approach point (MAP), the GPS-
400 will not automatically sequence to the
• GPA primary means NAV capable
next waypoint. The GPS-400 continues to give
• TSO C129a B1/C1 compliant guidance along an extension of the final course
segment until the missed approach procedure
• Optional UniLink (text only)
is initiated. When the OBS key is used to ini-
• H o n ey w e l l f l i g h t g u i d a n c e s y s t e m tiate the missed approach procedure, the
compatible missed approach holding point is automatically
offered as the destination waypoint. The OBS
course must be selected on the GPS-400 CDU.
GARMIN GPS-400 (OPTIONAL) The remote course knobs will not change the
selected OBS course.
General
The GPS-400 can be coupled to the autopilot NOTE
when FMS is selected as the navigation source
and NAV is selected on the mode select panel. The GPS-400 does not provide guid-
A white (armed) or green (captured) LNAV ance in accordance with the pub-
message on the PFD will indicate that the lished missed approach procedure.
GPS-400 is being coupled to the NAV mode When executing a missed approach,
of the Collins Pro Line 21 system. Prior to way- use the autopilot HDG mode or man-
points in the GPS-400 active flight plan, the ually fly the aircraft to ensure the
waypoint and waypoint identifier will flash. missed approach procedure is exe-
cuted as published.
NOTE
The red boxed FMS annunciation will Garmin GPS-400 Navigation
appear briefly during flight plan mod- Operational Approvals
ifications and selection of the direct The Garmin GPS-400 is approved under TSO
to function. This is normal while the C129 A1 and has been demonstrated capable
FMS updates navigation data. of meeting the requirements for the following
VFR/IFR operations (provided it is receiving
The terminal mode will automatically engage usable navigation data from the GPS sensor):
when the aircraft is within 30 nm of the des-
tination airport and an approach has been
loaded into the active flight plan. The CDI 1. North Atlantic Track (NAT) Minimum
sensitivity will change from ±5.0 nm to ±1.0 Navigational Performance Specification
nm for full-scale deflection. (MNPS) airspace—In accordance with
AC91-49 and AC120-33
NOTE 2. Enroute and terminal—In accordance
The map format on the PFD/MFD with AC20-138
will not display the ARC portion of
a GPS approach. The ARC will be 3. Enroute BRNAV/RNP5—In accordance
displayed on the GPS-400 CDU. with AC90-96 and JAA AMJ 20X2 for air-
craft with FMS CDI information dis-
The approach mode will engage when the air- played on the copilot instrument panel
craft is 2.0 nm from the FAF. CDI sensitivity (dual-PFD installations, or single-PFD
will change respectively from ±1.0 nm to ±0.3 installations with a separate dedicated
nm for full-scale deflection. APPR will dis- CDI displaying FMS aircraft position rel-
play in the upper left quadrant of the PFD. ative to track on the copilot side)
Abnormal Procedures
TILT RANGE
RAIM not Available
TCAS FAIL
TEST FL
ON ABOVE
SBY NORM
OFF BELOW
PUSH TO TST PUSH FOR FL
3. The self-test function is not inhibited in altitude. If TCAS determines that a possible col-
flight. A test pattern is displayed on the lision hazard exists, it issues both visual and
TCAS during pilot initiated TCAS 1 self- aural advisories to the crew.
test (Figure 16-107).
TCAS has a minimum surveillance volume
defined by a horizontal radius of 14nm and a
TCAS detects and tracks other aircraft by in-
vertical range of ±12,700 feet. TCAS may
terrogating their transponders. Aircraft de-
track aircraft outside its minimum volume de-
tected, tracked, and displayed by TCAS are
pending on the transponder type being inter-
referred to as “intruders.” TCAS analyzes the
rogated, the range of the intruder, and the
transponder replies to determine range and
density of intruders. The selected TCAS dis-
bearing, which it presents to the crew on the
play range does not affect the TCAS airspace
TCAS display. Relative altitude is also pre-
surveillance volume.
sented if the intruding transponder is reporting
TRAFFIC 29.92
HDG
S 193 21
VOR1
CRS 252 FORMAT
15
24
9.0NM
PRESET LX/RDR
FMS1 25 +01
–01 WX
T +O.5
12.5 TFC
–05 SAT 0 °C
ISA 0 °C
RAT 50 °C
8. Pushing the FL button will display alti- Set the reported airfield temperature on the dis-
tude reporting targets at barometrically play. Once the knob is released, the display will
corrected altitudes. indicate the percent N 1 for takeoff based on the
selected temperature. If any other mode is se-
lected on the ground, or if there is no N1 charted
data for the anti-ice conditions, the display will
indicate “_ _ _ .”
TO / GA TO / GA TO / GA
CLB CRU CLB CRU CLB CRU
SAFE FLIGHT SAFE FLIGHT SAFE FLIGHT
NOTE 0
9 FEET 1
35 800
If any anti-ice item required by N 1 re-
minder is not turned on, the display
will remain blank.
8 2
60,000 FT
ALT (18,288M)
7 3
hPa IN HG
6 5 4
STD BARO
The pilot ADC receives 29-VDC power from 2. The PFD ADC altimeter and AM-250
the left crossover bus. Its ADC 1 circuit breaker altimeter and a sensitive standby altime-
is located on the right circuit-breaker panel and ter are required for all kinds of opera-
is labeled ADC 1. The copilot AM-250 re- tions (e.g., VFR day and night, IFR day
ceives 29-VDC power from the right extension and night, and icing).
bus. Its circuit breaker is located on the right-
hand circuit-breaker panel and is labeled
ADC/ALT 2.
NOTE
In the event of any discrepancy be-
tween the primary altimeters, the
pneumatic standby altimeter will not
be used in determining which of the
two primary altimeters is correct.
OPERATING LIMITATIONS
1. In the event of any discrepancy between
the primary altimeters, the pneumatic
standby altimeter will not be used in de-
termining which of the two primary al-
timeters is correct.
(i.e. overhead speakers are muted), any one of 5. Inadvertent descent below glide slope
the following actions will revert the system (mode 5)
back to the normal operating mode resulting
in AUDIO SPK/HPH being illuminated in the 6. SMART 500 callout—Altitude callout at
switch: 500 AGL (mode 6)
1. Deselecting cockpit speaker audio inhibit
switch 7. Excessive bank angle alerting (mode 6)
3. Either the pilot or the copilot selects MIC In addition, the enhanced ground proximity
OXY MASK position on the microphone warning system provides the following ter-
select switch rain map enhanced modes (Table 16-10):
NOTE:
EGPWS aural alerts and warnings above will override all other aural warnings except overspeed.
OPERATING LIMITATIONS
1. The use of this system is limited to per-
forming a caution/warning function only.
The Honeywell enhanced ground prox-
imity warning system (EGPWS) is not
intended as a primary flight instrument. Figure 16-110. Terrain Display Control
The Enhanced Ground Proximity Warning
System Pilot’s Guide, P/N 060-4241-000, a. The airport has no approved instru-
Revision C dated June 1999 (or later ap- ment approach procedure.
plicable revision), must be available to the
flight crew when operating the EGPWS. b. The longest runway is less than
3,500 feet in length.
2. Pilot are authorized to deviate from their
current air traffic control (ATC) clear-
ance to the extent necessary to comply c. The airport/approach is not listed in
with an EGPWS warning. AlliedSignal Avionics, Inc. docu-
ment 060-4267-00, Revision A or
latest revision (reference URL
3. The windshear warning portion of the http://www.egpws.com).
system should not be relied upon as the
sole source of windshear detection and
avoidance. The system utilizes many in- 7. In the event that the accuracy of aircraft
puts from other aircraft systems for the position data (from the flight manage-
detection of windshear and cannot pre- ment system(s) or global positioning sys-
dict severe windshear that may be ahead t e m [ G P S ] ) o r a ny o t h e r m o n i t o r e d
of the aircraft. Pilot judgment must be parameter becomes invalid or unavail-
based on airspeed, angle of attack able, the terrain alerting and display
(AOA), sink rate, and other factors in- (TAD) and terrain clearance floor (TCF)
cluding the windshear warning system. functions are automatically inhibited. If
this occurs, the MFD will display TERR
FAIL to indicate to the pilot that the en-
hanced modes of the EGPWS are not
4. The terrain display is intended to serve as available. This will not affect the basic
a situational awareness tool only. The GPWS functions.
terrain/obstacle database does not include
100% of all terrain, nor does it include
100% of all obstacles. Navigation is not OPERATING PROCEDURES
to be predicated upon use of the terrain
database display. The operating procedures are the same as those
in the basic FAA-approved Airplane Flight
Manual except as follows:
5. The terrain display must be INHIBITED
by selecting TERR INHIB when using
QFE as altitude reference (Figure 16-110). NOTE
• When an EGPWS CAUTION oc-
curs, adjust the aircraft flight path
6. EGPWS must be INHIBITED by select- or configuration until the caution
ing TERR INHIB when within 15 nm of ceases.
landing at an airport for which any of the
following conditions apply:
• If an EGPWS warning occurs, im-
mediately initiate and continue a
VISUAL
AURAL WARNING
MODE WARNING MESSAGE ACTION
MESSAGE (COLOR/DISPLAY)
2* “PULL UP, PULL UP, PULL UP Execute a vertical escape maneuver
TERRAIN, TERRAIN” (Red/PFD ADIs) (indicates rapidly rising terrain ahead as a
function of rate of change in radio altimeter).
*GPWS mode 2 will not provide warning for flight into precipitous or very rapidly rising terrain with little or no rising preamble terrain.
VISUAL
AURAL WARNING
WARNING MESSAGE ACTION
MESSAGE (COLOR/DISPLAY)
“TERRAIN–TERRAIN, PULL UP Immediately execute a vertical escape maneuver.
PULL UP–PULL UP” (Red/PFD ADIs) (This message indicates less than 30 seconds to
impact with terrain that is within 250 to 500 feet
below or higher than airplane altitude.)
VISUAL
AURAL WARNING
WARNING ACTION
MODE MESSAGE
MESSAGE (COLOR/DISPLAY)
1 “SINK RATE” GND/PROX Reduce rate of descent until the warning ceases
(Amber/PFD ADIs) (indicates excessive sink rate below 1,100 feet
AGL in landing configuration).
2 “TERRAIN” GND PROX Maneuver aircraft to avoid terrain (climb, turn
(Amber/PFD ADIs) as required). If terrain clearance continues to
decrease, the aural message TERRAIN will be
given until the terrain clearance stops decreasing.
3 “DON’T SINK” GND PROX Establish a positive rate of climb (indicates radio
(Amber/PFD ADIs) altitude loss after takeoff with gear and flaps not
in landing configuration, below 300 feet AGL).
4A “TOO LOW, GND PROX Immediately level off or initiate a climb as required.
TERRAIN” (Amber/PFD ADIs) (This message indicates the aircraft has descended
below 1,100 feet AGL, is not in landing configuration,
and airspeed is greater than 190 KIAS.)
4A “TOO LOW, GEAR” GND PROX Immediately level off, initiate a climb or lower landing
(Amber/PFD ADIs) gear as required. (This message indicates the
aircraft has descended below 500 feet AGL, landing
gear is not down, and airspeed is below 150 KIAS.)
4B** “TOO LOW, FLAPS” GND PROX Immediately level off, initiate a climb or extend
(Amber/PFD ADIs) flaps, as required. (This message indicates the
aircraft has descended below approximately
245 feet AGL, airspeed is below 160 KIAS and
flaps are not in the 35° position.)
5 “GLIDE SLOPE” –––– Maneuver the airplane to recapture the glide
slope, go-around, or continue the approach—
if visual—as required. (This message indicates
the aircraft has descended more than
approximately 1.6 dots below glide slope on an
ILS, is below 1,000 feet AGL, and is descending
greater than 500 feet per minute.)
7 “CAUTION WINDSHEAR During takeoff up to 1,500 feet AGL or during landing
WINDSHEAR” (Amber Annunciator) from 1,500 feet AGL to 10 feet, the aircraft has
entered an area of possible windshear. Be prepared
to execute windshear recovery.
** If landing with flaps less than 35°, FLAP OVERRIDE must be selected to prevent inappropriate TOO LOW, FLAPS alert.
VISUAL
AURAL WARNING
WARNING ACTION
MESSAGE
MESSAGE (COLOR/DISPLAY)
“TOO LOW, TERRAIN” GRD PROX Immediately level off, climb, or continue (if visual)
(Amber/PFD ADIs) as required. (This message indicates the aircraft
has passed through the EGPWS minimum terrain
clearance floor, based on proximity to nearest airport.)
“CAUTION–TERRAIN, GND PROX Adjust the aircraft flightpath to avoid terrain until
CAUTION–TERRAIN” (Amber/PFD ADIs) the caution ceases. (This message indicates the
airplane is within 30 to 60 seconds of impact with
terrain which is within 250 to 500 feet below or higher
than airplane altitude. This message will repeat every
seven seconds.)
NOTE:
If any of the above occur, immediately initiate corrective action to eliminate the cause of the condition.
AURAL
MODE ACTION
ADVISORY
6 “BANK ANGLE, This callout alerts the pilot to excessive bank angles.
BANK ANGLE” The bank angle that causes this alert varies lineraly
from 10° at 30 feet AGL to 40° at 150 feet AGL to
55° at 2,450 feet AGL.
NAVIGATION OPERATIONAL
APPROVALS
The CDI-500 course deviation indicator is ap-
proved for enroute navigation only.
OPERATING LIMITATIONS
The CDI-500 must be operated full bright dur-
ing daylight operations. Dimming the indica-
tor may result in inability to see track deviation.
AVIONICS DISPATCH
SWITCH (OPTIONAL)
GENERAL
The AVIONICS DISPATCH switch provides
capability to turn on COMM II, both audio am-
plifiers, and the FMS without repositioning the
battery and avionics switches. The pushbut-
ton switch labeled AVIONICS DISPATCH
will illuminate ON whenever the switch is se-
lected ON and the battery switch is OFF.
Pushing the switch a second time will turn
the power off.
2. The integrated avionics processor sys- 5. The MFD went blank with the loss of the
tem (IAPS) is: engine instrument system (EIS) and nav-
igation display.
A. The heart of the Collins Pro Line 21
located in the right forward nose bag- A. There is no reversion possibility, ob-
gage compartment serve the standby L and R N 1 s
B. Changes analog engine data to digi- B. Use the L AHRS reversion switch
tal and directs that data to the MFD for C. Use the DADC reversion switch
display D. Select the PFD/MFD reversion switch
C. Changes fuel quantity to analog and to REV TO PFD
directs it to the PFD for display
D. Has no way to store fault codes from 6. Select the NAV button on the mode select
the flight guidance system (FGS) panel (MSP) when cleared for:
A. VOR approach
3. Things that trip the autopilot and yaw B. ILS approach
damper are: C. Localizer straight-in approach
A. Pressing the electric trim switch D. Localizer back-course approach
B. Pressing the AP TRIM DISC red
button
C. Pressing the electric trim switch or the 7. The pilot PFD airspeed, altitude, and ver-
go-around button on the left throttle tical speed data just failed to red lettered
IAS, ALT, and VS in red boxes.
D. Pressing the AP SYNC button and
EFIS turned on and timed out with no A. The left air data computer failed.
fault codes Single PFD cannot revert. Dual PFD
can revert.
B. With single PFD, the copilot round
4. Which of the following is required for instruments are inoperative.
normal takeoff operation of the EFIS C. The standby airspeed and altimeter
system: use the left air data computer.
A. Pilot in the seat with lap belt on and D. Properly flying the single PFD con-
the FMS flight plan loaded in the FMS figuration, fly the standby instruments
B. The avionics master switch on prior backed up by the copilot instruments.
to starting engines and EFIS turned on
and timed out with no fault codes
8. The MFD FORMAT line-select key page 13. The PFD went blank with the loss of the
possibilities in order are: ADI and HSI displays.
A. FMS MAP, rose, diagnostics page A. There is no reversion possibility, ob-
B. Rose, arc, FMS MAP, TCAS 1, FMS serve the standby L and R N 1 s
planning map north up, and diagnos- B. Use the L AHRS reversion switch
tics page C. Use the DADC reversion switch
C. Arc, diagnostics page, Jeppesen chart D. Select the PFD/MFD reversion switch
D. Rose, arc, FMS MAP, TCAS 1 to REV TO MFD
9. The pilot PFD and MFD are primarily 14. What are the indications if the pilot air
controlled by the: data computer fails (single-PFD
A. Mode select panel (MSP) configuration)?
B. TCAS 1 control panel A. The left PFD, red ATT, and HDG fail
C. Autopilot panel (APP) flags appear
D. Display control panel (DCP) B. The copilot round instruments are in-
operative
C. The pilot airspeed, altimeter, and ver-
10. The rudder servo is engaged by the: tical speed go to red lettered IAS,
A. Yaw damper (YD) lever on the APP ALT, and VS in red boxes
B. Autopilot lever (AP) on the APP D. Properly flying the single PFD con-
C. A/P SYNC button figuration, fly the standby instruments
backed up by the copilot instruments
D. Go-around button (GA) on the throt-
tle knob
15. The pilot PFD FORMAT line-select key
page possibilities are:
11. The autopilot minimum disengagement
altitude during an ILS is: A. Rose, arc, FMS MAP, TCAS 1
A. 70 feet B. Rose, arc, FMS MAP, TCAS 1, FMS
planning map north up, and diagnos-
B. 110 feet tics page
C. 200 feet C. FMS MAP rose, diagnostics page
D. 50 feet D. Arc, diagnostics page, Jeppesen chart
12. What mode select panel (MSP) button do 16. To set the course on the course pointer and
you arm when cleared for the localizer CDI (LDI) and select the single line
straight-in approach? pointer:
A. APPR A. Select the radar key on the DCP
B. NAV B. Select the NAV/BRG key on the DCP
C. B/C C. Select the APPR button on the MSP
D. FLC D. Press the RETURN line-select key to
the FORMAT page
9. Receiver autonomous integrity monitor- 12. If the CDI moves from the left side of
ing requires no less than _______ satellites the HSI to the right side of the HSI dur-
to be properly oriented, above the hori- ing an FMS flight, what distance from
zon in view. the center line are you?
A. 5 (good satellites) or 4 (satellites and A. Terminal phase; ±1.0 nm of center
baro-aiding) B. Enroute phase; ±5.0 nm of center
B. 6 (satellites) or 5 (satellites with baro- C. Approach phase; ±0.3 nm of center
aiding to eliminate a corrupted satel- D. A, B, and C
lite)
C. Both A and B
D. 3 13. What manuals are required on the air-
craft when FMS flight is intended?
A. FMS Flight Manual
10. To fly a GPS NDB-approved FMS ap-
B. Airplane Flight Manual (AFM)
proach:
C. Both A and B
A. The internal database must be updated
D. Newspaper
within 28 days
B. RAIM must be available
C. The FMS must be in the approach
mode over the FAF
D. All of the above
CHAPTER 17
MISCELLANEOUS SYSTEMS
CONTENTS
Page
INTRODUCTION................................................................................................................. 17-1
OXYGEN SYSTEM ............................................................................................................. 17-1
Component Description................................................................................................. 17-2
System Operation .......................................................................................................... 17-4
Oxygen Mask Mic and Headset Mic............................................................................. 17-6
QUESTIONS......................................................................................................................... 17-8
ILLUSTRATIONS
Figure Title Page
17-1 Oxygen Filler Port ................................................................................................. 17-2
17-2 Oxygen Pressure Gage........................................................................................... 17-2
17-3 Oxygen Control Valve............................................................................................ 17-3
17-4 Overboard Discharge Indicator.............................................................................. 17-3
17-5 Crew Masks ........................................................................................................... 17-3
17-6 Passenger Oxygen Mask........................................................................................ 17-4
17-7 Oxygen System ...................................................................................................... 17-5
17-8 HEAD SET Oxygen Panels ................................................................................... 17-6
TABLE
Table Title Page
17-1 Oxygen Supply Chart ............................................................................................ 17-7
CHAPTER 17
MISCELLANEOUS SYSTEMS
RESET
ANTI-ICE
12 ON
TEST
OIL
16
8 BLOWER
OFF
NO 1 FUEL ENG 1 XMSN
TRANS CHIP OIL
NO 1 FUEL NO 1 FUEL 90° BOX
LOW FILTER OIL
4 BATT
HOT
NO 1 BATT
SYS
GEN 1
HOT
0
INTRODUCTION
This chapter covers the oxygen system installed on the Citation CJ2. Oxygen is supplied
to the crew and passengers during pressurization system malfunctions, or whenever
required. Additionally, cold-weather operation, servicing, and airplane cleaning and care
are discussed.
OXYGEN SYSTEM
The oxygen system consists of the crew and the pressurization system up to the maximum
passenger distribution systems. Oxygen is certified altitude of 45,000 feet.
available to the crew at all times and can be
made available to the passengers either auto- The system consists of an oxygen storage
matically above a predetermined cabin alti- cylinder with an integral shutoff valve and
tude, or manually at any altitude by a cockpit pressure regulator, servicing fitting, crew
control. The system is primarily intended to and passenger masks, altitude pressure
provide emergency oxygen since a cabin alti- switch, overboard discharge disc, and a con-
tude of 8,000 feet is normally maintained by trol selector on the pilot’s console.
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Oxygen Cylinder Assembly
The oxygen cylinder, installed in the nose stor-
age compartment under the floor on the right
side, may have a 619-liter (22-cubic-foot) or
a optional 1,407-liter (50-cubic-foot) capac-
ity. A shutoff valve and pressure regulator lo-
cated on the cylinder control the flow of oxygen
to the distribution system. The shutoff valve
is normally open. The regulator reduces line
pressure to 70 psi. The cylinder is serviced
through the filler port near the aft bulkhead just
inside the flight nose baggage door (Figure
17-1). The fill valve incorporates a check valve
and filter. A pressure sealing cap prevents con-
taminants from entering the oxygen system.
The cylinder is serviced with aviator’s oxygen
only (MIL-O-2720, Type 1). Figure 17-1. Oxygen Filler Port
Pressure Gage
The oxygen pressure gage is located on the
right side of the copilot’s instrument panel
(Figure 17-2). The gage is internally illuminated
and the range markings are as follows:
Controls
Figure 17-2. Oxygen Pressure Gage
The OXYGEN CONTROL VALVE on the
pilot’s console (Figure 17-3) controls oxygen
flow to the passengers or restricts it to crew Overboard Discharge Indicator
use only. NORMAL, CREW ONLY, and MAN- A green overboard discharge indicator (disc) is
UAL DROP positions mechanically actuate a located on the right side of the nose section di-
control valve for distribution as desired. rectly below the nose access door (Figure 17-4).
The disc provides a visual indication that an
P. R
.
X Y. H
E
LI EF
O
OXYGEN HIGH
PRESSURE RELIEF
NOTE: THIS AREA IS GREEN DO NOT COVER
28-VOLT
DC
ALTITUDE
PRESSURE
SWITCH
MANUAL
DROP CREW
ONLY
TO COPILOT’S
FACE MASK
PILOT’S FACE
MASK EROS
OVERBOARD
DISCHARGE
INDICATOR
CYLINDER PRESSURE
SHUTOFF VALVE GAGE
KNOB
0 TO 400 PSI 1,600 TO 1,800 PSI
2,000 PSI
PRESSURE
REGULATOR LEGEND
HIGH-PRESSURE OXYGEN
* CHECK VALVE LOW-PRESSURE OXYGEN
QUESTIONS
1. The cockpit oxygen pressure gage reads: 4. The purpose of the altitude pressure
A. The oxygen pressure which is present switch is to:
at the crew masks A. Bypass oxygen flow directly to the
B. E l e c t r i c a l l y d e r ive d s y s t e m l ow passengers regardless of OXYGEN
pressure selector position.
C. Bottle pressure B. Open a solenoid at 14,500 feet cabin
D. Electrically derived system high altitude, allowing oxygen flow to the
pressure passenger oxygen distribution system.
C. Close a solenoid valve at 14,500 feet
cabin altitude, stopping oxygen flow
2. Passenger masks are dropped when: to the passengers.
A. The OXYGEN selector is in NOR- D. Restore cabin altitude to 8,000 feet so
M A L a n d c a b i n a l t i t u d e ex c e e d s that oxygen is not required.
14,500 feet.
B. The cabin altitude exceeds 14,500 5. If the oxygen selector is placed in CREW
feet, regardless of OXYGEN selec- ONLY:
tor position.
A. T h e p a s s e n g e r m a s k s c a n n o t b e
C. The OXYGEN selector is in MAN- dropped automatically.
UAL DROP, regardless of altitude.
B. The passenger masks will not deploy
D. Both A and C automatically, but they can still be
dropped manually.
3. If DC power fails, placing the OXYGEN C. The passengers will still receive
selector in: oxygen if the cabin altitude is above
8,000 feet.
A. MANUAL DROP deploys the passen-
ger masks, regardless of the cabin al- D. Normal DC power is removed from the
titude. passenger mask door actuators, thus
preventing them from dropping the
B. MANUAL DROP deploys the passen-
masks.
ger masks only if 14,500 feet cabin al-
titude is exceeded.
C. CREW ONLY does not restrict oxy- 6. If normal DC power is lost with the
gen to the crew only if the cabin alti- oxygen selector in NORMAL:
tude is above 14,500 feet. A. The passenger masks will deploy im-
D. Any of the three operating positions mediately, regardless of the cabin
will not route oxygen to the altitude.
passengers—they have their own B. T h e p a s s e n g e r m a s k s c a n n o t b e
oxygen. dropped manually.
C. The oxygen pressure gage on the
copilot’s panel will be inoperative.
D. Automatic dropping of the passenger
masks will not occur.
WALKAROUND
The following section is a pictorial walkaround. It shows each item
called out in the exterior power-off preflight inspection. The fold-
out pages at the beginning and the end of the walkaround section
should be unfolded before starting to read.
CITATION CJ2 525A PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CITATION CJ2 525A PILOT TRAINING MANUAL
WALKAROUND
LEFT NOSE—CHECK
47
71
5 2 77 46
75
43
44
68
67 69 66
74 73
3 1 72 70
76
4 3. NOSE GEAR, DOORS, WHEEL, AND TIRE—CONDI-
TION AND SECURE
41 48 37
36
23 24
15 7 8 9 10 11
17
44 16
43 12 6
27
29
28 4. NOSEWHEEL CENTERING LOCK ASSEMBLY—DIS-
19 CONNECT LOCKING MECHANISM AND VERIFY FLY
(GREEN) PLACARD IS VISIBLE. (DO NOT TOW [RED]
35 AIRPLANE WITH NOSEWHEEL CENTERING LOCK
ASSEMBLY IN FLY [GREEN] POSITION.)
2. BAGGAGE DOOR—SECURED AND LOCKED
26 34
22 25 21 20 18 14 13
RIGHT WING—CHECK
RIGHT NACELLE—CHECK
36. OIL FILTER DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE 38. ENGINE EXHAUST AND BYPASS DUCTS—
INDICATOR—NOT EXTENDED CONDITION AND SECURE
37. OIL LEVEL—PUSH PANEL CHECK 39. THRUST ATTENUATOR—CONDITION AND SECURE
FILLER CAP AND ACCESS DOORS—SECURE
EMPENNAGE—TEST
41. RIGHT HORIZONTAL STABILIZER DEICE 42. LEFT AND RIGHT HORIZONTAL STABILIZER,
BOOT—CONDITION ELEVATOR, AND TRIM TAB—CONDITION
AFT COMPARTMENT
LEFT NACELLE—CHECK
59. THRUST ATTENUATOR—CONDITION AND SECURE 61. GENERATOR COOLING AIR EXHAUST—CLEAR
62. OIL LEVEL—PUSH PANEL CHECK 63. OIL FILTER DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE
FILLER CAP AND ACCESS DOORS—SECURE INDICATOR—NOT EXTENDED
LEFT WING—CHECK
45 48 42
49
46
39 38
43
40 32 33 31 30
42 45
45
45
62 58 59
55 43
56 63
66 68
44
61 60
56
69 65 67 50 51 52 53 54 55
64
57
APPENDIX
CONTENTS
Page
ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS (COLLINS RELATED) ................................... APP-1
ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS .......................................................................................... APP-4
F IOC—input/output concentrator
P V
PAC—path attenuation compensation VHF—very high frequency
PFD—primary flight display VIR—VOR/ILS receiver
VNAV—vertical speed
R
VOR—VHF omnidirectional range
RA—radio altimeter or resolution advisory
VS—vertical speed
RAS—radio altimeter system or reference
approach speed VSR—vertical speed required
RSP—reversionary switching panel
W
RSS—radio sensor system
WPT—waypoint
RTA—receiver/transmitter/antenna
WX—weather
RTU—radio tuning unit
Y
S
YD—yaw damper
SAT—static air temperature
STBY—standby
T
TA—traffic advisory
TAS—true airspeed
TAT—total air temperature or true air
temperature
TCAS—traffic collision avoidance system
TERR—terrain
TFC—traffic
TRK—track, track angle
TTG—time to go
U
UTC—Universal time correlation
ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS
CHAPTER 2 CHAPTER 5 CHAPTER 9 17. A
1. C 1. D 1. B 18. B
2. D 2. B 2. B 19. D
3. D 3. C 3. A
4. B 4. C 4. D CHAPTER 12
5. C 5. A 1. B
6. D 6. A CHAPTER 10 2. D
7. C 7. B 1. D 3. C
8. D 8. A 2. A 4. D
9. B 9. B 3. B 5. D
10. B 10. D 4. C 6. C
11. D 5. A 7. A
12. A CHAPTER 7 6. B 8. C
13. B 1. B 7. D 9. B
14. C 2. A 8. D 10. D
15. D 3. B 9. D 11. A
16. D 4. B 10. B 12. A
17. A 5. D 11. B 13. A
18. B 6. A 12. B 14. C
19. D 7. B 13. C
20. B 8. B 14. A CHAPTER 13
21. D 9. A 15. D 1. D
22. C 10. D 2. D
23. D 11. D CHAPTER 11 3. B
12. D 1. D 4. C
CHAPTER 3 13. D 2. B 5. A
1. A 14. B 3. D 6. D
2. D 15. D 4. D 7. D
3. D 16. A 5. C 8. B
4. D 17. A 6. A 9. D
5. A 7. D 10. D
6. B CHAPTER 8 8. D 11. D
1. D 9. D 12. D
CHAPTER 4 2. B 10. B
1. C 3. A 11. B CHAPTER 14
2. D 4. D 12. B 1. B
3. A 5. B 13. A 2. D
4. B 6. A 14. C 3. A
7. C 15. B 4. B
16. C 5. C
6. A 6. C
7. B 7. A
8. C 8. B
9. C 9. D
10. C 10. A
11. B 11. A
12. B 12. B
13. A 13. D
14. D 14. C
15. B 15. A
16. D 16. B
17. C
18. C CJ2 FLIGHT
19. C MANAGEMENT
20. D SYSTEMS
CHAPTER 16
CHAPTER 15 1. C
1. B 2. B
2. C 3. A
3. A 4. D
4. B 5. D
5. A 6. D
6. D 7. A
7. B 8. D
8. C 9. C
9. B 10. D
10. B 11. B
11. B 12. D
12. A 13. C
13. A
14. C CHAPTER 17
15. A 1. C
2. D
CJ2 COLLINS 3. A
PRO LINE 21 4. B
EFIS 5. A
CHAPTER 16 6. D
1. C
2. A
3. B
4. C
5. D
ANNUNCIATORS
The Annunciator section presents a color repre-
sentation of all the annunciator lights in the airplane.
CITATION CJ2 525A PILOT TRAINING MANUAL CITATION CJ2 525A PILOT TRAINING MANUAL
V
I
F
BATT
O’TEMP
CABIN
ALT
OIL PRESS
WARN
FUEL
GAUGE
FUEL LOW
LEVEL
FUEL LOW
PRESS
FUEL FLTR
BYPASS
FUEL
BOOST ON
FUEL
TRANSFER DUAL PFD
A
Collins
L D
I
> 160° ----------------- L R L R L R L R L R L R ----------------- R Collins
E
ENGINE O
L
F/W EMERG WIS AIR P/S HTR ENG WING BLD AIR TAIL DEICE TAIL DEICE ENGINE
MASTER MASTER HDG 1/2 BANK B/C FLC ALT FIRE SHUT OFF PRESS ON O’HEAT OFF ANTI-ICE ANTI-ICE O’HEAT FAIL PRESS
FIRE HDG 1/2 BANK B/C FLC ALT
MASTER MASTER
WARNING CAUTION A L R FRESH
AIR
AOA HTR
FAIL L R L R L R L R AIR DUCT
O’HEAT L R WARNING CAUTION
F
RESET RESET U RESET RESET
A GEN AFT DOOR NOT FLAPS PWR BRK HYD FLOW HYD PRESS ATTEN ATTN STOW
D
I OFF J-BOX LOCKED > 35 LOW PRESS LOW ON UNLOCK SELECT
I
NAV APPR FD SPD CHG VS BOTTLE 1 O
L
DOOR ANTI-SKID SPD BRK GROUND
BOTTLE 2 NAV APPR FD SPD CHG VS
ARMED L R LMT CB ----------------- L R L R ARMED
SEAL INOP EXTEND IDLE
PUSH PUSH
AVIONICS
M877
DISPATCH N1 %RPM
CHRONOMETER
GNS-X GNS-X GNS-X KLN-900 ONE PFD ONE PFD RVSM
95.6 95.9
APPROACH S/X WAYPOINT WAYPOINT ON
GNS-X GNS-X GNS-X KLN-900
HEADING DR MESSAGE MESSAGE OUTER MIDDLE INNER
GMT LT FT ET L R
SELECT CONTROL 0
SEL CTL 9 1
FEET
DAVTRON
AUDIO
8 320 2
SPK/HPH 60,000 FT
RUDDER AUDIO ALT (18,288 M)
TEST BIAS HPH ONLY
7 hPa 3
IN HG
OFF 29 .92
ANNU
FIRE 6 4
WARN STD 5 BARO
ANTI LDG
SKID GEAR
OVER BATT AVIONICS
SPEED TEMP POWER
AOA STDBY
W/S TEMP GYRO ON
RUDDER
O
BIAS F
F ELT
ACTIVATED PULL
WHEN LIT USE STBY CHAN 25K
TEST OFF COMM 1 PULL
L R L DISENGAGE R L R
ON ON
USE STBY CHAN PULL
25K
O COMM 2
F START ARM
TEST/RESET CHAN OFF
PULL
TEST
F DISG NOSE 0 SELECT ON
FAN 2
0 WAIT 1 SECOND
SELECT ARM
NORM NORM NORM NORM LH RH
SET ALT
FL EXER
AIR CONDITIONING
BARO
UNITS GEAR 0 00 AUTO
SET RATE COCKPIT VOICE
INCHES hPa UNLOCKED ALT O RECORDER
TERR GPWS FLAP GPWS F HOLD
NORM NORM G/S GPWS HG DEPRESSURIZE CABIN BEFORE LA F 5 SEC
TERR GPWS FLAP CANCELED TEST
INHIB OVRD FAN
COMPRESSOR FAN
TEST HEADSET ERASE
ON AFT FWD DEFOG
TCAS FAIL FLOOD HI
A
HI
O
H U F
I T F
DME O
ON ABOVE LOW LOW
NAV 1
DME SBY TST NORM FL
NAV 1 OFF BELOW ENGINE SYNC
PUSH TO TEST PUSH FOR FL OFF ON
FAN TURBINE CH
9.0 90
1 MUST BE M
OFF FOR H
NM KT MIN Z
TAKEOFF
AND K
BENDIX/KING
ENGAGE LANDING
H S
L R Z T
YD AP O
DN GPS APR GPS CRS
AP XFR HF USB
OBS VOL AM
OFF LSB
DME 1 DME 2 SQ
HOLD ON TEL
(A3J)
SELECTED DME
OFF UP TURB HF
Collins DISENGAGE